WO2017172356A1 - Polynucleotide agents targeting insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (igfals) and methods of use thereof - Google Patents
Polynucleotide agents targeting insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (igfals) and methods of use thereof Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- WO2017172356A1 WO2017172356A1 PCT/US2017/022390 US2017022390W WO2017172356A1 WO 2017172356 A1 WO2017172356 A1 WO 2017172356A1 US 2017022390 W US2017022390 W US 2017022390W WO 2017172356 A1 WO2017172356 A1 WO 2017172356A1
- Authority
- WO
- WIPO (PCT)
- Prior art keywords
- agent
- nucleotides
- igfals
- antisense polynucleotide
- length
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Ceased
Links
Classifications
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/70—Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
- A61K31/7088—Compounds having three or more nucleosides or nucleotides
- A61K31/712—Nucleic acids or oligonucleotides having modified sugars, i.e. other than ribose or 2'-deoxyribose
-
- A—HUMAN NECESSITIES
- A61—MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
- A61K—PREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
- A61K31/00—Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
- A61K31/70—Carbohydrates; Sugars; Derivatives thereof
- A61K31/7088—Compounds having three or more nucleosides or nucleotides
- A61K31/7125—Nucleic acids or oligonucleotides having modified internucleoside linkage, i.e. other than 3'-5' phosphodiesters
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N15/00—Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
- C12N15/09—Recombinant DNA-technology
- C12N15/11—DNA or RNA fragments; Modified forms thereof; Non-coding nucleic acids having a biological activity
- C12N15/113—Non-coding nucleic acids modulating the expression of genes, e.g. antisense oligonucleotides; Antisense DNA or RNA; Triplex- forming oligonucleotides; Catalytic nucleic acids, e.g. ribozymes; Nucleic acids used in co-suppression or gene silencing
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N2310/00—Structure or type of the nucleic acid
- C12N2310/10—Type of nucleic acid
- C12N2310/11—Antisense
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N2310/00—Structure or type of the nucleic acid
- C12N2310/30—Chemical structure
- C12N2310/31—Chemical structure of the backbone
- C12N2310/315—Phosphorothioates
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N2310/00—Structure or type of the nucleic acid
- C12N2310/30—Chemical structure
- C12N2310/32—Chemical structure of the sugar
- C12N2310/321—2'-O-R Modification
-
- C—CHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
- C12—BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
- C12N—MICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
- C12N2310/00—Structure or type of the nucleic acid
- C12N2310/30—Chemical structure
- C12N2310/33—Chemical structure of the base
- C12N2310/334—Modified C
- C12N2310/3341—5-Methylcytosine
Definitions
- Acromegaly is a progressive and life threatening disease resulting from growth hormone hypersecretion from a benign pituitary tumor. Excess growth hormone leads to approximately a 10 year reduction in lifespan and a reduced quality of life. Acromegaly is associated with cardiovascular disease including hypertension and cardiac hypertrophy, cerebrovascular disease including stroke, metabolic disease including diabetes, and respiratory disease including sleep apnea. Mortality rates in acromegaly are correlated with growth hormone and IGF-1 levels, with increased growth hormone concentrations being associated with shorter life spans (Holdaway et al., JCEM, 2004).
- Clinical features most commonly associated with acromegaly are acral enlargement, maxofacial changes, excessive sweating, athralgias, headache, hypogonadal symptoms, visual deficit, fatigue, weight gain, and galactorrhea. Diagnostic criteria are provided in the American Association of Clinical Endocrinologists Medical Guidelines for Clinical Practice for the Diagnosis and Treatment of Acromegaly– 2011 Update (Katznelson et al., Endocr. Pract. 17(Suppl. 4). As the foregoing symptoms may be associated with a number of diseases or conditions, diagnosis of acromegaly often does not occur until several years after the initiation of growth hormone hypersecretion. Diagnosis includes detection of an increased level of insulin growth factor-1 (IGF-1) and growth hormone elevation in an oral glucose tolerance test. The diagnosis is confirmed by detection of a GH-hypersecreting pituitary tumor, typically by MRI.
- IGF-1 insulin growth factor-1
- Surgical removal of the pituitary adenoma by transsphenoidal surgery results in a cure for about 50-60% of patients.
- Subjects for whom surgical intervention is not possible or does not result in a cure are treated with first-line pharmacological therapy which includes dopamine agonists or sustained-release somatostatin analogs (SSAs).
- SSAs sustained-release somatostatin analogs
- This therapy results in a good control for the disease for about 70% of these patients for whom surgery cannot provide a cure.
- the use of SSAs is limited to subjects expressing a somatostatin receptor on their tumor.
- Subjects whose disease cannot be controlled by the first-line pharmacological therapy are treated with SOMAVERT® (pegvisomant), a growth hormone receptor antagonist, which is administered by daily subcutaneous injection.
- SOMAVERT® pegvisomant
- a growth hormone receptor antagonist which is administered by daily subcutaneous injection.
- the insulin growth factor system is also associated with abnormal growth in cancer and metastasis (see, e.g., Samani et al., Endocrine Rev., 2007).
- the IGF system has become a target for anticancer agents, both as primary and adjunctive therapy.
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents and compositions comprising such agents which which which target nucleic acids encoding insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid.
- the IGFALS nucleic acid may be within a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human.
- the present invention also provides methods and combination therapies for treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS mRNA, e.g., an IGFALS -associated disease, such as acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer using the polynucleotide agents and compositions of the invention.
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS).
- the agents comprise 4 to 50 contiguous nucleotides, wherein at least one of the contiguous nucleotides is a modified nucleotide, and wherein the nucleotide sequence of the agent is at least 80% complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5.
- the equivalent region is a target region of SEQ ID NO:1, e.g., at least 14 contiguous nucleotides selected from the group consisting of residues 23-42, 87-106, 121- 207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417-470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132-1163,1220-1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1.
- the equivalent region is any one of the target regions of SEQ ID NO:1 provided in Table 3 or 5.
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises at least 8 contiguous nucleotides differing by no more than 3 nucleotides from any one of the nucleotide sequences listed in Table 3 or 5.
- IGFALS insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises at least 8 contiguous nucleotides differing by no more than 3 nucleotides from residues 23-42, 87-106, 121-207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417-470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132-1163,1220- 1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1.
- IGFALS insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
- substantially all of the nucleotides of the polynucleotide agents of the invention are modified nucleotides. In other embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the polynucleotide agent are modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, the polynucleotides are modified as shown in Table 5.
- the polynucleotide agent may be about 10 to about 40 nucleotides in length; about 10 to about 30 nucleotides in length; about 18 to about 30 nucleotides in length; about 10 to about 24 nucleotides in length; about 18 to about 24 nucleotides in length; about 12 or about 20 nucleotides in length.
- the modified nucleotide comprises a modified sugar moiety selected from the group consisting of a 2′-O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′- methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
- the bicyclic sugar moiety has a (—CRH—)n group forming a bridge between the 2′ oxygen and the 4′ carbon atoms of the sugar ring, wherein n is 1 or 2 and wherein R is H, CH 3 or CH 3 OCH 3 .
- n 1 and R is CH 3 .
- the modified nucleotide is a 5-methylcytosine.
- the modified nucleotide comprises a modified internucleoside linkage, such as a phosphorothioate internucleoside linkage.
- an agent of the invention comprises a plurality of 2′-deoxynucleotides flanked on each side by at least one nucleotide having a modified sugar moiety.
- the agent is a gapmer comprising a gap segment comprised of linked 2′- deoxynucleotides positioned between a 5′ and a 3′ wing segment.
- the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′- O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
- the 5’-wing segment is about 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2, 3, 4, or 5 nucleotides in length.
- the 3’-wing segment is about 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2, 3, 4, or 5 nucleotides in length.
- the gap segment is about 5 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 8-12, 10 nucleotides in length.
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression, comprising a gap segment consisting of linked deoxynucleotides; a 5’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides; a 3’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides; wherein the gap segment is positioned between the 5’-wing segment and the 3’-wing segment and wherein each nucleotide of each wing segment comprises a modified sugar.
- IGFALS insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
- the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is five nucleotides in length.
- the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is four nucleotides in length.
- the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is three nucleotides in length.
- the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is two nucleotides in length.
- the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′- O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
- the agents of the invention further comprise a ligand.
- the ligand is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc).
- the ligand may be one or more GalNAc attached to the agent through a monovalent, a bivalent, or a trivalent branched linker.
- the agent is conjugated to the ligand at the 3’-terminus.
- the agents of the invention comprise a plurality, e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6, of GalNAc, each independently attached to a plurality of nucleotides of the agent through a plurality of monovalent linkers.
- the ligand is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) derivative.
- the ligand is N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N-(2-aminoethyl)-2-aminoethyl-N
- the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions for inhibiting expression of an insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) gene comprising the agents of the invention.
- IGFALS insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
- the agent is present in an unbuffered solution, such as saline or water.
- the agent is is present in a buffer solution, such as a buffer comprising acetate, citrate, prolamine, carbonate, or phosphate or any combination thereof.
- the buffer solution is phosphate buffered saline (PBS).
- the present invention provides pharmaceutical composition
- a lipid formulation such as a lipid formulation comprising an LNP or a MC3.
- the present invention provides methods of inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression in a cell.
- the methods include contacting the cell with the agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention; and maintaining the cell for a time sufficient to obtain antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALSgene in the cell.
- IGFALS insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
- the cell is within a subject.
- the subject is a human. In some embodiments, the subject is not human.
- the IGFALS expression is inhibited by at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay, preferably using the method provided in Example 2 with the antisense oligonucleotide at a concentration of 10 nM. In certain embodiments, the IGFALS expression is inhibited by at least 40% using the method and cell line provided in Example 2 with the antisense oligonucleotide at a concentration of 10 nM.
- the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the methods include administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention, thereby treating the subject.
- the present invention provides methods of preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the methods include administering to the subject a prophylactically effective amount of the agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention, thereby preventing at least one symptom in the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent to the subject causes a decrease or normalization in one or more signs of symptoms of an IGFALS-associated disease or condition, a decrease in IGFALS protein levels, or a decrease in the IGFALS signaling pathway.
- the disorder is an IGFALS-associated disease.
- the IGFALS-associated disease is selected from acromegaly, gigantism, and cancer.
- the IGFALS-associated disease is acromegaly.
- the IGFALS-associated disease is or gigantism.
- the IGFALS-associated disease is cancer.
- the subject is human. In some embodiments, the subject is not human. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an additional agent for the treatment of an IGFALS-associated disease to the subject. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an inhibitor of growth hormone to a subject with an IGFALS-associated disease. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an inhibitor of signaling in the IGF pathway to a subject with an IGFALS associated disease. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering a chemotherapeutic agent to the subject.
- the methods of the invention further include treating the subject with radiation. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include treating the subject with surgery.
- the methods of the invention further include measuring IGFALs levels in the subject. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include measuring signaling in the IGF pathway in the subject.
- FIG. 1 is a schematic showing various aspects of the IGF signaling pathway. Detailed Description of the Invention
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, and compositions comprising such agents which target nucleic acids encoding insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) (e.g., mRNA encoding IGFALS as provided in, for example, any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-4).
- IGFALS acid labile subunit
- the polynucleotide agents bind to nucleic acids encoding IGFALS via, e.g.,Watson-Crick base pairing, and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid.
- polynucleotide agents of the invention include a nucleotide sequence which is 4 to 50 nucleotides or less in length and which is 80% complementary to at least part of an mRNA transcript of an IGFALS gene.
- the use of these polynucleotide agents enables the targeted inhibition of RNA expression or activity of an IGFALS gene in mammals.
- polynucleotide agents e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents
- targeting IGFALS can mediate antisense inhibition in vitro resulting in significant inhibition of expression of an IGFALS gene.
- methods and compositions including these polynucleotide agents are useful for treating a subject who would benefit by a reduction in the levels or activity of an IGFALS protein, such as a subject having an IGFALS associated disease, such as acromegaly, or gigantism, or cancer.
- the present invention also provides methods and combination therapies for treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS gene, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, such as acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer using the
- the present invention also provides methods for preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS gene, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease.
- an IGFALS gene e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease.
- at least one sign or symptom of acromegaly previously displayed in the subject including, elevated IGF-1 level, sleep apnea, joint pain, symptomatic carpal tunnel syndrome, hypertension,
- biventricular cardiac hypertrophy, cardiac arrhythmia, fatigue, and weakness is prevented using the methods of the invention. These symptoms may be assessed in vitro or in vivo using any method known in the art.
- the nadir GH suppression ofter administration of glucose can be considered the“gold standard” test for acromegaly (Katznelson et al., 2011, Endocrine Practice)
- suppression may not be observed after treatment with the RNAi agents provided herein due to their proposed mechanism of action.
- subjects may have accomplished clinically relevant beneficial outcomes with lowering of IGF-1 without reaching normal GH levels.
- IGF-1 levels are dependent both on the age and gender of the subject, with younger subjects having lower IGF-1 levels than older subjects. Therefore, when comparing IGF-1 levels to determine the lowering or normalizing of the level, an appropriate control must be selected. Appropriate controls include, for example, an IGF-1 level prior to treatment (when available) or an age and gender matched control. In certain embodiments, IGF-1 levels are monitored or tested on multiple occasions to confirm a change in IGF-1 level in a subject. In preferred embodiments, the IGF-1 level is decreased sufficiently to provide a clinically beneficial outcome for the subject.
- the disease is cancer
- signs or symptoms of the disease can be monitored by evaluating a subject for maintenance or preferably reduction of tumor burden of the primary tumor or metastatic tumor(s) or the prevention of metastasis.
- Methods for detection and monitoring of tumor burden are known in the art, e.g., RECIST criteria as provided in Eisenhauer et al., 2009, New response evaluation criteria in solid tumours: Revised RECIST guideline (version 1.1). Eur. J. Cancer. 45:228-247.
- compositions comprising polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, which effect antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene.
- the IGFALS gene may be within a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human.
- combination therapies of the present invention include administering to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, a polynucleotide agent of the invention and an additional therapeutic or intervention depending on the disease to be treated (e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer) and as discussed herein.
- combination therapies can include radiation treatments.
- combination treatments can include surgery.
- the following detailed description discloses how to make and use polynucleotide agents to inhibit the mRNA or protein expression of an IGFALS gene, as well as compositions, uses, and methods for treating subjects having diseases and disorders that would benefit from inhibition or reduction of the expression of this gene. I. Definitions
- articles“a” and“an” are used herein to refer to one or to more than one (i.e., to at least one) of the grammatical object of the article.
- “an element” means one element or more than one element, e.g., a plurality of elements.
- nucleoside with a modified base or a modified sugar is understood to include the options of a nucleoside with a modified base, a nucleoside with a modified sugar, and a nucleoside with a modified base and a modified sugar.
- “about” is used herein to mean within the typical ranges of tolerances in the art.
- “about” can be understood as about 2 standard deviations from the mean.
- about means +10%.
- about means +5%.
- the term“at least” prior to a number or series of numbers is understood to include the number adjacent to the term“at least”, and all subsequent numbers or integers that could logically be included, as clear from context.
- the number of nucleotides in a nucleic acid molecule must be an integer.
- “at least 17 nucleotides of a 20 nucleotide nucleic acid molecule” means that 17, 18, 19, or 20 nucleotides have the indicated property.
- “at least” can modify each of the numbers in the series or range.
- “no more than” or“less than” is understood as the value adjacent to the phrase and logical lower values or intergers, as logical from context, to zero. For example, a duplex with mismatches to a target site of“no more than 2 nucleotides” has a 2, 1, or 0 mismatches. When “no more than” is present before a series of numbers or a range, it is understood that“no more than” can modify each of the numbers in the series or range.
- “up to” as in“up to 10” is understood as up to and including 10, i.e., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
- Ranges provided herein are understood to include all individual interger values and all subranges within the ranges.
- IGFALS insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit
- IGFALS insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit
- the amino acid and complete coding sequences of the reference sequence of the human IGFALS gene may be found in, for example, GenBank Accession No. GI: 225579150 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_004970.2; SEQ ID NO:1) and GenBank
- GI:225579151 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_001146006.1; SEQ ID NO: 5).
- Mammalian orthologs of the human IGFALS gene may be found in, for example, GI:
- IGFALS mRNA sequences are readily available using publicly available databases, e.g., GenBank, UniProt, and OMIM.
- polynucleotide agent refers to an agent comprising a single-stranded oligonucleotide that contains RNA as that term is defined herein, and which targets nucleic acid molecules encoding IGFALS (e.g., mRNA encoding IGFALS as provided in, for example, any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5).
- the antisense polynucleotide agents specifically bind to the target nucleic acid molecules via hydrogen bonding (e.g., Watson-Crick, Hoogsteen, or reversed Hoogsteen hydrogen bonding) and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid (e.g., by an antisense mechanism of action).
- This interference with or modulation of the function of a target nucleic acid by the polynucleotide agents of the present invention is referred to as“antisense inhibition.”
- the functions of the target nucleic acid molecule to be interfered with may include functions such as, for example, translocation of the RNA to the site of protein translation, translation of protein from the RNA, splicing of the RNA to yield one or more mRNA species, and catalytic activity which may be engaged in or facilitated by the RNA.
- antisense inhibition refers to“inhibiting the expression” of target nucleic acid levels or target protein levels in a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a mammalian subject, in the presence of the antisense polynucleotide agent complementary to a target nucleic acid as compared to target nucleic acid levels or target protein levels in the absence of the antisense polynucleotide agent.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention can inhibit translation in a stoichiometric manner by base pairing to the mRNA and physically obstructing the translation machinery, see Dias, N. et al., (2002) Mol Cancer Ther 1:347-355.
- target sequence refers to a contiguous portion of the nucleotide sequence of an mRNA molecule formed during the transcription of an IGFALS gene, including mRNA that is a product of RNA processing of a primary transcription product.
- target nucleic acid refers to a nucleic acid molecule to which an antisense polynucleotide agent specifically hybridizes.
- the term“specifically hybridizes” refers to an antisense polynucleotide agent having a sufficient degree of complementarity between the antisense polynucleotide agent and a target nucleic acid to induce a desired effect, while exhibiting minimal or no effects on non-target nucleic acids under conditions in which specific binding is desired, e.g., under physiological conditions in the case of in vivo assays and therapeutic treatments.
- a target sequence may be about 4-50 nucleotides in length, e.g., about 8-45, 10-45, 10-40, 10- 35, 10-30, 10-20, 11-45, 11-40, 11-35, 11-30, 11-20, 12-45, 12-40, 12-35, 12-30, 12-25, 12-20, 13-45, 13-40, 13-35, 13-30, 13-25, 13-20, 14-45, 14-40, 14-35, 14-30, 14-25, 14-20, 15-45, 15-40, 15-35, 15- 30, 15-25, 15-20, 16-45, 16-40, 16-35, 16-30, 16-25, 16-20, 17-45, 17-40, 17-35, 17-30, 17-25, 17-20, 18-45, 18-40, 18-35, 18-30, 18-25, 18-20, 19-45, 19-40, 19-35, 19-30, 19-25, 19-20, e.g., 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33,
- complementary refers to the capacity for pairing between nucleobases of a first nucleic acid and a second nucleic acid.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent that is“substantially complementary to at least part of” a messenger RNA (mRNA) refers to an antisense polynucleotide agent that is substantially complementary to a contiguous portion of the mRNA of interest (e.g., an mRNA encoding IGFALS).
- mRNA messenger RNA
- a polynucleotide is complementary to at least a part of an IGFALS mRNA if the sequence is substantially complementary to a non-interrupted portion of an mRNA encoding IGFALS.
- region of complementarity refers to the region of the antisense polynucletiode agent that is substantially complementary to a sequence, for example a target sequence, e.g., an IGFALS nucleotide sequence, as defined herein.
- a target sequence e.g., an IGFALS nucleotide sequence
- the mismatches can be in the internal or terminal regions of the molecule.
- the most tolerated mismatches are in the terminal regions, e.g., within 5, 4, 3, or 2 nucleotides of the 5’- or 3’-terminus of the antisense polynucleotide.
- the term“complementary,” when used to describe a first nucleotide sequence in relation to a second nucleotide sequence refers to the ability of a polynucleotide comprising the first nucleotide sequence to hybridize and form a duplex structure under certain conditions with the second nucleotide sequence, as will be understood by the skilled person.
- Such conditions can, for example, be stringent conditions, where stringent conditions can include: 400 mM NaCl, 40 mM PIPES pH 6.4, 1 mM EDTA, 50 o C or 70 o C for 12-16 hours followed by washing (see, e.g.,“Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Sambrook, et al.
- Complementary sequences include those nucleotide sequences of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention that base-pair to a second nucleotide sequence over the entire length of one or both nucleotide sequences. Such sequences can be referred to as“fully complementary” with respect to each other herein. However, where a first sequence is referred to as“substantially complementary” with respect to a second sequence herein, the two sequences can be fully complementary, or they can form one or more, but generally not more than 5, 4, 3, or 2 mismatched base pairs upon hybridization for a duplex up to 30 base pairs, while retaining the ability to hybridize under the conditions most relevant to their ultimate application, e.g., antisense inhibition of target gene expression.
- “Complementary” sequences can also include, or be formed entirely from, non-Watson-Crick base pairs or base pairs formed from non-natural and modified nucleotides, in so far as the above requirements with respect to their ability to hybridize are fulfilled.
- Such non-Watson- Crick base pairs include, but are not limited to, G:U Wobble or Hoogstein base pairing.
- strand comprising a sequence refers to an oligonucleotide comprising a chain of nucleotides that is described by the sequence referred to using the standard nucleotide nomenclature.
- G,”“C,”“A,”“T,” and“U” each generally stand for a nucleotide that contains guanine, cytosine, adenine, thymidine and uracil as a base, respectively.
- the terms“deoxyribonucleotide”,“ribonucleotide” and“nucleotide” can also refer to a modified nucleotide, as further detailed below, or a surrogate replacement moiety (see, e.g., Table 2).
- nucleotide comprising inosine as its base can base pair with nucleotides containing adenine, cytosine, or uracil.
- nucleotides containing uracil, guanine, or adenine can be replaced in the nucleotide sequences of the agents featured in the invention by a nucleotide containing, for example, inosine.
- adenine and cytosine anywhere in the oligonucleotide can be replaced with guanine and uracil, respectively to form G-U Wobble base pairing with the target mRNA. Sequences containing such replacement moieties are suitable for the compositions and methods featured in the invention.
- A“nucleoside” is a base-sugar combination.
- The“nucleobase” (also known as“base”) portion of the nucleoside is normally a heterocyclic base moiety.
- “Nucleotides” are nucleosides that further include a phosphate group covalently linked to the sugar portion of the nucleoside.
- the phosphate group can be linked to the 2′, 3′, or 5′ hydroxyl moiety of the sugar.
- “Polynucleotides,” also referred to as“oligonucleotides,” are formed through the covalent linkage of adjacent nucleosides to one another, to form a linear polymeric oligonucleotide.
- the phosphate groups are commonly referred to as forming the internucleoside linkages of the polynucleotide.
- an“antisense polynucleotide agent” may include nucleotides (e.g., ribonucleotides or deoxyribonucleotides) with chemical modifications; an antisense polynucleotide agent may include substantial modifications at multiple nucleotides.
- modified nucleotide refers to a nucleotide having, independently, a modified sugar moiety, a modified internucleotide linkage, or modified nucleobase.
- modified nucleotide encompasses substitutions, additions or removal of, e.g., a functional group or atom, to internucleoside linkages, sugar moieties, or nucleobases.
- the modifications suitable for use in the antisense polynucleiotde agents of the invention include all types of modifications disclosed herein or known in the art. Any such modifications, as used in nucleotides, are encompassed by “antisense polynucleotide agent” for the purposes of this specification and claims.
- a“subject” is an animal, such as a mammal, including a primate (such as a human, a non-human primate, e.g., a monkey, and a chimpanzee), a non-primate (such as a cow, a pig, a camel, a llama, a horse, a goat, a rabbit, a sheep, a hamster, a guinea pig, a cat, a dog, a rat, a mouse, a horse, and a whale), or a bird (e.g., a duck or a goose).
- a primate such as a human, a non-human primate, e.g., a monkey, and a chimpanzee
- a non-primate such as a cow, a pig, a camel, a llama, a horse, a goat, a rabbit, a sheep, a hamster,
- the subject is a human, such as a human being treated or assessed for a disease, disorder, or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression; a human at risk for a disease, disorder, or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression; or a human having a disease, disorder or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the terms“treating” or“treatment” refer to a beneficial or desired result including, but not limited to, alleviation or amelioration of one or more symptoms associated with e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer. "Treatment” can also mean prolonging survival as compared to expected survival in the absence of treatment.
- the term“lower” or“reduce” and the like in the context of the level of an IGFALS in a subject or a disease marker or symptom refers to a statistically significant decrease in such level. The decrease can be, for example, at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, or 95%.
- the decrease is down to a level accepted as within the range of normal for an individual without such disorder which can also be referred to as a normalization of a level.
- a normalization of a level For example, lowering cholesterol to 180 mg/dl or lower would be considered to be within the range of normal for a subject.
- the reduction is the normalization of the level of a sign or symptom of a disease, a reduction in the difference between the subject level of a sign of the disease and the normal level of the sign for the disease (e.g., upper level of normal, lower level of normal, average of upper and lower level of normal).
- reduction can be understood as normalization of blood pressure, decreasing an elevated blood pressure or increasing a low blood pressure to reduce the difference from a normal reading.
- prevention or“preventing,” when used in reference to a disease, disorder or condition thereof, that would benefit from a reduction in expression of an IGFALS gene or production of IGFALS protein refers to a reduction in the likelihood that a subject will develop a symptom associated with such a disease, disorder, or condition, e.g., a symptom of IGFALS gene expression, such as the presence of elevated levels of proteins in the IGF signaling pathway, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the failure to develop a disease, disorder or condition, or the reduction in the development of a symptom or comorbidity associated with such a disease, disorder or condition e.g., by at least about 10% on a clinically accepted scale for that disease or disorder
- the exhibition of delayed symptoms or disease progression e.g., delayed cancer progression as determined using RECIST criteria
- IGFALS-associated disease is a disease or disorder that is caused by, or associated with IGFALS gene expression or IGFALS protein production.
- IGFALS-associated disease includes a disease, disorder or condition that would benefit from a decrease in IGFALS gene expression, replication, or protein activity.
- IGFALS-associated diseases include, for example, acromegaly, gigantism (a type of acromegaly, which refers to excess GH secretion that occurs during childhood when growth plates are open, leading to accelerated growth), and cancer, especially metastatic cancer.
- an IGFALS-associated disease is acromegaly. In some embodiments, an IGFALS-associated disease is gigantism. In other embodiments, an IGFALS-associated disease is cancer.
- the present invention provides polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, and compositions comprising such agents, which target an IGFALS gene and inhibit the expression of the IGFALS gene.
- the polynucleotide agents e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents
- inhibit the expression of an IGFALS gene in a cell such as a cell within a subject, e.g., a mammal, such as a human having an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the polynucleotde agents of the invention include a region of complementarity which is complementary to at least a part of an mRNA formed in the expression of an IGFALS gene.
- the region of complementarity may be about 50 nucleotides or less in length (e.g., 22-12, 20-14, 50, 49, 48, 47, 46, 45, 44, 43, 42, 41, 40, 39, 38, 37, 36, 35, 34, 33, 32, 31, 30, 29, 28, 27, 26, 25, 24, 23, 22, 21, 20, 19, 18, 17, 16, 15, 14, 13, 12, 11, or 10 nucleotides or less in length).
- the antisense polynucleotide agent Upon contact with a cell expressing the IGFALS gene, the antisense polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene (e.g., a human, a primate, a non-primate, or a bird IGFALS gene) by at least 20% as assayed by, for example, a PCR or branched DNA (bDNA)-based method, or by a protein-based method, such as by immunofluorescence analysis, using, for example, western blotting, or flow cytometric techniques.
- the inhibition of expression is determined at a 10 nM concetration using the cell line, delivery method, and qPCR method provided in Example 2 herein.
- the polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene by at least 40% by the assay in Example 2. In certain embodiments, the polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene by at least 40% by the assay in Example 2.
- the region of complementarity between an antisense polynucleotide agent and a target sequence may be substantially complementary (e.g., there is a sufficient degree of complementarity between the antisense polynucleotide agent and a target nucleic acid to so that they specifically hybridize and induce a desired effect), but is generally fully complementary to the target sequence.
- the target sequence can be derived from the sequence of an mRNA formed during the expression of an IGFALS gene.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention specifically hybridizes to a target nucleic acid molecule, such as the mRNA encoding IGFALS, and comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence which corresponds to the reverse complement of a nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be substantially complementary to the target sequence.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent that is substantially complementary to the target sequence may include a contiguous nucleotide sequence comprising no more than 5 mismatches (e.g., no more than 1, no more than 2, no more than 3, no more than 4, or no more than 5 mismatches) when hybridizing to a target sequence, such as to the corresponding region of a nucleic acid which encodes a mammalian IGFALS mRNA.
- the contiguous nucleotide sequence comprises no more than a single mismatch when hybridizing to the target sequence, such as the corresponding region of a nucleic acid which encodes a mammalian IGFALS mRNA.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention that are substantially complementary to the target sequence comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence which is at least 80% complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, such as at least 85%, 90%, 95%, or 100% complementary.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence which is fully complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs: 1-5 (or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5).
- the nucleotide sequence of an antisense polynucleotide agent is fully complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of nucleotides 1-20 of GenBank Accession No. GI: 225579150 (SEQ ID NO:1) (see, e.g., Table 3 or 5).
- An antisense polynucleotide agent may comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence of about 4 to 50 nucleotides in length, or any subrange falling within that range, e.g., about 8-49, 8-48, 8-47, 8- 46, 8-45, 8-44, 8-43, 8-42, 8-41, 8-40, 8-39, 8-38, 8-37, 8-36, 8-35, 8-34, 8-33, 8-32, 8-31, 8-30, 8-29, 8-28, 8-27, 8-26, 8-25, 8-24, 8-23, 8-22, 8-21, 8-20, 8-19, 8-18, 8-17, 8-16, 8-15, 8-14, 8-13, 8-12, 8- 11, 8-10, 8-9, 10-49, 10-48, 10-47, 10-46, 10-45, 10-44, 10-43, 10-42, 10-41, 10-40, 10-39, 10-38, 10- 37, 10-36, 10-35, 10-34, 10-33, 10-32,
- an antisense polynucleotide agent may comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence of no more than 22 nucleotides, e.g., no more than any of 21 nucleotides, 20 nucleotides, 19 nucleotides, no more than 18 nucleotides, 17 nucleotides, 16 nucleotides, than 15 nucleotides, or 14 nucleotides.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are 20 nucleotides in length.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are 14 nucleotides in length.
- the polynucleotide is at least 12 nucleotides in length.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention includes a sequence selected from sequences provided in Table 3 or Table 5. It will be understood that, although the sequences in Table 5 are described as modified or conjugated sequences, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, may also comprise any one of the sequences set forth in Table 5 that is un-modified, un- conjugated, or modified or conjugated differently than described therein.
- antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may include one of the sequences of Table 3 or 5 minus only a few nucleotides on one or both ends and yet remain similarly effective as compared to the antisense polynucleotide agents described above.
- antisense polynucleotide agents having a sequence of at least 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14,15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 contiguous nucleotides derived from one of the sequences of Table 3 or 5 and differing in their ability to inhibit the expression of an IGFALS gene by not more than 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, or 30% inhibition from an antisense polynucleotide agent comprising the full sequence, are contemplated to be within the scope of the present invention.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents provided in Table 3 and 5 identify a region(s) in an IGFALS transcript that is susceptible to antisense inhibition (e.g., the regions encompassed by the start and end positions relative to the in nucleotide sequences in Table 3, or at least 14 contiguous nucleotides of residues 23-42, 87-106, 121-207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417- 470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132- 1163,1220-1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1).
- the present invention further features antisense polynucleotide agents that target within one of these sites.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent is said to target within a particular site of an RNA transcript if the antisense polynucleotide agent promotes antisense inhibition of the target at that site.
- Such an antisense polynucleotide agent will generally include at least 14 contiguous nucleotides from one of the sequences provided in Table 3 or 5 coupled to additional nucleotide sequences taken from the region contiguous to the selected sequence in an IGFALS gene.
- target sequence is generally 4-50 nucleotides in length
- suitability of particular sequences in this range for directing antisense inhibition of any given target RNA there is wide variation in the suitability of particular sequences in this range for directing antisense inhibition of any given target RNA.
- Various software packages and the guidelines set out herein provide guidance for the identification of optimal target sequences for any given gene target, but an empirical approach can also be taken in which a“window” or“mask” of a given size (as a non-limiting example, 20 nucleotides) is literally or figuratively (including, e.g., in silico) placed on the target RNA sequence to identify sequences in the size range that can serve as target sequences.
- the next potential target sequence can be identified, until the complete set of possible sequences is identified for any given target size selected.
- This process coupled with systematic synthesis and testing of the identified sequences (using assays as described herein or as known in the art) to identify those sequences that perform optimally can identify those RNA sequences that, when targeted with an antisense polynucleotide agent, mediate the best inhibition of target gene expression.
- sequences identified for example, in Table 3 or 5 represent effective target sequences
- further optimization of antisense inhibition efficiency can be achieved by progressively“walking the window” one nucleotide upstream or downstream of the given sequences to identify sequences with equal or better inhibition characteristics.
- Such optimized sequences can be adjusted by, e.g., the introduction of modified nucleotides as described herein or as known in the art, addition or changes in length, or other modifications as known in the art or discussed herein to further optimize the molecule (e.g., increasing serum stability or circulating half-life, increasing thermal stability, enhancing transmembrane delivery, targeting to a particular location or cell type, increasing interaction with silencing pathway enzymes, increasing release from endosomes) as an expression inhibitor.
- modified nucleotides as described herein or as known in the art, addition or changes in length, or other modifications as known in the art or discussed herein to further optimize the molecule (e.g., increasing serum stability or circulating half-life, increasing thermal stability, enhancing transmembrane delivery, targeting to a particular location or cell type, increasing interaction with silencing pathway enzymes, increasing release from endosomes) as an expression inhibitor.
- the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention are un-modified, and do not comprise, e.g., chemical modifications or conjugations known in the art and described herein.
- at least one of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention is chemically modified to enhance stability or other beneficial characteristics.
- substantially all of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention are modified.
- all of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention are modified.
- Antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention in which“substantially all of the nucleotides are modified” are largely but not wholly modified and can include not more than 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 unmodified nucleotides.
- Exemplary modified antisense polynucleotide agents are provided in Table 5.
- nucleic acids featured in the invention can be synthesized or modified by standard methods known in the art as further discussed below, e.g., solution-phase or solid-phase organic synthesis or both, e.g., by use of an automated DNA synthesizer, such as are commercially available from, for example, Biosearch, Applied Biosystems, Inc.
- an automated DNA synthesizer such as are commercially available from, for example, Biosearch, Applied Biosystems, Inc.
- Well-established methods for the synthesis or modification of the nucleic acids featured in the invention are described in, for example,“Current protocols in nucleic acid chemistry,” Beaucage, S.L. et al. (Edrs.), John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, NY, USA, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference.
- Modifications include, for example, end modifications, e.g., 5’-end modifications (phosphorylation, conjugation, inverted linkages) or 3’-end modifications (conjugation, DNA nucleotides, inverted linkages, etc.); base modifications, e.g., replacement with stabilizing bases, destabilizing bases, or bases that base pair with an expanded repertoire of partners, removal of bases (abasic nucleotides), or conjugated bases; sugar modifications (e.g., at the 2’-position or 4’-position) or replacement of the sugar; or backbone modifications, including modification or replacement of the phosphodiester linkages.
- end modifications e.g., 5’-end modifications (phosphorylation, conjugation, inverted linkages) or 3’-end modifications (conjugation, DNA nucleotides, inverted linkages, etc.
- base modifications e.g., replacement with stabilizing bases, destabilizing bases, or bases that base pair with an expanded repertoire of partners, removal of bases (abasic nucleot
- modified nucleotides useful in the embodiments described herein include, but are not limited to nucleotides containing modified backbones or no natural
- nucleotides having modified backbones include, among others, those that do not have a phosphorus atom in the backbone.
- modified nucleotides that do not have a phosphorus atom in their internucleoside backbone can also be considered to be oligonucleosides.
- a modified antisense polynucleotide agent will have a phosphorus atom in its internucleoside backbone.
- Modified nucleotide backbones include, for example, phosphorothioates, chiral phosphorothioates, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkylphosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3'-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3'-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkylphosphonates, thionoalkylphosphotriesters, and
- boranophosphates having normal 3'-5' linkages, 2'-5'-linked analogs of these, and those having inverted polarity wherein the adjacent pairs of nucleoside units are linked 3'-5' to 5'-3' or 2'-5' to 5'-2'.
- Various salts, mixed salts and free acid forms are also included.
- Modified nucleotide backbones that do not include a phosphorus atom therein have backbones that are formed by short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl internucleoside linkages, mixed heteroatoms and alkyl or cycloalkyl internucleoside linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic internucleoside linkages. These include those having morpholino linkages (formed in part from the sugar portion of a nucleoside); siloxane backbones; sulfide, sulfoxide and sulfone backbones;
- formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; alkene containing backbones; sulfamate backbones; methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones; sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones; amide backbones; and others having mixed N, O, S and CH 2 component parts.
- suitable nucleotide mimetics are contemplated for use in antisense polynucleotide agents, in which both the sugar and the internucleoside linkage, i.e., the backbone, of the nucleotide units are replaced with novel groups.
- the base units are maintained for hybridization with an appropriate nucleic acid target compound.
- a peptide nucleic acid PNA
- PNA peptide nucleic acid
- the sugar backbone of an RNA is replaced with an amide containing backbone, in particular an aminoethylglycine backbone.
- nucleobases are retained and are bound directly or indirectly to aza nitrogen atoms of the amide portion of the backbone.
- Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Patent Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference. Additional PNA compounds suitable for use in the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are described in, for example, in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497-1500.
- Some embodiments featured in the invention include polynucleotides with phosphorothioate backbones and oligonucleosides with heteroatom backbones, and in particular --CH 2 --NH--CH 2 -, -- CH 2 --N(CH 3 )--O--CH 2 --[known as a methylene (methylimino) or MMI backbone], --CH 2 --O-- N(CH 3 )--CH 2 --, --CH 2 --N(CH 3 )--N(CH 3 )--CH 2 -- and --N(CH 3 )--CH 2 --CH 2 --[wherein the native phosphodiester backbone is represented as --O--P--O--CH 2 --] of the above-referenced U.S.
- Patent No. 5,489,677 and the amide backbones of the above-referenced U.S. Patent No.5,602,240.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents featured herein have morpholino backbone structures of the above-referenced U.S. Patent No.5,034,506.
- Modified nucleotides can also contain one or more modified or substituted sugar moieties.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents featured herein can include one of the following at the 2'- position: OH; F; O-, S-, or N-alkyl; O-, S-, or N-alkenyl; O-, S- or N-alkynyl; or O-alkyl-O-alkyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl and alkynyl can be substituted or unsubstituted C 1 to C 10 alkyl or C 2 to C 10 alkenyl and alkynyl.
- Exemplary suitable modifications include O[(CH 2 ) n O] m CH 3 , O(CH 2 ).
- n OCH 3 O(CH 2 ) n NH 2 , O(CH 2 ) n CH 3 , O(CH 2 ) n ONH 2 , and O(CH 2 ) n ON[(CH 2 ) n CH 3 )] 2 , where n and m are from 1 to 10.
- antisense polynucleotide agents include one of the following at the 2' position: C 1 to C 10 lower alkyl, substituted lower alkyl, alkaryl, aralkyl, O-alkaryl or O-aralkyl, SH, SCH 3 , OCN, Cl, Br, CN, CF 3 , OCF 3 , SOCH 3 , SO 2 CH 3 , ONO 2 , NO 2 , N 3 , NH 2 , heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkaryl, aminoalkylamino, polyalkylamino, substituted silyl, an RNA cleaving group, a reporter group, an intercalator, a group for improving the pharmacokinetic properties of an antisense polynucleotide, or a group for improving the pharmacodynamic properties of an antisense
- the modification includes a 2'-methoxyethoxy (2'-O--CH 2 CH 2 OCH 3 , also known as 2'-O-(2- methoxyethyl) or 2'-MOE) (Martin et al., Helv. Chim. Acta, 1995, 78:486-504) i.e., an alkoxy-alkoxy group.
- 2'-dimethylaminooxyethoxy i.e., a O(CH 2 ) 2 ON(CH 3 ) 2 group, also known as 2'-DMAOE, as described in examples herein below
- 2'- dimethylaminoethoxyethoxy also known in the art as 2'-O-dimethylaminoethoxyethyl or 2'- DMAEOE
- 2'-O--CH 2 --O--CH 2 --N(CH 2 ) 2 is 2'-dimethylaminooxyethoxy
- nucleotides having modified or substituted sugar moieties for use in the polynucleotide agents of the invention include nucleotides comprising a bicyclic sugar.
- A“bicyclic sugar” is a furanosyl ring modified by the bridging of two atoms.
- A“bicyclic nucleoside” (“BNA”) is a nucleoside having a sugar moiety comprising a bridge connecting two carbon atoms of the sugar ring, thereby forming a bicyclic ring system.
- the bridge connects the 4′- carbon and the 2′-carbon of the sugar ring.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent may include one or more locked nucleic acids.
- A“locked nucleic acid” is a nucleotide having a modified ribose moiety in which the ribose moiety comprises an extra bridge connecting the 2' and 4' carbons.
- an LNA is a nucleotide comprising a bicyclic sugar moiety comprising a 4'-CH 2 -O-2' bridge. This structure effectively "locks" the ribose in the 3'-endo structural conformation.
- the addition of locked nucleic acids to santisense polynucleotide agents has been shown to increase santisense polynucleotide agent stability in serum, and to reduce off-target effects (Elmen, J.
- bicyclic nucleosides for use in the polynucleotides of the invention include without limitation nucleosides comprising a bridge between the 4′ and the 2′ ribosyl ring atoms.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention include one or more bicyclic nucleosides comprising a 4′ to 2′ bridge.
- 4′ to 2′ bridged bicyclic nucleosides include but are not limited to 4′-(CH2)—O-2′ (LNA); 4′-(CH2)—S-2′; 4′-(CH2)2—O-2′ (ENA); 4′-CH(CH3)—O-2′ (also referred to as“constrained ethyl” or“cEt”) and 4′- CH(CH2OCH3)—O-2′ (and analogs thereof; see, e.g., U.S. Pat.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent can include one or more constrained ethyl nucleotides.
- a "constrained ethyl nucleotide” or “cEt” is a locked nucleic acid comprising a bicyclic sugar moiety comprising a 4'-CH(CH 3 )-O-2' bridge.
- a constrained ethyl nucleotide is in an S conformation and is referred to as an“S- constrained ethyl nucleotide” or“S-cEt.”
- Modified nucleotides included in the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention can also contain one or more sugar mimetics.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may include a “modified tetrahydropyran nucleotide” or“modified THP nucleotide.”
- A“modified tetrahydropyran nucleotide” has a six-membered tetrahydropyran“sugar” substituted in for the pentofuranosyl residue in normal nucleotides (a sugar surrogate).
- Modified THP nucleotides include, but are not limited to, what is referred to in the art as hexitol nucleic acid (HNA), anitol nucleic acid (ANA), manitol nucleic acid (MNA) (see, e.g., Leumann, Bioorg. Med. Chem., 2002, 10, 841-854), or fluoro HNA (F-HNA).
- HNA hexitol nucleic acid
- ANA anitol nucleic acid
- MNA manitol nucleic acid
- F-HNA fluoro HNA
- sugar surrogates comprise rings having more than 5 atoms and more than one heteroatom.
- nucleotides comprising morpholino sugar moieties and their use in oligomeric compounds has been reported (see for example: Braasch et al.,
- Morpholinos may be modified, for example by adding or altering various substituent groups from the above morpholino structure.
- Such sugar surrogates are referred to herein as“modified morpholinos.”
- Patent Application US2005- 0130923, published on Jun.16, 2005) or alternatively 5′-substitution of a bicyclic nucleic acid see PCT International Application WO 2007/134181, published on 11/22/07 wherein a 4′-CH2-0-2′ bicyclic nucleoside is further substituted at the 5′ position with a 5′-methyl or a 5′-vinyl group.
- PCT International Application WO 2007/134181 published on 11/22/07 wherein a 4′-CH2-0-2′ bicyclic nucleoside is further substituted at the 5′ position with a 5′-methyl or a 5′-vinyl group.
- carbocyclic bicyclic nucleosides along with their oligomerization and biochemical studies have also been described (see, e.g., Srivastava et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc.2007, 129(26), 8362-8379).
- antisense compounds comprise one or more modified cyclohexenyl nucleosides, which is a nucleoside having a six-membered cyclohexenyl in place of the
- Modified cyclohexenyl nucleosides include, but are not limited to those described in the art (see for example commonly owned, published PCT Application WO 2010/036696, published on Apr.10, 2010, Robeyns et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2008, 130(6), 1979-1984; Horvath et al., Tetrahedron Letters, 2007, 48, 3621-3623; Nauwelaerts et al., J. Am. Chem.
- An antisense polynucleotide agent can also include nucleobase modifications or substitutions.
- “unmodified” or“natural” nucleobases include the purine bases adenine (A) and guanine (G), and the pyrimidine bases thymine (T), cytosine (C) and uracil (U).
- Modified nucleobases include other synthetic and natural nucleobases such as deoxy-thymine (dT), 5-methylcytosine (5-me- C), 5-hydroxymethyl cytosine, xanthine, hypoxanthine, 2-aminoadenine, 6-methyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-propyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2- thiouracil, 2-thiothymine and 2-thiocytosine, 5-halouracil and cytosine, 5-propynyl uracil and cytosine, 6-azo uracil, cytosine and thymine, 5-uracil (pseudouracil), 4-thiouracil, 8-halo, 8-amino, 8- thiol, 8-thioalkyl, 8-hydroxyl anal other 8-substituted adenines and guanines, 5-halo, particularly 5- bromo
- nucleobases include those disclosed in U.S. Patent No.3,687,808, those disclosed in“Modified Nucleosides in Biochemistry,” Biotechnology and Medicine, Herdewijn, P. ed. Wiley-VCH, 2008; those disclosed in The Concise Encyclopedia Of Polymer Science And Engineering, pages 858-859, Kroschwitz, J. L, ed. John Wiley & Sons, 1990, these disclosed by Englisch et al., Angewandte Chemie, International Edition, 1991, 30, 613, and those disclosed by Sanghvi, Y S., Chapter 15, antisense polynucleotide agent Research and
- nucleobases are particularly useful for increasing the binding affinity of the agents featured in the invention.
- These include 5-substituted pyrimidines, 6-azapyrimidines and N-2, N-6 and 0-6 substituted purines, including 2-aminopropyladenine, 5-propynyluracil and 5-propynylcytosine.5- methylcytosine substitutions have been shown to increase nucleic acid duplex stability by 0.6-1.2°C (Sanghvi, Y. S., Crooke, S. T.
- One or more of the nucleotides of an iRNA of the invention may also include a
- A“hydroxymethyl substituted nucleotide” is an acyclic 2’-3’- seco-nucleotide, also referred to as an“unlocked nucleic acid” (“UNA”) modification.
- Additional modification which may potentially stabilize the ends of antisense polynucleotide agents can include N- (acetylaminocaproyl)-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6-NHAc), N-(caproyl-4- hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6), N-(acetyl-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-NHAc), thymidine-2'-0- deoxythymidine (ether), N-(aminocaproyl)-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6-amino), 2-docosanoyl- uridine-3"- phosphate, inverted base dT(idT) and others. Disclosure of this modification can be found in US20120142101.
- any of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be optionally conjugated with a GalNAc derivative ligand, as described below.
- an agent that contains conjugations of one or more carbohydrate moieties to an antisense polynucleotide agent can optimize one or more properties of the agent.
- the carbohydrate moiety will be attached to a modified subunit of the antisense polynucleotide agent.
- the ribose sugar of one or more ribonucleotide subunits of an agent can be replaced with another moiety, e.g., a non-carbohydrate (preferably cyclic) carrier to which is attached a carbohydrate ligand.
- a ribonucleotide subunit in which the ribose sugar of the subunit has been so replaced is referred to herein as a ribose replacement modification subunit (RRMS).
- a cyclic carrier may be a carbocyclic ring system, i.e., all ring atoms are carbon atoms, or a heterocyclic ring system, i.e., one or more ring atoms may be a heteroatom, e.g., nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur.
- the cyclic carrier may be a monocyclic ring system, or may contain two or more rings, e.g. fused rings.
- the cyclic carrier may be a fully saturated ring system, or it may contain one or more double bonds.
- the ligand may be attached to the polynucleotide via a carrier.
- the carriers include (i) at least one“backbone attachment point,” preferably two“backbone attachment points” and (ii) at least one “tethering attachment point.”
- A“backbone attachment point” as used herein refers to a functional group, e.g. a hydroxyl group, or generally, a bond available for, and that is suitable for incorporation of the carrier into the backbone, e.g., the phosphate, or modified phosphate, e.g., sulfur containing, backbone, of a ribonucleic acid.
- A“tethering attachment point” in some embodiments refers to a constituent ring atom of the cyclic carrier, e.g., a carbon atom or a heteroatom (distinct from an atom which provides a backbone attachment point), that connects a selected moiety.
- the moiety can be, e.g., a carbohydrate, e.g. monosaccharide, disaccharide, trisaccharide, tetrasaccharide, oligosaccharide and polysaccharide.
- the selected moiety is connected by an intervening tether to the cyclic carrier.
- the cyclic carrier will often include a functional group, e.g., an amino group, or generally, provide a bond, that is suitable for incorporation or tethering of another chemical entity, e.g., a ligand to the constituent ring.
- a functional group e.g., an amino group
- another chemical entity e.g., a ligand to the constituent ring.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents may be conjugated to a ligand via a carrier, wherein the carrier can be cyclic group or acyclic group; preferably, the cyclic group is selected from pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolinyl, imidazolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, [1,3]dioxolane, oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, morpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, quinoxalinyl, pyridazinonyl, tetrahydrofuryl and and decalin; preferably, the acyclic group is selected from serinol backbone or diethanolamine backbone.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the methods of the invention is an agent selected from the group of agents listed in Table 3 or 5. These agents may further comprise a ligand, as described below.
- At least one of the contiguous nucleotides of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be a modified nucleotide.
- the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified sugars.
- the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified nucleobases.
- the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified internucleoside linkages.
- the modifications sugar modifications, nucleobase modifications, or linkage modifications
- the patterns of modifications of sugar moieties, internucleoside linkages, and nucleobases are each independent of one another.
- Antisense polynucleotide agents having modified oligonucleotides arranged in patterns, or motifs may, for example, confer to the agents properties such as enhanced inhibitory activity, increased binding affinity for a target nucleic acid, or resistance to degradation by in vivo nucleases.
- such agents may contain at least one region modified so as to confer increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid, or increased inhibitory activity.
- a second region of such agents may optionally serve as a substrate for the cellular endonuclease RNase H, which cleaves the RNA strand of an RNA:DNA duplex.
- An exemplary antisense polynucleotide agent having modified oligonucleotides arranged in patterns, or motifs is a gapmer.
- a“gapmer” an internal region or "gap” having a plurality of linked nucleotides that supports RNaseH cleavage is positioned between two external flanking regions or "wings” having a plurality of linked nucleotides that are chemically distinct from the linked nucleotides of the internal region.
- the gap segment generally serves as the substrate for endonuclease cleavage, while the wing segments comprise modified nucleotides.
- the three regions of a gapmer motif form a contiguous sequence of nucleotides and may be described as“X-Y-Z”, wherein“X” represents the length of the 5-wing,“Y” represents the length of the gap, and“Z” represents the length of the 3’- wing.
- a gapmer described as“X-Y-Z” has a configuration such that the gap segment is positioned immediately adjacent to each of the 5′ wing segment and the 3′ wing segment. Thus, no intervening nucleotides exist between the 5′ wing segment and gap segment, or the gap segment and the 3′ wing segment.
- Any of the antisense compounds described herein can have a gapmer motif.
- X and Z are the same, in other embodiments they are different.
- the regions of a gapmer are differentiated by the types of modified nucleotides in the region.
- the modified nucleotides of each of the wings may differ from at least some of the modified nucleotides of the gap.
- at least some of the modified nucleotides of each wing that are closest to the gap differ from the modified nucleotides of the neighboring gap nucleotides, thus defining the boundary between the wings and the gap.
- the modified nucleotides within the gap are the same as one another.
- the gap includes one or more modified nucleotides that differ from the modified nucleotides of one or more other nucleotides of the gap.
- the length of the 5'- wing (X) of a gapmer may be 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2 to 6, 2 to 5, 3 to 6, 3 to 5, 1 to 5, 1 to 4, 1 to 3, 2 to 4 nucleotides in length, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides in length.
- the length of the 3'- wing (Z) of a gapmer may be 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2 to 6, 2- 5, 3 to 6, 3 to 5, 1 to 5, 1 to 4, 1 to 3, 2 to 4 nucleotides in length, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides in length.
- the length of the gap (Y) of a gapmer may be 5 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 5 to 13, 5 to 12, 5 to 11, 5 to 10, 5 to 9, 5 to 8, 5 to 7, 5 to 6, 6 to 14, 6 to 13, 6 to 12, 6 to 11, 6 to 10, 6 to 9, 6 to 8, 6 to 7, 7 to 14, 7 to 13, 7 to 12, 7 to 11, 7 to 10, 7 to 9, 7 to 8, 8 to 14, 8 to 13, 8 to 12, 8 to 11, 8 to 10, 8 to 9, 9 to 14, 9 to 13, 9 to 12, 9 to 11, 9 to 10, 10 to 14, 10 to 13, 10 to 12, 10 to 11, 11 to 14, 11 to 13, 11 to 12, 12 to 14, 12 to 13, or 13 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, or 14 nucleotides in length.
- X consists of 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 nucleotides
- Y consists of 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 nucleotides
- Z consists of 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 nucleotides.
- Such gapmers include (X-Y-Z) 2-7-2, 2-7-3, 2-7-4, 2-7-5, 2-7-6, 3-7-2, 3-7-3, 3-7-4, 3-7-5, 3-7-6, 4-7-3, 4-7-4, 4-7-5, 4-7-6, 5-7-3, 5-7-4, 5-7-5, 5-7-6, 6-7-3, 6-7-4, 6-7-5, 6-7-6, 3-7-3, 3-7-4, 3-7-5, 3-7-6, 4-7-3, 4-7-4, 4-7-5, 4- 7-6, 5-7-3, 5-7-4, 5-7-5, 5-7-6, 6-7-3, 6-7-4, 6-7-5, 6-7-6, 2-8-2, 2-8-3, 2-8-4, 2-8-5, 2-8-6, 3-8-2, 3-8- 3, 3-8-4, 3
- antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 5-10-5 gapmer motif. In other embodiments of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 4-10-4 gapmer motif. In another embodiment of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 3-10-3 gapmer motif. In yet other embodiments of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 2-10-2 gapmer motif.
- the 5'- wing or 3’-wing of a gapmer may independently include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
- the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least two modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least three modified nucleotides. In yet another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least four modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least five modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'-wing of a gapmer is a modified nucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least two modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least three modified nucleotides. In yet another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least four modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least five modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a modified nucleotide.
- the regions of a gapmer are differentiated by the types of sugar moieties of the nucleotides.
- the nucleotides of each distinct region comprise uniform sugar moieties.
- the nucleotides of each distinct region comprise different sugar moieties.
- the sugar nucleotide modification motifs of the two wings are the same as one another.
- the sugar nucleotide modification motifs of the 5'-wing differs from the sugar nucleotide modification motif of the 3'-wing.
- the 5’-wing of a gapmer may include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
- At least one modified nucleotide of the 5'-wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide, such as a constrained ethyl nucleotide, or an LNA.
- the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 bicyclic nucleotides.
- each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide.
- the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes at least 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 constrained ethyl nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a constrained ethyl nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one LNA nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 LNA nucleotides. In other embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is an LNA nucleotide.
- At least one modified nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a non- bicyclic modified nucleotide, e.g., a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
- A“2 '-substituted nucleotide” is a nucleotide comprising a modification at the 2’-position which is other than H or OH, such as a 2’- OMe nucleotide, or a 2’-MOE nucleotide.
- the 5’-wing of a gapmer comprises 2, 3, 4, or 52 '-substituted nucleotides.
- each nucleotide of the 5’-wing of a gapmer is a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
- the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’-OMe nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’-OMe nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’-OMe nucleotide.
- the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’- MOE nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’- MOE nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’- MOE nucleotide.
- the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a 2'-deoxynucleotide. In a certain embodiments, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one ribonucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a ribonucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer may include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
- At least one modified nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide, such as a constrained ethyl nucleotide, or an LNA.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 bicyclic nucleotides.
- each nucleotide of the 3’- wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one constrained ethyl nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 constrained ethyl nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a constrained ethyl nucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one LNA nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 LNA nucleotides. In other embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is an LNA nucleotide.
- At least one modified nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a non- bicyclic modified nucleotide, e.g., a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises 2, 3, 4, or 52 '-substituted nucleotides.
- each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
- the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’-OMe nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’-OMe nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’-OMe nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’- MOE nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’- MOE nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’- MOE nucleotide.
- the 3'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a 2'-deoxynucleotide. In a certain embodiments, the 3'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one ribonucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a ribonucleotide.
- the gap of a gapmer may include 5-14 modified nucleotides, e.g., 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, or 14 modified nucleotides.
- the gap of a gapmer comprises at least one 5-methylcytosine. In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, or 135- methylcytosines. In one embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the the gap of a gapmer are 5- methylcytosines.
- the gap of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, or 132'- deoxynucleotides. In one embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the the gap of a gapmer are 2'- deoxynucleotides.
- a gapmer may include one or more modified internucleotide linkages.
- a gapmer includes one or more phosphodiester internucleotide linkages.
- a gapmer includes one or more phosphorothioate internucleotide linkages.
- each nucleotide of a 5’-wing of a gapmer are linked via a
- each nucleotide of a 3’-wing of a gapmer are linked via a phosphorothioate internucleotide linkage.
- each nucleotide of a gap segment of a gapmer is linked via a phosphorothioate internucleotide linkage.
- all of the nucleotides in a gapmer are linked via phosphorothioate internucleotide linkages.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising 5 nucleotides.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides.
- each nucleotide of a 5-wing flanking a gap segment of 102′- deoxyribonucleotides comprises a modified nucleotide.
- each nucleotide of a 3-wing flanking a gap segment of 102′-deoxyribonucleotides comprises a modified nucleotide.
- each of the modified 5’-wing nucleotides and each of the modified 3’-wing nucleotides comprise a 2′-sugar modification.
- the 2′-sugar modification is a 2’- OMe modification.
- the 2′-sugar modification is a 2’-MOE modification.
- each of the modified 5’-wing nucleotides and each of the modified 3’-wing nucleotides comprise a bicyclic nucleotide.
- the bicyclic nucleotide is a constrained ethyl nucleotide.
- the bicyclic nucleotide is an LNA nucleotide.
- each cytosine in an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- the agent further comprises a ligand.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- the agent further comprises a ligand.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising five constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising five LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage.
- each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
- polynucleotide agents of the invention e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents
- moieties include but are not limited to lipid moieties such as a cholesterol moiety (Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acid. Sci. USA, 1989, 86: 6553-6556), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Biorg. Med. Chem.
- a thioether e.g., beryl-S-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306-309; Manoharan et al., Biorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765-2770), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl.
- a ligand alters the distribution, targeting, or lifetime of an antisense polynucleotide agent into which it is incorporated.
- a ligand provides an enhanced affinity for a selected target, e.g., molecule, cell, or cell type; compartment, e.g., a cellular or organ compartment, tissue, organ, or region of the body, as, e.g., compared to a species absent such a ligand.
- Preferred ligands will not take part in hybridization of an antisense polynucleotide agent to the targeted mRNA.
- Ligands can include a naturally occurring substance, such as a protein (e.g., human serum albumin (HSA), low-density lipoprotein (LDL), or globulin); carbohydrate (e.g., a dextran, pullulan, chitin, chitosan, inulin, cyclodextrin, N-acetylgalactosamine, or hyaluronic acid); or a lipid.
- the ligand can also be a recombinant or synthetic molecule, such as a synthetic polymer, e.g., a synthetic polyamino acid.
- polyamino acids examples include polyamino acid is a polylysine (PLL), poly L-aspartic acid, poly L-glutamic acid, styrene-maleic acid anhydride copolymer, poly(L-lactide- co-glycolied) copolymer, divinyl ether-maleic anhydride copolymer, N-(2- hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide copolymer (HMPA), polyethylene glycol (PEG), polyvinyl alcohol (PVA), polyurethane, poly(2-ethylacryllic acid), N-isopropylacrylamide polymers, or
- polyamines include: polyethylenimine, polylysine (PLL), spermine, spermidine, polyamine, pseudopeptide-polyamine, peptidomimetic polyamine, dendrimer polyamine, arginine, amidine, protamine, cationic lipid, cationic porphyrin, quaternary salt of a polyamine, or an alpha helical peptide.
- Ligands can also include targeting groups, e.g., a cell or tissue targeting agent, e.g., a lectin, glycoprotein, lipid, or protein, e.g., an antibody, that binds to a specified cell type such as a kidney cell.
- a cell or tissue targeting agent e.g., a lectin, glycoprotein, lipid, or protein, e.g., an antibody, that binds to a specified cell type such as a kidney cell.
- a targeting group can be a thyrotropin, melanotropin, lectin, glycoprotein, surfactant protein A, Mucin carbohydrate, multivalent lactose, multivalent galactose, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl- gulucoseamine multivalent mannose, multivalent fucose, glycosylated polyaminoacids, multivalent galactose, transferrin, bisphosphonate, polyglutamate, polyaspartate, a lipid, cholesterol, a steroid, bile acid, folate, vitamin B12, vitamin A, biotin, or an RGD peptide or RGD peptide mimetic.
- ligands include dyes, intercalating agents (e.g. acridines), cross-linkers (e.g. psoralene, mitomycin C), porphyrins (TPPC4, texaphyrin, Sapphyrin), polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., phenazine, dihydrophenazine), artificial endonucleases (e.g.
- intercalating agents e.g. acridines
- cross-linkers e.g. psoralene, mitomycin C
- porphyrins TPPC4, texaphyrin, Sapphyrin
- polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons e.g., phenazine, dihydrophenazine
- artificial endonucleases e.g.
- EDTA lipophilic molecules, e.g., cholesterol, cholic acid, adamantane acetic acid, 1-pyrene butyric acid, dihydrotestosterone, 1,3-Bis-O(hexadecyl)glycerol, geranyloxyhexyl group, hexadecylglycerol, borneol, menthol, 1,3-propanediol, heptadecyl group, palmitic acid, myristic acid,O3- (oleoyl)lithocholic acid, O3-(oleoyl)cholenic acid, dimethoxytrityl, or phenoxazine)and peptide conjugates (e.g., antennapedia peptide, Tat peptide), alkylating agents, phosphate, amino, mercapto, PEG (e.g., PEG-40K), MPEG, [MPEG] 2 , polyamino, alkyl,
- biotin e.g., aspirin, vitamin E, folic acid
- transport/absorption facilitators e.g., aspirin, vitamin E, folic acid
- synthetic ribonucleases e.g., imidazole, bisimidazole, histamine, imidazole clusters, acridine- imidazole conjugates, Eu3+ complexes of tetraazamacrocycles), dinitrophenyl, HRP, or AP.
- Ligands can be proteins, e.g., glycoproteins, or peptides, e.g., molecules having a specific affinity for a co-ligand, or antibodies e.g., an antibody, that binds to a specified cell type such as a hepatic cell.
- Ligands can also include hormones and hormone receptors. They can also include non- peptidic species, such as lipids, lectins, carbohydrates, vitamins, cofactors, multivalent lactose, multivalent galactose, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-gulucosamine multivalent mannose, or multivalent fucose.
- the ligand can be, for example, a lipopolysaccharide, an activator of p38 MAP kinase, or an activator of NF- ⁇ B.
- the ligand can be a substance, e.g., a drug, which can increase the uptake of the antisense polynucleotide agent into the cell, for example, by disrupting the cell’s cytoskeleton, e.g., by disrupting the cell’s microtubules, microfilaments, or intermediate filaments.
- the drug can be, for example, taxon, vincristine, vinblastine, cytochalasin, nocodazole, japlakinolide, latrunculin A, phalloidin, swinholide A, indanocine, or myoservin.
- a ligand attached to an antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein acts as a pharmacokinetic modulator (PK modulator).
- PK modulators include lipophiles, bile acids, steroids, phospholipid analogues, peptides, protein binding agents, PEG, vitamins etc.
- Exemplary PK modulators include, but are not limited to, cholesterol, fatty acids, cholic acid, lithocholic acid, dialkylglycerides, diacylglyceride, phospholipids, sphingolipids, naproxen, ibuprofen, vitamin E, biotin etc.
- Oligonucleotides that comprise a number of phosphorothioate linkages are also known to bind to serum protein, thus short oligonucleotides, e.g., oligonucleotides of 5 bases, 10 bases, 15 bases or 20 bases, comprising multiple of phosphorothioate linkages in the backbone are also amenable to the present invention as ligands (e.g. as PK modulating ligands).
- aptamers that bind serum components e.g. serum proteins
- PK modulating ligands are also suitable for use as PK modulating ligands in the embodiments described herein.
- Ligand-conjugated polynucleotides of the invention may be synthesized by the use of a polynucleotide that bears a pendant reactive functionality, such as that derived from the attachment of a linking molecule onto the oligonucleotide (described below).
- This reactive polynucleotide may be reacted directly with commercially-available ligands, ligands that are synthesized bearing any of a variety of protecting groups, or ligands that have a linking moiety attached thereto.
- polynucleotides used in the conjugates of the present invention may be conveniently and routinely made through the well-known technique of solid-phase synthesis.
- Equipment for such synthesis is sold by several vendors including, for example, Applied Biosystems (Foster City, Calif.). Any other means for such synthesis known in the art may additionally or alternatively be employed. It is also known to use similar techniques to prepare other polynucleotides, such as the
- the polynucleotides and polynucleosides may be assembled on a suitable DNA synthesizer utilizing standard nucleotide or nucleoside precursors, or nucleotide or nucleoside conjugate precursors that already bear the linking moiety, ligand-nucleotide or nucleoside-conjugate precursors that already bear the ligand molecule, or non-nucleoside ligand- bearing building blocks.
- the synthesis of the sequence-specific linked nucleosides is typically completed, and the ligand molecule is then reacted with the linking moiety to form the ligand-conjugated oligonucleotide.
- the polynucleotides or linked nucleosides of the present invention are synthesized by an automated synthesizer using phosphoramidites derived from ligand-nucleoside conjugates in addition to the standard phosphoramidites and non-standard phosphoramidites that are commercially available and routinely used in oligonucleotide synthesis.
- the ligand or conjugate is a lipid or lipid-based molecule.
- a lipid or lipid-based molecule preferably binds a serum protein, e.g., human serum albumin (HSA).
- HSA binding ligand allows for distribution of the conjugate to a target tissue, e.g., a non-kidney target tissue of the body.
- the target tissue can be the liver, including parenchymal cells of the liver.
- Other molecules that can bind HSA can also be used as ligands. For example, naproxen or aspirin can be used.
- a lipid or lipid-based ligand can (a) increase resistance to degradation of the conjugate, (b) increase targeting or transport into a target cell or cell membrane, or (c) can be used to adjust binding to a serum protein, e.g., HSA.
- a serum protein e.g., HSA.
- a lipid based ligand can be used to inhibit, e.g., control the binding of the conjugate to a target tissue.
- a lipid or lipid-based ligand that binds to HSA more strongly will be less likely to be targeted to the kidney and therefore less likely to be cleared from the body.
- a lipid or lipid-based ligand that binds to HSA less strongly can be used to target the conjugate to the kidney.
- the lipid based ligand binds HSA.
- it binds HSA with a sufficient affinity such that the conjugate will be preferably distributed to a non-kidney tissue.
- the affinity it is preferred that the affinity not be so strong that the HSA-ligand binding cannot be reversed.
- the lipid based ligand binds HSA weakly or not at all, such that the conjugate will be preferably distributed to the kidney.
- Other moieties that target to kidney cells can also be used in place of or in addition to the lipid based ligand.
- the ligand is a moiety, e.g., a vitamin, which is taken up by a target cell, e.g., a proliferating cell.
- a target cell e.g., a proliferating cell.
- vitamins include vitamin A, E, and K.
- Other exemplary vitamins include are B vitamin, e.g., folic acid, B12, riboflavin, biotin, pyridoxal or other vitamins or nutrients taken up by target cells such as liver cells.
- the ligand is a cell-permeation agent, preferably a helical cell-permeation agent.
- the agent is amphipathic.
- An exemplary agent is a peptide such as tat or antennopedia. If the agent is a peptide, it can be modified, including a peptidylmimetic, invertomers, non-peptide or pseudo-peptide linkages, and use of D-amino acids.
- the helical agent is preferably an alpha-helical agent, which preferably has a lipophilic and a lipophobic phase.
- the ligand can be a peptide or peptidomimetic.
- a peptidomimetic also referred to herein as an oligopeptidomimetic is a molecule capable of folding into a defined three-dimensional structure similar to a natural peptide. The attachment of peptide and peptidomimetics to antisense
- polynucleotide agents can affect pharmacokinetic distribution of the agent, such as by enhancing cellular recognition and absorption.
- the peptide or peptidomimetic moiety can be 5-50 amino acids long, e.g., 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, or 50 amino acids long.
- a peptide or peptidomimetic can be, for example, a cell permeation peptide, cationic peptide, amphipathic peptide, or hydrophobic peptide (e.g., consisting primarily of Tyr, Trp or Phe).
- the peptide moiety can be a dendrimer peptide, constrained peptide or crosslinked peptide.
- the peptide moiety can include a hydrophobic membrane translocation sequence (MTS).
- An exemplary hydrophobic MTS-containing peptide is RFGF having the amino acid sequence AAVALLPAVLLALLAP (SEQ ID NO: 7).
- An RFGF analogue e.g., amino acid sequence
- AALLPVLLAAP (SEQ ID NO:8) containing a hydrophobic MTS can also be a targeting moiety.
- the peptide moiety can be a“delivery” peptide, which can carry large polar molecules including peptides, oligonucleotides, and protein across cell membranes.
- sequences from the HIV Tat protein (GRKKRRQRRRPPQ (SEQ ID NO: 9) and the Drosophila Antennapedia protein (RQIKIWFQNRRMKWKK (SEQ ID NO:10) have been found to be capable of functioning as delivery peptides.
- a peptide or peptidomimetic can be encoded by a random sequence of DNA, such as a peptide identified from a phage-display library, or one-bead-one-compound (OBOC) combinatorial library (Lam et al., Nature, 354:82-84, 1991).
- OBOC one-bead-one-compound
- peptidomimetic tethered to an antisens epolynucleotide agent via an incorporated monomer unit for cell targeting purposes is an arginine-glycine-aspartic acid (RGD)-peptide, or RGD mimic.
- RGD arginine-glycine-aspartic acid
- a peptide moiety can range in length from 5 amino acids to 40 amino acids.
- the peptide moieties can have a structural modification, such as to increase stability or direct conformational properties. Any of the structural modifications described below can be utilized.
- RGD peptide for use in the compositions and methods of the invention may be linear or cyclic, and may be modified, e.g., glycosylated or methylated, to facilitate targeting to a specific tissue(s).
- RGD-containing peptides and peptidiomimemtics may include D-amino acids, as well as synthetic RGD mimics.
- A“cell permeation peptide” is capable of permeating a cell, e.g., a microbial cell, such as a bacterial or fungal cell, or a mammalian cell, such as a human cell.
- a microbial cell-permeating peptide can be, for example, an ⁇ -helical linear peptide (e.g., LL-37 or Ceropin P1), a disulfide bond- containing peptide (e.g., ⁇ -defensin, ⁇ -defensin or bactenecin), or a peptide containing only one or two dominating amino acids (e.g., PR-39 or indolicidin).
- a cell permeation peptide can also include a nuclear localization signal (NLS).
- NLS nuclear localization signal
- a cell permeation peptide can be a bipartite amphipathic peptide, such as MPG, which is derived from the fusion peptide domain of HIV-1 gp41 and the NLS of SV40 large T antigen (Simeoni et al., Nucl. Acids Res.31:2717-2724, 2003).
- an antisense polynucleotide agent further comprises a carbohydrate.
- the carbohydrate conjugated agents are advantageous for the in vivo delivery of nucleic acids, as well as compositions suitable for in vivo therapeutic use, as described herein (see, e.g., Prakash, et al. (2014) Nuc Acid Res doi
- “carbohydrate” refers to a compound which is either a carbohydrate per se made up of one or more monosaccharide units having at least 6 carbon atoms (which can be linear, branched or cyclic) with an oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur atom bonded to each carbon atom; or a compound having as a part thereof a carbohydrate moiety made up of one or more monosaccharide units each having at least six carbon atoms (which can be linear, branched or cyclic), with an oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur atom bonded to each carbon atom.
- Representative carbohydrates include the sugars (mono-, di-, tri- and oligosaccharides containing from 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 monosaccharide units), and polysaccharides such as starches, glycogen, cellulose and polysaccharide gums.
- Specific monosaccharides include C5 and above (e.g., C5, C6, C7, or C8) sugars; di- and trisaccharides include sugars having two or three monosaccharide units (e.g., C5, C6, C7, or C8).
- a carbohydrate conjugate for use in the compositions and methods of the invention is a monosaccharide.
- the monosaccharide is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) or a GalNAc derivative.
- a carbohydrate conjugate for use in the compositions and methods of the invention is selected from the rou consisting of:
- Another representative carbohydrate conjugate for use in the embodiments described herein includes, but is not limited to,
- the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a monovalent linker. In some embodiments, the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a bivalent linker. In yet other embodiments of the invention, the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a trivalent linker.
- the agents of the invention comprise one GalNAc or GalNAc derivative attached to the agent.
- the agents of the invention comprise a plurality (e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6) GalNAc or GalNAc derivatives, each independently attached to a plurality of nucleotides of the RNAi agent through a plurality of monovalent linkers.
- the carbohydrate conjugate further comprises one or more additional ligands as described above, such as, but not limited to, a PK modulator or a cell permeation peptide.
- the conjugate or ligand described herein can be attached to an antisense polynucleotide agent with various linkers that can be cleavable or non-cleavable.
- linker or“linking group” means an organic moiety that connects two parts of a compound, e.g., covalently attaches two parts of a compound.
- Linkers typically comprise a direct bond or an atom such as oxygen or sulfur, a unit such as NR8, C(O), C(O)NH, SO, SO 2 , SO 2 NH or a chain of atoms, such as, but not limited to, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkenyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkynyl, arylalkyl, arylalkenyl, arylalkynyl, heteroarylalkyl, heteroarylalkenyl, heteroarylalkynyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heterocyclylalkenyl, heterocyclylalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, alkylarylalkyl, alkylarylalkenyl, alkylarylalkynyl, alkenylarylalkyl, alkenylarylalkenyl,
- alkenylheterocyclylalkenyl alkenylheterocyclylalkynyl, alkynylheterocyclylalkyl,
- the linker is between 1-24 atoms or any subrange within that range, e.g., 2-24, 3-24, 4-24, 5-24, 6-24, 6-18, 7-18, 8-18, 7-17, 8- 17, 6-16, 7-16, or 8-16 atoms.
- a cleavable linking group is one which is sufficiently stable outside the cell, but which upon entry into a target cell is cleaved to release the two parts the linker is holding together.
- the cleavable linking group is cleaved at least 10 times, 20, times, 30 times, 40 times, 50 times, 60 times, 70 times, 80 times, 90 times or more, or at least 100 times faster in a target cell or under a first reference condition (which can, e.g., be selected to mimic or represent intracellular conditions) than in the blood of a subject, or under a second reference condition (which can, e.g., be selected to mimic or represent conditions found in the blood or serum).
- Cleavable linking groups are susceptible to cleavage agents, e.g., pH, redox potential or the presence of degradative molecules. Generally, cleavage agents are more prevalent or found at higher levels or activities inside cells than in serum or blood. Examples of such degradative agents include: redox agents which are selected for particular substrates or which have no substrate specificity, including, e.g., oxidative or reductive enzymes or reductive agents such as mercaptans, present in cells, that can degrade a redox cleavable linking group by reduction; esterases; endosomes or agents that can create an acidic environment, e.g., those that result in a pH of five or lower; enzymes that can hydrolyze or degrade an acid cleavable linking group by acting as a general acid, peptidases (which can be substrate specific), and phosphatases.
- redox agents which are selected for particular substrates or which have no substrate specificity, including, e.g.,
- a cleavable linkage group such as a disulfide bond can be susceptible to pH.
- the pH of human serum is 7.4, while the average intracellular pH is slightly lower, ranging from about 7.1-7.3.
- Endosomes have a more acidic pH, in the range of 5.5-6.0, and lysosomes have an even more acidic pH at around 5.0.
- Some linkers will have a cleavable linking group that is cleaved at a preferred pH, thereby releasing a cationic lipid from the ligand inside the cell, or into the desired compartment of the cell.
- a linker can include a cleavable linking group that is cleavable by a particular enzyme.
- the type of cleavable linking group incorporated into a linker can depend on the cell to be targeted.
- a liver-targeting ligand can be linked to a cationic lipid through a linker that includes an ester group.
- Liver cells are rich in esterases, and therefore the linker will be cleaved more efficiently in liver cells than in cell types that are not esterase-rich.
- Other cell-types rich in esterases include cells of the lung, renal cortex, and testis.
- Linkers that contain peptide bonds can be used when targeting cell types rich in peptidases, such as liver cells and synoviocytes.
- the suitability of a candidate cleavable linking group can be evaluated by testing the ability of a degradative agent (or condition) to cleave the candidate linking group. It will also be desirable to also test the candidate cleavable linking group for the ability to resist cleavage in the blood or when in contact with other non-target tissue.
- a degradative agent or condition
- the candidate cleavable linking group for the ability to resist cleavage in the blood or when in contact with other non-target tissue.
- the evaluations can be carried out in cell free systems, in cells, in cell culture, in organ or tissue culture, or in whole animals.
- useful candidate compounds are cleaved at least 2, 4, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 times faster in the cell (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic intracellular conditions) as compared to blood or serum (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic extracellular conditions).
- a cleavable linking group is a redox cleavable linking group that is cleaved upon reduction or oxidation.
- An example of reductively cleavable linking group is a disulphide linking group (-S-S-).
- a candidate cleavable linking group is a suitable “reductively cleavable linking group,” or for example is suitable for use with a particular antisense polynucleotide agent moiety and particular targeting agent one can look to methods described herein.
- a candidate can be evaluated by incubation with dithiothreitol (DTT), or other reducing agent using reagents know in the art, which mimic the rate of cleavage which would be observed in a cell, e.g., a target cell.
- the candidates can also be evaluated under conditions which are selected to mimic blood or serum conditions.
- candidate compounds are cleaved by at most 10% in the blood.
- useful candidate compounds are degraded at least 2, 4, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 times faster in the cell (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic intracellular conditions) as compared to blood (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic extracellular conditions).
- the rate of cleavage of candidate compounds can be determined using standard enzyme kinetics assays under conditions chosen to mimic intracellular media and compared to conditions chosen to mimic extracellular media.
- a cleavable linker comprises a phosphate-based cleavable linking group.
- a phosphate-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by agents that degrade or hydrolyze the phosphate group.
- An example of an agent that cleaves phosphate groups in cells are enzymes such as phosphatases in cells.
- phosphate-based linking groups are -O-P(O)(ORk)-O-, -O- P(S)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(S)(SRk)-O-, -S-P(O)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(O)(ORk)-S-, -S-P(O)(ORk)-S-, -O- P(S)(ORk)-S-, -S-P(S)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -O-P(S)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(
- Preferred embodiments are -O-P(O)(OH)-O-, -O-P(S)(OH)-O-, -O- P(S)(SH)-O-, -S-P(O)(OH)-O-, -O-P(O)(OH)-S-, -S-P(O)(OH)-S-, -O-P(S)(OH)-S-, -S-P(S)(OH)-O-, -O-P(O)(H)-O-, -O-P(S)(H)-O-, -S-P(O)(H)-O-, -S-P(O)(H)-O-, -S-P(O)(H)-S-, -O-P(S)(H)-S-, -O-P(S)(H)-S-.
- a preferred embodiment is -O-P(O)(OH)-O-.
- a cleavable linker comprises an acid cleavable linking group.
- An acid cleavable linking group is a linking group that is cleaved under acidic conditions.
- acid cleavable linking groups are cleaved in an acidic environment with a pH of 6.5 or lower (e.g., 6.0, 5.75, 5.5, 5.25, 5.0, or lower), or by agents such as enzymes that can act as a general acid.
- a pH of 6.5 or lower e.g., 6.0, 5.75, 5.5, 5.25, 5.0, or lower
- agents such as enzymes that can act as a general acid.
- specific low pH organelles such as endosomes and lysosomes can provide a cleaving environment for acid cleavable linking groups.
- Acid cleavable linking groups include but are not limited to hydrazones, esters, and esters of amino acids.
- a preferred embodiment is when the carbon attached to the oxygen of the ester (the alkoxy group) is an aryl group, substituted alkyl group, or tertiary alkyl group such as dimethyl pentyl or t-butyl.
- a cleavable linker comprises an ester-based cleavable linking group.
- An ester-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by enzymes such as esterases and amidases in cells.
- Examples of ester-based cleavable linking groups include but are not limited to esters of alkylene, alkenylene and alkynylene groups.
- Ester cleavable linking groups have the general formula -C(O)O-, or -OC(O)-. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above.
- a cleavable linker comprises a peptide-based cleavable linking group.
- a peptide-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by enzymes such as peptidases and proteases in cells.
- Peptide-based cleavable linking groups are peptide bonds formed between amino acids to yield oligopeptides (e.g., dipeptides, tripeptides etc.) and polypeptides.
- Peptide-based cleavable groups do not include the amide group (-C(O)NH-).
- the amide group can be formed between any alkylene, alkenylene or alkynelene.
- a peptide bond is a special type of amide bond formed between amino acids to yield peptides and proteins.
- the peptide based cleavage group is generally limited to the peptide bond (i.e., the amide bond) formed between amino acids yielding peptides and proteins and does not include the entire amide functional group.
- Peptide-based cleavable linking groups have the general formula– NHCHRAC(O)NHCHRBC(O)-, where RA and RB are the R groups of the two adjacent amino acids. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention is conjugated to a carbohydrate through a linker.
- Non-limiting examples of antisense polynucleotide agent carbohydrate conjugates with linkers of the compositions and methods of the invention include, but are not limited
- a ligand is one or more“GalNAc” (N-acetylgalactosamine) derivatives attached through a bivalent or trivalent branched linker.
- a antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention is conjugated to a bivalent or trivalent branched linker selected from the group of structures shown in any of formula (XXXII)– (XXXV):
- q2A, q2B, q3A, q3B, q4A, q4B, q5A, q5B and q5C represent independently for each occurrence 0-20 and wherein the repeating unit can be the same or different;
- P 2A , P 2B , P 3A , P 3B , P 4A , P 4B , P 5A , P 5B , P 5C , T 2A , T 2B , T 3A , T 3B , T 4A , T 4B , T 4A , T 5B , T 5C are each independently for each occurrence absent, CO, NH, O, S, OC(O), NHC(O), CH 2 , CH 2 NH or CH 2 O;
- R 2A , R 2B , R 3A , R 3B , R 4A , R 4B , R 5A , R 5B , R 5C are each independently for each occurrence absent, NH, O,
- L 2A , L 2B , L 3A , L 3B , L 4A , L 4B , L 5A , L 5B and L 5C represent the ligand; i.e. each independently for each occurrence a monosaccharide (such as GalNAc), disaccharide, trisaccharide, tetrasaccharide, oligosaccharide, or polysaccharide; andR a is H or amino acid side chain.
- a monosaccharide such as GalNAc
- disaccharide such as GalNAc
- trisaccharide such as tetrasaccharide
- oligosaccharide oligosaccharide
- R a is H or amino acid side chain.
- Triplevalent conjugating GalNAc derivatives are particularly useful for use with antisense polynucleotide agents for inhibiting the expression of a target gene, such as those of formula (XXXVI): ,
- L 5A , L 5B and L 5C represent a monosaccharide, such as GalNAc derivative.
- suitable bivalent and trivalent branched linker groups conjugating GalNAc derivatives include, but are not limited to, the structures recited above as formulas II, VII, XI, X, and XIII.
- RNA conjugates include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos.4,828,979; 4,948,882; 5,218,105; 5,525,465; 5,541,313; 5,545,730;
- the present invention also includes antisense polynucleotide agents that are chimeric compounds.
- “Chimeric” antisense polynucleotide agents or“chimeras,” in the context of this invention, are antisense polynucleotide agent compounds, which contain two or more chemically distinct regions, each made up of at least one monomer unit, i.e., a nucleotide in the case of an antisense polynucleotide agent.
- These antisense polynucleotide agents typically contain at least one region wherein the RNA is modified so as to confer upon the antisense polynucleotide agent increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, or increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid.
- An additional region of the antisense polynucleotide agent can serve as a substrate for enzymes capable of cleaving RNA:DNA or RNA:RNA hybrids.
- RNase H is a cellular endonuclease which cleaves the RNA strand of an RNA:DNA duplex. Activation of RNase H, therefore, results in cleavage of the RNA target, thereby greatly enhancing the efficiency of antisense polynucleotide agent inhibition of gene expression. Consequently, comparable results can often be obtained with shorter antisense polynucleotide agents when chimeric antisense
- polynucleotide agents are used, compared to phosphorothioate deoxy antisense polynucleotide agents hybridizing to the same target region. Cleavage of the RNA target can be routinely detected by gel electrophoresis and, if necessary, associated nucleic acid hybridization techniques known in the art.
- nucleotide of an antisense polynucleotide agent can be modified by a non-ligand group.
- a number of non-ligand molecules have been conjugated to antisense
- polynucleotide agents in order to enhance the activity, cellular distribution or cellular uptake of the antisense polynucleotide agent, and procedures for performing such conjugations are available in the scientific literature.
- Such non-ligand moieties have included lipid moieties, such as cholesterol (Kubo, T. et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm., 2007, 365(1):54-61; Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 1989, 86:6553), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem.
- a thioether e.g., hexyl-S-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306; Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl.
- Acids Res., 1990, 18:3777 a polyamine or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al., Nucleosides & Nucleotides, 1995, 14:969), or adamantane acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651), a palmityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264:229), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-carbonyl-oxycholesterol moiety (Crooke et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 1996, 277:923).
- RNA conjugates Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of such RNA conjugates have been listed above. Typical conjugation protocols involve the synthesis of an RNAs bearing an aminolinker at one or more positions of the sequence. The amino group is then reacted with the molecule being conjugated using appropriate coupling or activating reagents. The conjugation reaction can be performed either with the RNA still bound to the solid support or following cleavage of the RNA, in solution phase. Purification of the RNA conjugate by HPLC typically affords the pure conjugate. V. Delivery of a Polynucleotide Agent of the Invention
- a polynucleotide agent of the invention e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents
- a cell e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human subject (e.g., a subject in need thereof, such as a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease)
- delivery may be performed by contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention either in vitro or in vivo.
- In vivo delivery may also be performed directly by administering a composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent to a subject.
- any method of delivering a nucleic acid molecule in vitro or in vivo can be adapted for use with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention (see e.g., Akhtar S. and Julian RL. (1992) Trends Cell. Biol.2(5):139-144 and WO94/02595, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties).
- factors to consider in order to deliver an antisense polynucleotide agent include, for example, biological stability of the delivered molecule, prevention of non-specific effects, and accumulation of the delivered molecule in the target tissue.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent can be minimized by local administration, for example, by direct injection or implantation into a tissue or topically administering the preparation.
- Local administration to a treatment site maximizes local concentration of the agent, limits the exposure of the agent to systemic tissues that can otherwise be harmed by the agent or that can degrade the agent, and permits a lower total dose of the antisense polynucleotide agent to be administered.
- RNA interference has also shown success with local delivery to the CNS by direct injection (Dorn, G., et al.
- the agent can be modified or alternatively delivered using a drug delivery system; both methods act to prevent the rapid degradation of the antisense polynucleotide agent by endo- and exo- nucleases in vivo. Modification of the agent or the pharmaceutical carrier can also permit targeting of the antisense polynucleotide agent composition to the target tissue and avoid undesirable off-target effects.
- Antisense polynucleotide agent can be modified by chemical conjugation to lipophilic groups such as cholesterol to enhance cellular uptake and prevent degradation.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent can be delivered using drug delivery systems such as a
- cationic delivery systems facilitate binding of an antisense polynucleotide agent molecule (negatively charged) and also enhance interactions at the negatively charged cell membrane to permit efficient uptake of an antisense polynucleotide agent by the cell.
- Cationic lipids, dendrimers, or polymers can either be bound to an antisense polynucleotide agent, or induced to form a vesicle or micelle (see e.g., Kim SH., et al (2008) Journal of Controlled Release 129(2):107-116) that encases an antisense polynucleotide agent.
- vesicles or micelles further prevents degradation of the antisense polynucleotide agent when administered systemically.
- Methods for making and administering cationic-antisense polynucleotide agent complexes are well within the abilities of one skilled in the art (see e.g., Sorensen, DR., et al (2003) J. Mol. Biol 327:761-766; Verma, UN, et al (2003) Clin. Cancer Res.9:1291-1300; Arnold, AS et al (2007) J. Hypertens.25:197-205, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety).
- Some non- limiting examples of drug delivery systems useful for systemic delivery of antisense polynucleotide agents include DOTAP (Sorensen, DR., et al (2003), supra; Verma, UN., et al (2003), supra), Oligofectamine, "solid nucleic acid lipid particles” (Zimmermann, TS., et al (2006) Nature 441:111- 114), cardiolipin (Chien, PY., et al (2005) Cancer Gene Ther.12:321-328; Pal, A., et al (2005) Int J. Oncol.26:1087-1091), polyethyleneimine (Bonnet ME., et al (2008) Pharm. Res.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent forms a complex with cyclodextrin for systemic administration.
- the present invention also includes pharmaceutical compositions and formulations which include the polynucleotide agents of the invention , e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents.
- pharmaceutical compositions containing an antisense polynucleotide agent, as described herein, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier are provided herein.
- phrases "pharmaceutically acceptable” is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human subjects and animal subjects without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
- pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier means a pharmaceutically- acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, manufacturing aid (e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body.
- manufacturing aid e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid
- solvent encapsulating material involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body.
- Each carrier must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the subject being treated.
- materials which can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) lubricating agents, such as magnesium state, sodium lauryl sulfate and talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; (1
- compositions containing the antisense polynucleotide agents are useful for treating a disease or disorder associated with the expression or activity of an IGFALS gene, e.g. an IGFALS-associated disease.
- Such pharmaceutical compositions are formulated based on the mode of delivery.
- One example is compositions that are formulated for systemic administration via parenteral delivery, e.g., by subcutaneous (SC) or intravenous (IV) delivery.
- the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention may be administered in dosages sufficient to inhibit expression of an IGFALS gene.
- a suitable dose of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention will be in the range of 0.001 to 200.0 milligrams per kilogram body weight of the recipient per day, generally in the range of 1 to 50 mg per kilogram body weight per day.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered at 0.01 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, 1 mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg, 2 mg/kg, 3 mg/kg, 10 mg/kg, 20 mg/kg, 30 mg/kg, 40 mg/kg, or 50 mg/kg per single dose.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6,
- the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered at a dose of about 0.1 to 50 mg/kg, 0.25 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.1 to 45 mg/kg, 0.25 to 45 mg/kg, 0.5 to 45 mg/kg, 0.75 to 45 mg/kg, 1 to 45 mg/mg, 1.5 to 45 mg/kb, 2 to 45 mg/kg
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.01, 0.02, 0.03, 0.04, 0.05, 0.06, 0.07, 0.08, 0.09, 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4,
- the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered at a dose of about 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kgb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 45 mg/kg, 0.75 to 45 mg/kg, 1 to 45 mg/mg, 1.5 to 45 mg/kb, 2 to 45 mg/kg, 2.5 to 45 mg/kg, 3 to 45 mg/kg, 3.5 to 45 mg/kg, 4 to 45 mg/kg, 4.5
- subjects can be administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, a single therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7,
- subjects are administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, multiple doses of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4,
- subjects are administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, a repeat dose of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose of about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4
- a repeat-dose periodine may include administration of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent on a regular basis, such as every other day, every third day, every fourth day, twice a week, once a week, every other week, or once a month.
- the pharmaceutical composition can be administered by intravenous infusion over a period of time, such as over about a 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, and 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, or 29 minute period.
- the infusion is administered over about 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, or 4 hours.
- the administration may be repeated, for example, on a regular basis, such as weekly, biweekly (i.e., every two weeks) for one month, two months, three months, four months or longer.
- the treatments can be administered on a less frequent basis. For example, after administration weekly or biweekly for three months, administration can be repeated once per month, for six months or a year or longer.
- the pharmaceutical composition can be administered once daily, or the antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered as two, three, or more sub-doses at appropriate intervals throughout the day or even using continuous infusion or delivery through a controlled release formulation. In that case, the antisense polynucleotide agent contained in each sub-dose must be correspondingly smaller in order to achieve the total daily dosage.
- the dosage unit can also be compounded for delivery over several days, e.g., using a conventional sustained release formulation which provides sustained release of the antisense polynucleotide agent over a several day period. Sustained release formulations are well known in the art and are particularly useful for delivery of agents at a particular site, such as could be used with the agents of the present invention. In this embodiment, the dosage unit contains a corresponding multiple of the daily dose.
- a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions can be long lasting, such that subsequent doses are administered at not more than 3, 4, or 5 day intervals, or at not more than 1, 2, 3, or 4 week intervals.
- a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention is administered once per week.
- a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention is administered bi- monthly.
- treatment of a subject with a therapeutically effective amount of a composition can include a single treatment or a series of treatments.
- Estimates of effective dosages and in vivo half-lives for the individual antisense polynucleotide agents encompassed by the invention can be made using conventional methodologies or on the basis of in vivo testing using an appropriate animal model, as described elsewhere herein.
- mice models for the study of various human diseases, such as a disorder that would benefit from reduction in the expression of IGFALS. Such models can be used for in vivo testing of an antisense polynucleotide agent, as well as for determining a therapeutically effective dose. Suitable mouse models are known in the art. For example, a mouse model of acromegaly was developed by Kovacs et al. (1997, Endocrinology) the entire contents of which are incorporated herein by reference.
- Bovine growth hormone transgenic mice also exhibit features of acromegaly (Palmiter et al., Science (1983), Olsson et al., Am J Phys Endo Metab (2003), Berryman et al, GH and IGF Res (2004), Izzard et al., GH and IGF Res (2009), Blutke et al., Mol and Cell Endo (2014)). Multiple animal models of cancer are known in the art.
- compositions of the present invention can be administered in a number of ways depending upon whether local or systemic treatment is desired and upon the area to be treated.
- Administration can be topical (e.g., by a transdermal patch), pulmonary, e.g., by inhalation or insufflation of powders or aerosols, including by nebulizer; intratracheal, intranasal, epidermal and transdermal, oral or parenteral.
- Parenteral administration includes intravenous, intraarterial, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal or intramuscular injection or infusion; subdermal, e.g., via an implanted device; or intracranial, e.g., by intraparenchymal, intrathecal or intraventricular, administration.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent can be delivered in a manner to target a particular tissue, such as the liver (e.g., the hepatocytes of the liver).
- a particular tissue such as the liver (e.g., the hepatocytes of the liver).
- compositions and formulations for topical administration can include transdermal patches, ointments, lotions, creams, gels, drops, suppositories, sprays, liquids and powders.
- Conventional pharmaceutical carriers, aqueous, powder or oily bases, thickeners and the like can be necessary or desirable.
- Coated condoms, gloves and the like can also be useful.
- Suitable topical formulations include those in which the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention are in admixture with a topical delivery agent such as lipids, liposomes, fatty acids, fatty acid esters, steroids, chelating agents and surfactants.
- Suitable lipids and liposomes include neutral (e.g., dioleoylphosphatidyl DOPE ethanolamine, dimyristoylphosphatidyl choline DMPC,
- distearolyphosphatidyl choline) negative e.g., dimyristoylphosphatidyl glycerol DMPG
- cationic e.g., dioleoyltetramethylaminopropyl DOTAP and dioleoylphosphatidyl ethanolamine DOTMA.
- Antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be encapsulated within liposomes or can form complexes thereto, in particular to cationic liposomes. Alternatively, antisense
- polynucleotide agents can be complexed to lipids, in particular to cationic lipids.
- Suitable fatty acids and esters include but are not limited to arachidonic acid, oleic acid, eicosanoic acid, lauric acid, caprylic acid, capric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein, dilaurin, glyceryl 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, an acylcarnitine, an acylcholine, or a C 1-20 alkyl ester (e.g., isopropylmyristate IPM), monoglyceride, diglyceride or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof).
- Topical formulations are described in detail in U.S. Patent No.6,747,014, which is incorporated herein by reference.
- An antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the compositions and methods of the invention can be formulated for delivery in a membranous molecular assembly, e.g., a liposome or a micelle.
- a membranous molecular assembly e.g., a liposome or a micelle.
- liposome refers to a vesicle composed of amphiphilic lipids arranged in at least one bilayer, e.g., one bilayer or a plurality of bilayers. Liposomes include unilamellar and multilamellar vesicles that have a membrane formed from a lipophilic material and an aqueous interior.
- the aqueous portion contains the antisense polynucleotide agent composition.
- the lipophilic material isolates the aqueous interior from an aqueous exterior, which typically does not include the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, although in some examples, it may.
- Liposomes are useful for the transfer and delivery of active ingredients to the site of action. Because the liposomal membrane is structurally similar to biological membranes, when liposomes are applied to a tissue, the liposomal bilayer fuses with bilayer of the cellular membranes. As the merging of the liposome and cell progresses, the internal aqueous contents that include the antisense polynucleotide agent are delivered into the cell where the antisense polynucleotide agent can specifically bind to a target RNA and can mediate antisense inhibition. In some cases the liposomes are also specifically targeted, e.g., to direct the antisense polynucleotide agent to particular cell types.
- a liposome containing an antisense polynucleotide agent can be prepared by a variety of methods.
- the lipid component of a liposome is dissolved in a detergent so that micelles are formed with the lipid component.
- the lipid component can be an amphipathic cationic lipid or lipid conjugate.
- the detergent can have a high critical micelle concentration and may be nonionic.
- Exemplary detergents include cholate, CHAPS, octylglucoside, deoxycholate, and lauroyl sarcosine.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent preparation is then added to the micelles that include the lipid component.
- the cationic groups on the lipid interact with the antisense polynucleotide agent and condense around the antisense polynucleotide agent to form a liposome. After condensation, the detergent is removed, e.g., by dialysis, to yield a liposomal preparation of antisense polynucleotide agent.
- a carrier compound that assists in condensation can be added during the condensation reaction, e.g., by controlled addition.
- the carrier compound can be a polymer other than a nucleic acid (e.g., spermine or spermidine). pH can also be adjusted to favor condensation.
- Liposome formation can also include one or more aspects of exemplary methods described in Felgner, P. L. et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 8:7413-7417, 1987; U.S. Pat. No.4,897,355; U.S. Pat. No. 5,171,678; Bangham, et al. M. Mol. Biol.23:238, 1965; Olson, et al. Biochim.
- Microfluidization can be used when consistently small (50 to 200 nm) and relatively uniform aggregates are desired (Mayhew, et al. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 775:169, 1984). These methods are readily adapted to packaging antisense polynucleotide agent preparations into liposomes.
- Liposomes fall into two broad classes. Cationic liposomes are positively charged liposomes which interact with the negatively charged nucleic acid molecules to form a stable complex. The positively charged nucleic acid/liposome complex binds to the negatively charged cell surface and is internalized in an endosome. Due to the acidic pH within the endosome, the liposomes are ruptured, releasing their contents into the cell cytoplasm (Wang et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 1987, 147, 980-985).
- Liposomes which are pH-sensitive or negatively-charged, entrap nucleic acids rather than complex with it. Since both the nucleic acid and the lipid are similarly charged, repulsion rather than complex formation occurs. Nevertheless, some nucleic acid is entrapped within the aqueous interior of these liposomes. pH-sensitive liposomes have been used to deliver nucleic acids encoding the thymidine kinase gene to cell monolayers in culture. Expression of the exogenous gene was detected in the target cells (Zhou et al., Journal of Controlled Release, 1992, 19, 269-274).
- liposomal composition includes phospholipids other than naturally-derived phosphatidylcholine.
- Neutral liposome compositions can be formed from dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (DMPC) or dipalmitoyl phosphatidylcholine (DPPC).
- Anionic liposome compositions generally are formed from dimyristoyl phosphatidylglycerol, while anionic fusogenic liposomes are formed primarily from dioleoyl phosphatidylethanolamine (DOPE).
- Another type of liposomal composition is formed from phosphatidylcholine (PC) such as, for example, soybean PC, and egg PC.
- PC phosphatidylcholine
- Another type is formed from mixtures of phospholipid or phosphatidylcholine or cholesterol.
- Examples of other methods to introduce liposomes into cells in vitro and in vivo include U.S. Pat. No.5,283,185; U.S. Pat. No.5,171,678; WO 94/00569; WO 93/24640; WO 91/16024; Felgner, J. Biol. Chem.269:2550, 1994; Nabel, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.90:11307, 1993; Nabel, Human Gene Ther. 3:649, 1992; Gershon, Biochem.32:7143, 1993; and Strauss EMBO J.11:417, 1992.
- Non-ionic liposomal systems have also been examined to determine their utility in the delivery of drugs to the skin, in particular systems comprising non-ionic surfactant and cholesterol.
- Non-ionic liposomal formulations comprising Novasome TM I (glyceryl
- Liposomes also include“sterically stabilized” liposomes, a term which, as used herein, refers to liposomes comprising one or more specialized lipids that, when incorporated into liposomes, result in enhanced circulation lifetimes relative to liposomes lacking such specialized lipids.
- sterically stabilized liposomes are those in which part of the vesicle-forming lipid portion of the liposome (A) comprises one or more glycolipids, such as monosialoganglioside G M1 , or (B) is derivatized with one or more hydrophilic polymers, such as a polyethylene glycol (PEG) moiety.
- PEG polyethylene glycol
- cationic liposomes are used.
- Cationic liposomes possess the advantage of being able to fuse to the cell membrane.
- Non-cationic liposomes although not able to fuse as efficiently with the plasma membrane, are taken up by macrophages in vivo and can be used to deliver antisense polynucleotide agents to macrophages.
- liposomes obtained from natural phospholipids are biocompatible and biodegradable; liposomes can incorporate a wide range of water and lipid soluble drugs; liposomes can protect encapsulated antisense polynucleotide agents in their internal compartments from metabolism and degradation (Rosoff, in "Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms," Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, volume 1, p.245).
- Important considerations in the preparation of liposome formulations are the lipid surface charge, vesicle size and the aqueous volume of the liposomes.
- a positively charged synthetic cationic lipid, N-[1-(2,3-dioleyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N- trimethylammonium chloride can be used to form small liposomes that interact spontaneously with nucleic acid to form lipid-nucleic acid complexes which are capable of fusing with the negatively charged lipids of the cell membranes of tissue culture cells, resulting in delivery of Antisense polynucleotide agent (see, e.g., Felgner, P. L. et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 8:7413- 7417, 1987 and U.S. Pat. No.4,897,355 for a description of DOTMA and its use with DNA).
- DOTMA N-[1-(2,3-dioleyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N- trimethylammonium chloride
- a DOTMA analogue, 1,2-bis(oleoyloxy)-3-(trimethylammonia)propane (DOTAP) can be used in combination with a phospholipid to form DNA-complexing vesicles.
- LipofectinTM Bethesda Research Laboratories, Gaithersburg, Md. is an effective agent for the delivery of highly anionic nucleic acids into living tissue culture cells that comprise positively charged DOTMA liposomes which interact spontaneously with negatively charged polynucleotides to form complexes. When enough positively charged liposomes are used, the net charge on the resulting complexes is also positive.
- DOTAP 1,2- bis(oleoyloxy)-3,3-(trimethylammonia)propane
- cationic lipid compounds include those that have been conjugated to a variety of moieties including, for example, carboxyspermine which has been conjugated to one of two types of lipids and includes compounds such as 5-carboxyspermylglycine dioctaoleoylamide (“DOGS”) (TransfectamTM, Promega, Madison, Wisconsin) and dipalmitoylphosphatidylethanolamine 5- carboxyspermyl-amide (“DPPES”) (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No.5,171,678).
- DOGS 5-carboxyspermylglycine dioctaoleoylamide
- DPES dipalmitoylphosphatidylethanolamine 5- carboxyspermyl-amide
- Another cationic lipid conjugate includes derivatization of the lipid with cholesterol (“DC- Chol”) which has been formulated into liposomes in combination with DOPE (See, Gao, X. and Huang, L., Biochim. Biophys. Res. Commun.179:280, 1991). Lipopolylysine, made by conjugating polylysine to DOPE, has been reported to be effective for transfection in the presence of serum (Zhou, X. et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta 1065:8, 1991). For certain cell lines, these liposomes containing conjugated cationic lipids, are said to exhibit lower toxicity and provide more efficient transfection than the DOTMA-containing compositions.
- DC- Chol lipid with cholesterol
- cationic lipids suitable for the delivery of oligonucleotides are described in WO 98/39359 and WO 96/37194.
- Liposomal formulations are particularly suited for topical administration; liposomes present several advantages over other formulations. Such advantages include reduced side effects related to high systemic absorption of the administered drug, increased accumulation of the administered drug at the desired target, and the ability to administer an antisense polynucleotide agent into the skin.
- liposomes are used for delivering antisense polynucleotide agenst to epidermal cells and also to enhance the penetration of antisense polynucleotide agenst into dermal tissues, e.g., into skin.
- the liposomes can be applied topically.
- Topical delivery of drugs formulated as liposomes to the skin has been documented (see, e.g., Weiner et al., Journal of Drug Targeting, 1992, vol.2,405-410 and du Plessis et al., Antiviral Research, 18, 1992, 259-265; Mannino, R. J. and Fould-Fogerite, S., Biotechniques 6:682-690, 1988; Itani, T. et al. Gene 56:267- 276.1987; Nicolau, C. et al. Meth. Enz.149:157-176, 1987; Straubinger, R. M. and Papahadjopoulos, D. Meth. Enz.101:512-527, 1983; Wang, C. Y. and Huang, L., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 84:7851- 7855, 1987).
- Non-ionic liposomal systems have also been examined to determine their utility in the delivery of drugs to the skin, in particular systems comprising non-ionic surfactant and cholesterol.
- Non-ionic liposomal formulations comprising Novasome I (glyceryl)
- dilaurate/cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether dilaurate/cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether
- Novasome II glyceryl distearate/ cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether
- Liposomes that include antisense polynucleotide agent can be made highly deformable. Such deformability can enable the liposomes to penetrate through pore that are smaller than the average radius of the liposome.
- transfersomes are a type of deformable liposomes.
- Transferosomes can be made by adding surface edge activators, usually surfactants, to a standard liposomal composition.
- Transfersomes that include antisense polynucleotide agents can be delivered, for example, subcutaneously by infection in order to deliver antisense polynucleotide agents to keratinocytes in the skin.
- lipid vesicles In order to cross intact mammalian skin, lipid vesicles must pass through a series of fine pores, each with a diameter less than 50 nm, under the influence of a suitable transdermal gradient.
- these transferosomes can be self- optimizing (adaptive to the shape of pores, e.g., in the skin), self-repairing, and can frequently reach their targets without fragmenting, and often self-loading.
- Other formulations amenable to the present invention are described in WO2009088892, WO2009086558, WO2009132131, and WO2008042973.
- Transfersomes are yet another type of liposomes, and are highly deformable lipid aggregates which are attractive candidates for drug delivery vehicles. Transfersomes can be described as lipid droplets which are so highly deformable that they are easily able to penetrate through pores which are smaller than the droplet. Transfersomes are adaptable to the environment in which they are used, e.g., they are self-optimizing (adaptive to the shape of pores in the skin), self-repairing, frequently reach their targets without fragmenting, and often self-loading. To make transfersomes it is possible to add surface edge-activators, usually surfactants, to a standard liposomal composition. Transfersomes have been used to deliver serum albumin to the skin. The transfersome-mediated delivery of serum albumin has been shown to be as effective as subcutaneous injection of a solution containing serum albumin.
- microemulsions and liposomes.
- the most common way of classifying and ranking the properties of the many different types of surfactants, both natural and synthetic, is by the use of the
- hydrophile/lipophile balance HLB
- the nature of the hydrophilic group provides the most useful means for categorizing the different surfactants used in formulations (Rieger, in“Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms”, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1988, p.285).
- Nonionic surfactants find wide application in pharmaceutical and cosmetic products and are usable over a wide range of pH values. In general their HLB values range from 2 to 18 depending on their structure.
- Nonionic surfactants include nonionic esters such as ethylene glycol esters, propylene glycol esters, glyceryl esters, polyglyceryl esters, sorbitan esters, sucrose esters, and ethoxylated esters.
- Nonionic alkanolamides and ethers such as fatty alcohol ethoxylates, propoxylated alcohols, and
- ethoxylated/propoxylated block polymers are also included in this class.
- the polyoxyethylene surfactants are the most popular members of the nonionic surfactant class.
- Anionic surfactants include carboxylates such as soaps, acyl lactylates, acyl amides of amino acids, esters of sulfuric acid such as alkyl sulfates and ethoxylated alkyl sulfates, sulfonates such as alkyl benzene sulfonates, acyl isethionates, acyl taurates and sulfosuccinates, and phosphates.
- the most important members of the anionic surfactant class are the alkyl sulfates and the soaps.
- Cationic surfactants include quaternary ammonium salts and ethoxylated amines. The quaternary ammonium salts are the most used members of this class.
- amphoteric surfactants include acrylic acid derivatives, substituted alkylamides, N-alkylbetaines and phosphatides.
- the use of surfactants in drug products, formulations and in emulsions has been reviewed (Rieger, in“Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms”, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1988, p.285).
- the antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the compositions and methods of the invention can also be provided as micellar formulations.“Micelles” are defined herein as a particular type of molecular assembly in which amphipathic molecules are arranged in a spherical structure such that all the hydrophobic portions of the molecules are directed inward, leaving the hydrophilic portions in contact with the surrounding aqueous phase. The converse arrangement exists if the environment is hydrophobic.
- a mixed micellar formulation suitable for delivery through transdermal membranes may be prepared by mixing an aqueous solution of the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, an alkali metal C 8 to C 22 alkyl sulphate, and a micelle forming compounds.
- Exemplary micelle forming compounds include lecithin, hyaluronic acid, pharmaceutically acceptable salts of hyaluronic acid, glycolic acid, lactic acid, chamomile extract, cucumber extract, oleic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, monoolein, monooleates, monolaurates, borage oil, evening of primrose oil, menthol, trihydroxy oxo cholanyl glycine and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, glycerin, polyglycerin, lysine, polylysine, triolein, polyoxyethylene ethers and analogues thereof, polidocanol alkyl ethers and analogues thereof, chenodeoxycholate, deoxycholate, and mixtures thereof.
- the micelle forming compounds may be added at the same time or after addition of the alkali metal alkyl sulphate. Mixed micelles will form with substantially any kind of mixing of the ingredients but vigorous mixing in order to provide
- a first micellar composition which contains the antisense polynucleotide agent composition and at least the alkali metal alkyl sulphate.
- the first micellar composition is then mixed with at least three micelle forming compounds to form a mixed micellar composition.
- the micellar composition is prepared by mixing the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, the alkali metal alkyl sulphate and at least one of the micelle forming compounds, followed by addition of the remaining micelle forming compounds, with vigorous mixing.
- Phenol or m-cresol may be added to the mixed micellar composition to stabilize the formulation and protect against bacterial growth.
- phenol or m-cresol may be added with the micelle forming ingredients.
- An isotonic agent such as glycerin may also be added after formation of the mixed micellar composition.
- the formulation can be put into an aerosol dispenser and the dispenser is charged with a propellant.
- the propellant which is under pressure, is in liquid form in the dispenser.
- the ratios of the ingredients are adjusted so that the aqueous and propellant phases become one, i.e., there is one phase. If there are two phases, it is necessary to shake the dispenser prior to dispensing a portion of the contents, e.g., through a metered valve.
- the dispensed dose of pharmaceutical agent is propelled from the metered valve in a fine spray.
- Propellants may include hydrogen-containing chlorofluorocarbons, hydrogen-containing fluorocarbons, dimethyl ether and diethyl ether.
- HFA 134a (1,1,1,2 tetrafluoroethane) may be used.
- concentrations of the essential ingredients can be determined by relatively straightforward experimentation. For absorption through the oral cavities, it is often desirable to increase, e.g., at least double or triple, the dosage for through injection or administration through the gastrointestinal tract.
- Antisense polynucleotide agents of in the invention may be fully encapsulated in a lipid formulation, e.g., a LNP, or other nucleic acid-lipid particle.
- LNP refers to a stable nucleic acid-lipid particle comprising a lipid layer encapsulating a pharmaceutically active molecule.
- LNPs typically contain a cationic lipid, a non-cationic lipid, and a lipid that prevents aggregation of the particle (e.g., a PEG-lipid conjugate).
- LNPs are extremely useful for systemic applications, as they exhibit extended circulation lifetimes following intravenous (i.v.) injection and accumulate at distal sites (e.g., sites physically separated from the administration site).
- LNPs include "pSPLP," which include an encapsulated condensing agent-nucleic acid complex as set forth in PCT Publication No. WO 00/03683.
- the particles of the present invention typically have a mean diameter of 50 nm to 150 nm, more typically 60 nm to 130 nm, more typically 70 nm to 110 nm, most typically 70 nm to 90 nm, and are substantially nontoxic.
- the nucleic acids when present in the nucleic acid- lipid particles of the present invention are resistant in aqueous solution to degradation with a nuclease. Nucleic acid-lipid particles and their method of preparation are disclosed in, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.5,976,567; 5,981,501; 6,534,484;
- the lipid to drug ratio (mass/mass ratio) (e.g., lipid to antisense polynucleotide agent ratio) will be in the range of from 1:1 to 50:1, from 1:1 to 25:1, from 3:1 to 15:1, from 4:1 to 10:1, from 5:1 to 9:1, or 6:1 to 9:1. Ranges intermediate to the above recited ranges are also contemplated to be part of the invention.
- the cationic lipid can be, for example, N,N-dioleyl-N,N-dimethylammonium chloride (DODAC), N,N-distearyl-N,N-dimethylammonium bromide (DDAB), N-(I -(2,3- dioleoyloxy)propyl)-N,N,N-trimethylammonium chloride (DOTAP), N-(I -(2,3- dioleyloxy)propyl)- N,N,N-trimethylammonium chloride (DOTMA), N,N-dimethyl-2,3- dioleyloxy)propylamine (DODMA), 1,2-DiLinoleyloxy-N,N-dimethylaminopropane (DLinDMA), l,2-Dilinolenyloxy-N,N- dimethylaminopropane (DLenDMA), 1,2-Dilinoleylcarbamoyloxy-3-dimethylamino
- the compound 2,2-Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane can be used to prepare lipid-santisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles. Synthesis of 2,2- Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane is described in United States provisional patent application number 61/107,998 filed on October 23, 2008, which is herein incorporated by reference.
- the lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent particle includes 40% 2, 2- Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane: 10% DSPC: 40% Cholesterol: 10% PEG-C-DOMG (mole percent) with a particle size of 63.0 ⁇ 20 nm and a 0.027 antisense polynucleotide agent/Lipid Ratio.
- the ionizable/non-cationic lipid can be an anionic lipid or a neutral lipid including, but not limited to, distearoylphosphatidylcholine (DSPC), dioleoylphosphatidylcholine (DOPC),
- DSPC distearoylphosphatidylcholine
- DOPC dioleoylphosphatidylcholine
- DPPC dipalmitoylphosphatidylcholine
- DOPG dioleoylphosphatidylglycerol
- DPPG dipalmitoylphosphatidylglycerol
- DOPE dioleoyl-phosphatidylethanolamine
- the non-cationic lipid can be from 5 mol % to 90 mol %, 10 mol %, or 58 mol % if cholesterol is included, of the total lipid present in the particle.
- the conjugated lipid that inhibits aggregation of particles can be, for example, a
- PEG-lipid including, without limitation, a PEG-diacylglycerol (DAG), a PEG- dialkyloxypropyl (DAA), a PEG-phospholipid, a PEG-ceramide (Cer), or a mixture thereof.
- the PEG-DAA conjugate can be, for example, a PEG-dilauryloxypropyl (Ci 2 ), a PEG- dimyristyloxypropyl (Ci 4 ), a PEG-dipalmityloxypropyl (Ci 6 ), or a PEG- distearyloxypropyl (C] 8 ).
- the conjugated lipid that prevents aggregation of particles can be from 0 mol % to 20 mol % or 2 mol % of the total lipid present in the particle.
- the nucleic acid-lipid particle further includes cholesterol at, e.g., 10 mol % to 60 mol % or 48 mol % of the total lipid present in the particle.
- the lipidoid ND98 ⁇ 4HCl (MW 1487) (see U.S. Patent Application No. 12/056,230, filed 3/26/2008, which is incorporated herein by reference), Cholesterol (Sigma-Aldrich), and PEG-Ceramide C16 (Avanti Polar Lipids) can be used to prepare lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles (i.e., LNP01 particles).
- Stock solutions of each in ethanol can be prepared as follows: ND98, 133 mg/ml; Cholesterol, 25 mg/ml, PEG-Ceramide C16, 100 mg/ml.
- the ND98, Cholesterol, and PEG-Ceramide C16 stock solutions can then be combined in a, e.g., 42:48:10 molar ratio.
- the combined lipid solution can be mixed with aqueous antisense polynucleotide agent (e.g., in sodium acetate pH 5) such that the final ethanol concentration is 35-45% and the final sodium acetate concentration is 100-300 mM.
- aqueous antisense polynucleotide agent e.g., in sodium acetate pH 5
- Lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles typically form spontaneously upon mixing.
- the resultant nanoparticle mixture can be extruded through a polycarbonate membrane (e.g., 100 nm cut-off) using, for example, a thermobarrel extruder, such as Lipex Extruder (Northern Lipids, Inc).
- a thermobarrel extruder such as Lipex Extruder (Northern Lipids, Inc).
- the extrusion step can be omitted.
- Ethanol removal and simultaneous buffer exchange can be accomplished by, for example, dialysis or tangential flow filtration.
- Buffer can be exchanged with, for example, phosphate buffered saline (PBS) at pH 7, e.g., pH 6.9, pH 7.0, pH 7.1, pH 7.2, pH 7.3, or pH 7.4.
- PBS phosphate buffered saline
- LNP01 formulations are described, e.g., in International Application Publication No. WO 2008/042973, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
- PEG-DMG PEG-didimyristoyl glycerol (C14-PEG, or PEG-C14) (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000)
- PEG-DSG PEG-distyryl glycerol (C18-PEG, or PEG-C18) (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000)
- PEG-cDMA PEG-carbamoyl-1,2-dimyristyloxypropylamine (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000)
- SNALP l,2-Dilinolenyloxy-N,N-dimethylaminopropane (DLinDMA)
- XTC comprising formulations are described in WO2010008537, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
- MC3 comprising formulations are described in U.S. Publication No.2010/0324120, filed June 10, 2010, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
- ALNY-100 comprising formulations are described inWO201054406, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
- any of the compounds, e.g., cationic lipids and the like, used in the nucleic acid-lipid particles of the invention can be prepared by known organic synthesis techniques, including the methods described in more detail in the Examples. All substituents are as defined below unless indicated otherwise.
- Alkyl means a straight chain or branched, noncyclic or cyclic, saturated aliphatic hydrocarbon containing from 1 to 24 carbon atoms.
- Representative saturated straight chain alkyls include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, and the like; while saturated branched alkyls include isopropyl, sec-butyl, isobutyl, tert-butyl, isopentyl, and the like.
- saturated cyclic alkyls include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and the like; while unsaturated cyclic alkyls include cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl, and the like.
- Alkenyl means an alkyl, as defined above, containing at least one double bond between adjacent carbon atoms. Alkenyls include both cis and trans isomers. Representative straight chain and branched alkenyls include ethylenyl, propylenyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, isobutylenyl, 1-pentenyl, 2-pentenyl, 3-methyl-1-butenyl, 2-methyl-2-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, and the like.
- Alkynyl means any alkyl or alkenyl, as defined above, which additionally contains at least one triple bond between adjacent carbons.
- Representative straight chain and branched alkynyls include acetylenyl, propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 1-pentynyl, 2-pentynyl, 3-methyl-1 butynyl, and the like.
- Acyl means any alkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl wherein the carbon at the point of attachment is substituted with an oxo group, as defined below.
- Heterocycle means a 5- to 7-membered monocyclic, or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic, heterocyclic ring which is either saturated, unsaturated, or aromatic, and which contains from 1 or 2 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms can be optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen heteroatom can be optionally quaternized, including bicyclic rings in which any of the above heterocycles are fused to a benzene ring.
- the heterocycle can be attached via any heteroatom or carbon atom.
- Heterocycles include heteroaryls as defined below.
- Heterocycles include morpholinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperizynyl, hydantoinyl, valerolactamyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydroprimidinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl,
- Halogen means fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo.
- protecting groups can be used.
- Protecting group methodology is well known to those skilled in the art (see, for example, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Green, T.W. et al., Wiley-Interscience, New York City, 1999).
- protecting groups within the context of this invention are any group that reduces or eliminates unwanted reactivity of a functional group.
- a protecting group can be added to a functional group to mask its reactivity during certain reactions and then removed to reveal the original functional group.
- an“alcohol protecting group” is used.
- An“alcohol protecting group” is any group which decreases or eliminates unwanted reactivity of an alcohol functional group.
- Protecting groups can be added and removed using techniques well known in the art.
- Formulations prepared by either the standard or extrusion-free method can be characterized in similar manners.
- formulations are typically characterized by visual inspection. They should be whitish translucent solutions free from aggregates or sediment. Particle size and particle size distribution of lipid-nanoparticles can be measured by light scattering using, for example, a Malvern Zetasizer Nano ZS (Malvern, USA). Particles should be 20-300 nm, such as 40-100 nm in size. The particle size distribution should be unimodal.
- the total antisense polynucleotide agent concentration in the formulation, as well as the entrapped fraction is estimated using a dye exclusion assay.
- a sample of the formulated antisense polynucleotide agent can be incubated with an RNA- binding dye, such as Ribogreen (Molecular Probes) in the presence or absence of a formulation disrupting surfactant, e.g., 0.5% Triton-X100.
- an RNA- binding dye such as Ribogreen (Molecular Probes)
- Molecular Probes Molecular Probes
- the total antisense polynucleotide agent in the formulation can be determined by the signal from the sample containing the surfactant, relative to a standard curve.
- the entrapped fraction is determined by subtracting the“free” antisense
- polynucleotide agent content (as measured by the signal in the absence of surfactant) from the total antisense polynucleotide agent content.
- Percent entrapped antisense polynucleotide agent is typically >85%.
- the particle size is at least 30 nm, at least 40 nm, at least 50 nm, at least 60 nm, at least 70 nm, at least 80 nm, at least 90 nm, at least 100 nm, at least 110 nm, and at least 120 nm.
- the suitable range is typically at least 50 nm to at least 110 nm, at least 60 nm to at least 100 nm, or at least 80 nm to at least 90 nm.
- compositions and formulations for oral administration include powders or granules, microparticulates, nanoparticulates, suspensions or solutions in water or non-aqueous media, capsules, gel capsules, sachets, tablets or minitablets. Thickeners, flavoring agents, diluents, emulsifiers, dispersing aids or binders can be desirable.
- oral formulations are those in which the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention are administered in conjunction with one or more penetration enhancer surfactants and chelators.
- Suitable surfactants include fatty acids or esters or salts thereof, bile acids or salts thereof.
- Suitable bile acids/salts include
- chenodeoxycholic acid and ursodeoxychenodeoxycholic acid (UDCA)
- cholic acid dehydrocholic acid, deoxycholic acid, glucholic acid, glycholic acid, glycodeoxycholic acid, taurocholic acid, taurodeoxycholic acid, sodium tauro-24,25-dihydro-fusidate and sodium
- Suitable fatty acids include arachidonic acid, undecanoic acid, oleic acid, lauric acid, caprylic acid, capric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein, dilaurin, glyceryl 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, an acylcarnitine, an acylcholine, or a monoglyceride, a diglyceride or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (e.g., sodium).
- arachidonic acid arachidonic acid, undecanoic acid, oleic acid, lauric acid, caprylic acid, capric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein, dilaurin, gly
- combinations of penetration enhancers are used, for example, fatty acids/salts in combination with bile acids/salts.
- One exemplary combination is the sodium salt of lauric acid, capric acid and UDCA.
- Further penetration enhancers include
- Antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be delivered orally, in granular form including sprayed dried particles, or complexed to form micro or nanoparticles.
- Antisense polynucleotide agent complexing agents include poly-amino acids; polyimines; polyacrylates; polyalkylacrylates, polyoxethanes,
- polyalkylcyanoacrylates cationized gelatins, albumins, starches, acrylates, polyethyleneglycols (PEG) and starches; polyalkylcyanoacrylates; DEAE-derivatized polyimines, pollulans, celluloses and starches.
- Suitable complexing agents include chitosan, N-trimethylchitosan, poly-L-lysine, polyhistidine, polyornithine, polyspermines, protamine, polyvinylpyridine,
- Oral formulations for antisense polynucleotide agents and their preparation are described in detail in U.S. Patent 6,887,906, US Publn. No.20030027780, and U.S. Patent No.6,747,014, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
- compositions and formulations for parenteral, intraparenchymal (into the brain), intrathecal, intraventricular or intrahepatic administration can include sterile aqueous solutions which can also contain buffers, diluents and other suitable additives such as, but not limited to, penetration enhancers, carrier compounds and other pharmaceutically acceptable carriers or excipients.
- compositions of the present invention include, but are not limited to, solutions, emulsions, and liposome-containing formulations. These compositions can be generated from a variety of components that include, but are not limited to, preformed liquids, self-emulsifying solids and self-emulsifying semisolids. Particularly preferred are formulations that target the liver, e.g., when treating hepatic disorders, e.g., hepatic carcinoma.
- the pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention can be prepared according to conventional techniques well known in the pharmaceutical industry. Such techniques include the step of bringing into association the active ingredients with the pharmaceutical carrier(s) or excipient(s). In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredients with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
- compositions of the present invention can be formulated into any of many possible dosage forms such as, but not limited to, tablets, capsules, gel capsules, liquid syrups, soft gels, suppositories, and enemas.
- the compositions of the present invention can also be formulated as suspensions in aqueous, non-aqueous or mixed media.
- Aqueous suspensions can further contain substances which increase the viscosity of the suspension including, for example, sodium
- the suspension can also contain stabilizers.
- compositions of the present invention can be prepared and formulated as emulsions.
- Emulsions are typically heterogeneous systems of one liquid dispersed in another in the form of droplets usually exceeding 0.1 ⁇ m in diameter (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199; Rosoff, in
- Emulsions are often biphasic systems comprising two immiscible liquid phases intimately mixed and dispersed with each other.
- emulsions can be of either the water-in-oil (w/o) or the oil-in-water (o/w) variety.
- aqueous phase When an aqueous phase is finely divided into and dispersed as minute droplets into a bulk oily phase, the resulting composition is called a water-in-oil (w/o) emulsion.
- oil-in-water (o/w) emulsion When an oily phase is finely divided into and dispersed as minute droplets into a bulk aqueous phase, the resulting composition is called an oil-in-water (o/w) emulsion.
- Emulsions can contain additional components in addition to the dispersed phases, and the active drug which can be present as a solution in either the aqueous phase, oily phase or itself as a separate phase. Pharmaceutical excipients such as emulsifiers, stabilizers, dyes, and anti-oxidants can also be present in emulsions as needed.
- compositions can also be multiple emulsions that are comprised of more than two phases such as, for example, in the case of oil-in-water-in-oil (o/w/o) and water-in-oil-in-water (w/o/w) emulsions.
- Such complex formulations often provide certain advantages that simple binary emulsions do not.
- Multiple emulsions in which individual oil droplets of an o/w emulsion enclose small water droplets constitute a w/o/w emulsion.
- a system of oil droplets enclosed in globules of water stabilized in an oily continuous phase provides an o/w/o emulsion.
- Emulsions are characterized by little or no thermodynamic stability. Often, the dispersed or discontinuous phase of the emulsion is well dispersed into the external or continuous phase and maintained in this form through the means of emulsifiers or the viscosity of the formulation. Either of the phases of the emulsion can be a semisolid or a solid, as is the case of emulsion-style ointment bases and creams. Other means of stabilizing emulsions entail the use of emulsifiers that can be incorporated into either phase of the emulsion.
- Emulsifiers can broadly be classified into four categories: synthetic surfactants, naturally occurring emulsifiers, absorption bases, and finely dispersed solids (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199).
- Synthetic surfactants also known as surface active agents, have found wide applicability in the formulation of emulsions and have been reviewed in the literature (see e.g., Ansel's
- Surfactants are typically amphiphilic and comprise a hydrophilic and a hydrophobic portion.
- HLB hydrophile/lipophile balance
- Surfactants can be classified into different classes based on the nature of the hydrophilic group: nonionic, anionic, cationic and amphoteric (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY Rieger, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.285).
- Naturally occurring emulsifiers used in emulsion formulations include lanolin, beeswax, phosphatides, lecithin and acacia.
- Absorption bases possess hydrophilic properties such that they can soak up water to form w/o emulsions yet retain their semisolid consistencies, such as anhydrous lanolin and hydrophilic petrolatum. Finely divided solids have also been used as good emulsifiers especially in combination with surfactants and in viscous preparations.
- polar inorganic solids such as heavy metal hydroxides, nonswelling clays such as bentonite, attapulgite, hectorite, kaolin, montmorillonite, colloidal aluminum silicate and colloidal magnesium aluminum silicate, pigments and nonpolar solids such as carbon or glyceryl tristearate.
- non-emulsifying materials are also included in emulsion formulations and contribute to the properties of emulsions. These include fats, oils, waxes, fatty acids, fatty alcohols, fatty esters, humectants, hydrophilic colloids, preservatives and antioxidants (Block, in
- Hydrophilic colloids or hydrocolloids include naturally occurring gums and synthetic polymers such as polysaccharides (for example, acacia, agar, alginic acid, carrageenan, guar gum, karaya gum, and tragacanth), cellulose derivatives (for example, carboxymethylcellulose and carboxypropylcellulose), and synthetic polymers (for example, carbomers, cellulose ethers, and carboxyvinyl polymers). These disperse or swell in water to form colloidal solutions that stabilize emulsions by forming strong interfacial films around the dispersed-phase droplets and by increasing the viscosity of the external phase.
- polysaccharides for example, acacia, agar, alginic acid, carrageenan, guar gum, karaya gum, and tragacanth
- cellulose derivatives for example, carboxymethylcellulose and carboxypropylcellulose
- synthetic polymers for example, carbomers, cellulose ethers, and
- emulsions often contain a number of ingredients such as carbohydrates, proteins, sterols and phosphatides that can readily support the growth of microbes, these formulations often incorporate preservatives.
- preservatives included in emulsion formulations include methyl paraben, propyl paraben, quaternary ammonium salts, benzalkonium chloride, esters of p- hydroxybenzoic acid, and boric acid.
- Antioxidants are also commonly added to emulsion formulations to prevent deterioration of the formulation.
- Antioxidants used can be free radical scavengers such as tocopherols, alkyl gallates, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, or reducing agents such as ascorbic acid and sodium metabisulfite, and antioxidant synergists such as citric acid, tartaric acid, and lecithin.
- free radical scavengers such as tocopherols, alkyl gallates, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, or reducing agents such as ascorbic acid and sodium metabisulfite
- antioxidant synergists such as citric acid, tartaric acid, and lecithin.
- Emulsion formulations for oral delivery have been very widely used because of ease of formulation, as well as efficacy from an absorption and bioavailability standpoint (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rosoff, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.245; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199).
- Mineral-oil base laxatives, oil-soluble vitamins and high fat nutritive preparations are among the materials that have commonly been administered orally as o/w emulsions.
- compositions of antisense polynucleotide agents are formulated as microemulsions.
- a microemulsion can be defined as a system of water, oil and amphiphile which is a single optically isotropic and thermodynamically stable liquid solution (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rosoff, in
- microemulsions are systems that are prepared by first dispersing an oil in an aqueous surfactant solution and then adding a sufficient amount of a fourth component, generally an intermediate chain-length alcohol to form a transparent system.
- microemulsions have also been described as thermodynamically stable, isotropically clear dispersions of two immiscible liquids that are stabilized by interfacial films of surface-active molecules (Leung and Shah, in: Controlled Release of Drugs: Polymers and Aggregate Systems, Rosoff, M., Ed., 1989, VCH Publishers, New York, pages 185-215).
- Microemulsions commonly are prepared via a combination of three to five components that include oil, water, surfactant, cosurfactant and electrolyte.
- microemulsion is of the water-in-oil (w/o) or an oil-in-water (o/w) type is dependent on the properties of the oil and surfactant used and on the structure and geometric packing of the polar heads and hydrocarbon tails of the surfactant molecules (Schott, in Remington's
- microemulsions offer the advantage of solubilizing water-insoluble drugs in a formulation of thermodynamically stable droplets that are formed spontaneously
- Surfactants used in the preparation of microemulsions include, but are not limited to, ionic surfactants, non-ionic surfactants, Brij 96, polyoxyethylene oleyl ethers, polyglycerol fatty acid esters, tetraglycerol monolaurate (ML310), tetraglycerol monooleate (MO310), hexaglycerol monooleate (PO310), hexaglycerol pentaoleate (PO500), decaglycerol monocaprate (MCA750), decaglycerol monooleate (MO750), decaglycerol sequioleate (SO750), decaglycerol decaoleate (DAO750), alone or in combination with cosurfactants.
- ionic surfactants non-ionic surfactants
- Brij 96 polyoxyethylene oleyl ethers
- polyglycerol fatty acid esters tetraglycerol monolaurate (ML310),
- the cosurfactant usually a short-chain alcohol such as ethanol, 1-propanol, and 1-butanol, serves to increase the interfacial fluidity by penetrating into the surfactant film and consequently creating a disordered film because of the void space generated among surfactant molecules.
- Microemulsions can, however, be prepared without the use of cosurfactants and alcohol-free self-emulsifying microemulsion systems are known in the art.
- the aqueous phase can typically be, but is not limited to, water, an aqueous solution of the drug, glycerol, PEG300, PEG400, polyglycerols, propylene glycols, and derivatives of ethylene glycol.
- the oil phase can include, but is not limited to, materials such as Captex 300, Captex 355, Capmul MCM, fatty acid esters, medium chain (C8-C12) mono, di, and tri-glycerides, polyoxyethylated glyceryl fatty acid esters, fatty alcohols, polyglycolized glycerides, saturated polyglycolized C8-C10 glycerides, vegetable oils and silicone oil.
- materials such as Captex 300, Captex 355, Capmul MCM, fatty acid esters, medium chain (C8-C12) mono, di, and tri-glycerides, polyoxyethylated glyceryl fatty acid esters, fatty alcohols, polyglycolized glycerides, saturated polyglycolized C8-C10 glycerides, vegetable oils and silicone oil.
- Microemulsions are particularly of interest from the standpoint of drug solubilization and the enhanced absorption of drugs.
- Lipid based microemulsions both o/w and w/o have been proposed to enhance the oral bioavailability of drugs, including peptides (see e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.6,191,105; 7,063,860; 7,070,802; 7,157,099; Constantinides et al., Pharmaceutical Research, 1994, 11, 1385- 1390; Ritschel, Meth. Find. Exp. Clin. Pharmacol., 1993, 13, 205).
- Microemulsions afford advantages of improved drug solubilization, protection of drug from enzymatic hydrolysis, possible enhancement of drug absorption due to surfactant-induced alterations in membrane fluidity and permeability, ease of preparation, ease of oral administration over solid dosage forms, improved clinical potency, and decreased toxicity (see e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.6,191,105; 7,063,860; 7,070,802; 7,157,099;
- microemulsions can form spontaneously when their components are brought together at ambient temperature. This can be particularly advantageous when formulating thermolabile drugs, peptides or antisense polynucleotide agents.
- Microemulsions have also been effective in the transdermal delivery of active components in both cosmetic and pharmaceutical applications. It is expected that the microemulsion compositions and formulations of the present invention will facilitate the increased systemic absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents from the gastrointestinal tract, as well as improve the local cellular uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents and nucleic acids.
- Microemulsions of the present invention can also contain additional components and additives such as sorbitan monostearate (Grill 3), Labrasol, and penetration enhancers to improve the properties of the formulation and to enhance the absorption of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the present invention.
- Penetration enhancers used in the microemulsions of the present invention can be classified as belonging to one of five broad categories--surfactants, fatty acids, bile salts, chelating agents, and non-chelating non-surfactants (Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92). Each of these classes has been discussed above.
- An antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be incorporated into a particle, e.g., a microparticle.
- Microparticles can be produced by spray-drying, but may also be produced by other methods including lyophilization, evaporation, fluid bed drying, vacuum drying, or a combination of these techniques.
- the present invention employs various penetration enhancers to effect the efficient delivery of nucleic acids, particularly antisense polynucleotide agents, to the skin of animals.
- nucleic acids particularly antisense polynucleotide agents
- Most drugs are present in solution in both ionized and nonionized forms. However, usually only lipid soluble or lipophilic drugs readily cross cell membranes. It has been discovered that even non- lipophilic drugs can cross cell membranes if the membrane to be crossed is treated with a penetration enhancer. In addition to aiding the diffusion of non-lipophilic drugs across cell membranes, penetration enhancers also enhance the permeability of lipophilic drugs.
- Penetration enhancers can be classified as belonging to one of five broad categories, i.e., surfactants, fatty acids, bile salts, chelating agents, and non-chelating non-surfactants (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92).
- surfactants fatty acids
- Surfactants are chemical entities which, when dissolved in an aqueous solution, reduce the surface tension of the solution or the interfacial tension between the aqueous solution and another liquid, with the result that absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the mucosa is enhanced.
- these penetration enhancers include, for example, sodium lauryl sulfate, polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether and polyoxyethylene-20- cetyl ether) (see e.g., Malmsten, M.
- fatty acids and their derivatives which act as penetration enhancers include, for example, oleic acid, lauric acid, capric acid (n-decanoic acid), myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein (1-monooleoyl-rac-glycerol), dilaurin, caprylic acid, arachidonic acid, glycerol 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, acylcarnitines, acylcholines, C 1-20 alkyl esters thereof (e.g., methyl, isopropyl and t-butyl), and mono- and di-glycerides thereof (i.e., oleate, laurate, caprate, myristate, palmitate, stearate, linoleate, etc.) (see e.g., To,
- bile The physiological role of bile includes the facilitation of dispersion and absorption of lipids and fat-soluble vitamins (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Brunton, Chapter 38 in: Goodman & Gilman's The
- bile salts include any of the naturally occurring components of bile as well as any of their synthetic derivatives.
- Suitable bile salts include, for example, cholic acid (or its pharmaceutically acceptable sodium salt, sodium cholate), dehydrocholic acid (sodium dehydrocholate), deoxycholic acid (sodium deoxycholate), glucholic acid (sodium glucholate), glycholic acid (sodium
- glycocholate glycodeoxycholic acid (sodium glycodeoxycholate), taurocholic acid (sodium taurocholate), taurodeoxycholic acid (sodium taurodeoxycholate), chenodeoxycholic acid (sodium chenodeoxycholate), ursodeoxycholic acid (UDCA), sodium tauro-24,25-dihydro-fusidate (STDHF), sodium glycodihydrofusidate and polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether (POE) (see e.g., Malmsten, M.
- POE polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether
- Chelating agents can be defined as compounds that remove metallic ions from solution by forming complexes therewith, with the result that absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the mucosa is enhanced.
- chelating agents have the added advantage of also serving as DNase inhibitors, as most characterized DNA nucleases require a divalent metal ion for catalysis and are thus inhibited by chelating agents (Jarrett, J. Chromatogr., 1993, 618, 315-339).
- Suitable chelating agents include but are not limited to disodium ethylenediaminetetraacetate (EDTA), citric acid, salicylates (e.g., sodium salicylate, 5-methoxysalicylate and homovanilate), N- acyl derivatives of collagen, laureth-9 and N-amino acyl derivatives of beta-diketones (enamines)(see e.g., Katdare, A.
- EDTA disodium ethylenediaminetetraacetate
- citric acid e.g., citric acid
- salicylates e.g., sodium salicylate, 5-methoxysalicylate and homovanilate
- N- acyl derivatives of collagen e.g., laureth-9 and N-amino acyl derivatives of beta-diketones (enamines)(see e.g., Katdare, A.
- non-chelating non-surfactant penetration enhancing compounds can be defined as compounds that demonstrate insignificant activity as chelating agents or as surfactants but that nonetheless enhance absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the alimentary mucosa (see e.g., Muranishi, Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1990, 7, 1-33).
- This class of penetration enhancers includes, for example, unsaturated cyclic ureas, 1-alkyl- and 1- alkenylazacyclo-alkanone derivatives (Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, page 92); and non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agents such as diclofenac sodium, indomethacin and phenylbutazone (Yamashita et al., J. Pharm. Pharmacol., 1987, 39, 621-626).
- Agents that enhance uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents at the cellular level can also be added to the pharmaceutical and other compositions of the present invention.
- cationic lipids such as lipofectin (Junichi et al, U.S. Pat. No.5,705,188), cationic glycerol derivatives, and polycationic molecules, such as polylysine (Lollo et al., PCT Application WO 97/30731), are also known to enhance the cellular uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents.
- transfection reagents examples include, for example LipofectamineTM (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Lipofectamine 2000TM (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), 293fectinTM (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA),
- agents can be utilized to enhance the penetration of the administered nucleic acids, including glycols such as ethylene glycol and propylene glycol, pyrrols such as 2-pyrrol, azones, and terpenes such as limonene and menthone.
- glycols such as ethylene glycol and propylene glycol
- pyrrols such as 2-pyrrol
- azones such as 2-pyrrol
- terpenes such as limonene and menthone.
- compositions of the present invention also incorporate carrier compounds in the formulation.
- carrier compound or“carrier” can refer to a nucleic acid, or analog thereof, which is inert (i.e., does not possess biological activity per se) but is recognized as a nucleic acid by in vivo processes that reduce the bioavailability of a nucleic acid having biological activity by, for example, degrading the biologically active nucleic acid or promoting its removal from circulation.
- nucleic acid and a carrier compound can result in a substantial reduction of the amount of nucleic acid recovered in the liver, kidney or other extracirculatory reservoirs, presumably due to competition between the carrier compound and the nucleic acid for a common receptor.
- the recovery of a partially phosphorothioated antisense polynucleotide agent in hepatic tissue can be reduced when it is coadministered with polyinosinic acid, dextran sulfate, polycytidic acid or 4-acetamido- 4'isothiocyano-stilbene-2,2'-disulfonic acid (Miyao et al., Antisense polynucleotide agent Res. Dev., 1995, 5, 115-121; Takakura et al., Antisense polynucleotide agent & Nucl. Acid Drug Dev., 1996, 6, 177-183.
- a“pharmaceutical carrier” or“excipient” is a“pharmaceutical carrier” or“excipient”
- the excipient can be liquid or solid and is selected, with the planned manner of administration in mind, so as to provide for the desired bulk, consistency, etc., when combined with a nucleic acid and the other components of a given pharmaceutical composition.
- Typical pharmaceutical carriers include, but are not limited to, binding agents (e.g., pregelatinized maize starch, polyvinylpyrrolidone or hydroxypropyl methylcellulose, etc.); fillers (e.g., lactose and other sugars, microcrystalline cellulose, pectin, gelatin, calcium sulfate, ethyl cellulose, polyacrylates or calcium hydrogen phosphate, etc.); lubricants (e.g., magnesium stearate, talc, silica, colloidal silicon dioxide, stearic acid, metallic stearates, hydrogenated vegetable oils, corn starch, polyethylene glycols, sodium benzoate, sodium acetate, etc.); disintegrants (e.g., starch, sodium starch glycolate, etc.); and wetting agents (e.g., sodium lauryl sulphate, etc).
- binding agents e.g., pregelatinized maize starch, polyvinylpyrrolidone or hydroxypropy
- compositions of the present invention can also be used to formulate the compositions of the present invention.
- suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, but are not limited to, water, salt solutions, alcohols, polyethylene glycols, gelatin, lactose, amylose, magnesium stearate, talc, silicic acid, viscous paraffin, hydroxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone and the like.
- Formulations for topical administration of nucleic acids can include sterile and non-sterile aqueous solutions, non-aqueous solutions in common solvents such as alcohols, or solutions of the nucleic acids in liquid or solid oil bases.
- the solutions can also contain buffers, diluents and other suitable additives.
- Pharmaceutically acceptable organic or inorganic excipients suitable for non- parenteral administration which do not deleteriously react with nucleic acids can be used.
- Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients include, but are not limited to, water, salt solutions, alcohol, polyethylene glycols, gelatin, lactose, amylose, magnesium stearate, talc, silicic acid, viscous paraffin, hydroxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone and the like.
- compositions of the present invention can additionally contain other adjunct components conventionally found in pharmaceutical compositions, at their art-established usage levels.
- the compositions can contain additional, compatible, pharmaceutically-active materials such as, for example, antipruritics, astringents, local anesthetics or anti-inflammatory agents, or can contain additional materials useful in physically formulating various dosage forms of the compositions of the present invention, such as dyes, flavoring agents, preservatives, antioxidants, opacifiers, thickening agents and stabilizers.
- additional materials useful in physically formulating various dosage forms of the compositions of the present invention such as dyes, flavoring agents, preservatives, antioxidants, opacifiers, thickening agents and stabilizers.
- such materials when added, should not unduly interfere with the biological activities of the components of the compositions of the present invention.
- the formulations can be sterilized and, if desired, mixed with auxiliary agents, e.g., lubricants, preservatives, stabilizers, wetting agents, emulsifiers, salts for influencing osmotic pressure, buffers, colorings, flavorings or aromatic substances and the like which do not deleteriously interact with the nucleic acid(s) of the formulation.
- auxiliary agents e.g., lubricants, preservatives, stabilizers, wetting agents, emulsifiers, salts for influencing osmotic pressure, buffers, colorings, flavorings or aromatic substances and the like which do not deleteriously interact with the nucleic acid(s) of the formulation.
- Aqueous suspensions can contain substances which increase the viscosity of the suspension including, for example, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, sorbitol or dextran.
- the suspension can also contain stabilizers.
- compositions featured in the invention include (a) one or more antisense polynucleotide agents and (b) one or more agents which function by a non-antisense inhibition mechanism and which are useful in treating a hemolytic disorder.
- agents include, but are not lmited to an anti-inflammatory agent, anti-steatosis agent, anti-viral, or anti- fibrosis agent.
- other substances commonly used to protect the liver such as silymarin, can also be used in conjunction with the antisense polynucleotide agents described herein.
- Other agents useful for treating liver diseases include telbivudine, entecavir, and protease inhibitors such as telaprevir and other disclosed, for example, in Tung et al., U.S. Application Publication Nos.
- Toxicity and therapeutic efficacy of such compounds can be determined by standard pharmaceutical procedures in cell cultures or experimental animals, e.g., for determining the LD 50 (the dose lethal to 50% of the population) and the ED 50 (the dose therapeutically effective in 50% of the population).
- the dose ratio between toxic and therapeutic effects is the therapeutic index and it can be expressed as the ratio LD 50 /ED 50 .
- Compounds that exhibit high therapeutic indices are preferred.
- the data obtained from cell culture assays and animal studies can be used in formulating a range of dosage for use in humans.
- the dosage of compositions featured herein in the invention lies generally within a range of circulating concentrations that include the ED 50 with little or no toxicity.
- the dosage can vary within this range depending upon the dosage form employed and the route of administration utilized.
- the therapeutically effective dose can be estimated initially from cell culture assays.
- a dose can be formulated in animal models to achieve a circulating plasma concentration range of the compound or, when appropriate, of the polypeptide product of a target sequence (e.g., achieving a decreased concentration of the polypeptide) that includes the IC 50 (i.e., the concentration of the test compound which achieves a half-maximal inhibition of symptoms) as determined in cell culture.
- a target sequence e.g., achieving a decreased concentration of the polypeptide
- IC 50 i.e., the concentration of the test compound which achieves a half-maximal inhibition of symptoms
- levels in plasma can be measured, for example, by high performance liquid chromatography.
- the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be administered in combination with other known agents effective in treatment of pathological processes mediated by IGFALS expression.
- the administering physician can adjust the amount and timing of antisense polynucleotide agent administration on the basis of results observed using standard measures of efficacy known in the art or described herein. VII. Methods For Inhibiting IGFALS Expression
- the present invention provides methods of inhibiting expression of IGFALS in a cell.
- the methods include contacting a cell with a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent, in an amount effective to inhibit expression of the IGFALS in the cell, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALS in the cell.
- a polynucleotide agent of the invention e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent
- Contacting of a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent may be done in vitro or in vivo.
- Contacting a cell in vivo with the antisense polynucleotide agent includes contacting a cell or group of cells within a subject, e.g., a human subject, with the antisense polynucleotide agent. Combinations of in vitro and in vivo methods of contacting are also possible. Contacting may be direct or indirect, as discussed above. Furthermore, contacting a cell may be accomplished via a targeting ligand, including any ligand described herein or known in the art.
- the targeting ligand is a carbohydrate moiety, e.g., a GalNAc 3 ligand, or any other ligand that directs the antisense polynucleotide agent to a site of interest, e.g., the liver of a subject.
- inhibitorting is used interchangeably with“reducing,”“silencing,” “downregulating” and other similar terms, and includes any level of inhibition.
- the phrase“inhibiting expression of an IGFALS gene” is intended to refer to inhibition of expression of any IGFALS gene (such as, e.g., a mouse IGFALS gene, a rat IGFALS gene, a monkey IGFALS gene, or a human IGFALS gene) as well as variants or mutants of an IGFALS gene.
- the IGFALS gene may be a wild-type IGFALS gene, a mutant IGFALS gene, or a transgenic IGFALS gene in the context of a genetically manipulated cell, group of cells, or organism.
- “Inhibiting expression of an IGFALS gene” includes any level of inhibition of an IGFALS gene, e.g., at least partial suppression of the expression of an IGFALS gene.
- the expression of the IGFALS may be assessed based on the level, or the change in the level, of any variable associated with IGFALS gene expression, e.g., IGFALS mRNA level, IGFALS protein level, or for example, signaling through the IGF pathway may also be measured to assess IGFALS expression. This level may be assessed in an individual cell or in a group of cells, including, for example, a sample derived from a subject.
- Inhibition may be assessed by a decrease in an absolute or relative level of one or more variables that are associated with IGFALS expression compared with a control level.
- the control level may be any type of control level that is utilized in the art, e.g., a pre-dose baseline level, or a level determined from a similar subject, cell, or sample that is untreated or treated with a control (such as, e.g., buffer only control or inactive agent control).
- expression of an IGFALS gene is inhibited by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, at least 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay method.
- the level of expression is detected using the in vitro method provided in the Examples.
- Inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS gene may be manifested by a reduction of the amount of mRNA expressed by a first cell or group of cells (such cells may be present, for example, in a sample derived from a subject) in which an IGFALS gene is transcribed and which has or have been treated (e.g., by contacting the cell or cells with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, or by administering an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention to a subject in which the cells are or were present) such that the expression of an IGFALS gene is inhibited, as compared to a second cell or group of cells substantially identical to the first cell or group of cells but which has not or have not been so treated (control cell(s)).
- the inhibition is assessed by expressing the level of mRNA in treated cells as a percentage of the level of mRNA in control cells, using the following formula:
- IGFALS gene silencing may be determined in any cell expressing IGFALS, either constitutively or by genetic engineering, and by any assay known in the art. The liver is the predominant site of IGFALS expression.
- Inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS protein may be manifested by a reduction in the level of the IGFALS protein that is expressed by a cell or group of cells (e.g., the level of protein expressed in a sample derived from a subject).
- the inhibiton of protein expression levels in a treated cell or group of cells may similarly be expressed as a percentage of the level of protein in a control cell or group of cells.
- a control cell or group of cells that may be used to assess the inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS gene includes a cell or group of cells that has not yet been contacted with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention.
- the control cell or group of cells may be derived from an individual subject (e.g., a human or animal subject) prior to treatment of the subject with an antisense polynucleotide agent.
- the level of IGFALS mRNA that is expressed by a cell or group of cells may be determined using any method known in the art for assessing mRNA expression.
- the level of expression of IGFALS in a sample is determined by detecting a transcribed polynucleotide, or portion thereof, e.g., mRNA of the IGFALS gene.
- RNA may be extracted from cells using RNA extraction techniques including, for example, using acid phenol/guanidine isothiocyanate extraction (RNAzol B; Biogenesis), RNeasy RNA preparation kits (Qiagen) or PAXgene (PreAnalytix, Switzerland).
- Typical assay formats utilizing ribonucleic acid hybridization include nuclear run-on assays, RT-PCR, RNase protection assays (Melton et al., Nuc. Acids Res.12:7035), northern blotting, in situ hybridization, and microarray analysis.
- the level of expression of IGFALS is determined using a nucleic acid probe.
- probe refers to any molecule that is capable of selectively binding to a specific IGFALS. Probes can be synthesized by one of skill in the art, or derived from appropriate biological preparations. Probes may be specifically designed to be labeled. Examples of molecules that can be utilized as probes include, but are not limited to, RNA, DNA, proteins, antibodies, and organic molecules.
- Isolated mRNA can be used in hybridization or amplification assays that include, but are not limited to, Southern or northern analyses, polymerase chain reaction (PCR) analyses and probe arrays.
- One method for the determination of mRNA levels involves contacting the isolated mRNA with a nucleic acid molecule (probe) that can hybridize to IGFALS mRNA.
- the mRNA is immobilized on a solid surface and contacted with a probe, for example by running the isolated mRNA on an agarose gel and transferring the mRNA from the gel to a membrane, such as nitrocellulose.
- the probe(s) are immobilized on a solid surface and the mRNA is contacted with the probe(s), for example, in an Affymetrix® gene chip array.
- a skilled artisan can readily adapt known mRNA detection methods for use in determining the level of IGFALS mRNA.
- An alternative method for determining the level of expression of IGFALS in a sample involves the process of nucleic acid amplification or reverse transcriptase (to prepare cDNA) of for example mRNA in the sample, e.g., by RT-PCR (the experimental embodiment set forth in Mullis, 1987, U.S. Pat. No.4,683,202), ligase chain reaction (Barany (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 88:189-193), self sustained sequence replication (Guatelli et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 87:1874-1878), transcriptional amplification system (Kwoh et al. (1989) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.
- the level of expression of IGFALS is determined by quantitative fluorogenic RT-PCR (i.e., the TaqMan TM System).
- the expression levels of IGFALS mRNA may be monitored using a membrane blot (such as used in hybridization analysis such as northern, Southern, dot, and the like), or microwells, sample tubes, gels, beads or fibers (or any solid support comprising bound nucleic acids). See U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,770,722, 5,874,219, 5,744,305, 5,677,195 and 5,445,934, which are incorporated herein by reference.
- the determination of IGFALS expression level may also comprise using nucleic acid probes in solution.
- the level of mRNA expression is assessed using branched DNA (bDNA) assays or real time PCR (qPCR).
- bDNA branched DNA
- qPCR real time PCR
- the level of IGFALS protein expression may be determined using any method known in the art for the measurement of protein levels. Such methods include, for example, electrophoresis, capillary electrophoresis, high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), thin layer
- TLC chromatography
- hyperdiffusion chromatography fluid or gel precipitin reactions
- absorption spectroscopy a colorimetric assays
- spectrophotometric assays flow cytometry
- immunodiffusion single or double
- immunoelectrophoresis western blotting
- radioimmunoassay RIA
- enzyme- linked immunosorbent assays ELISAs
- immunofluorescent assays electrochemiluminescence assays, and the like.
- sample refers to a collection of similar fluids, cells, or tissues isolated from a subject, as well as fluids, cells, or tissues present within a subject.
- biological fluids include blood, serum and serosal fluids, plasma, lymph, urine, cerebrospinal fluid, saliva, ocular fluids, and the like.
- Tissue samples may include samples from tissues, organs or localized regions. For example, samples may be derived from particular organs, parts of organs, or fluids or cells within those organs. In certain embodiments, samples may be derived from the liver (e.g., whole liver or certain segments of liver or certain types of cells in the liver, such as, e.g., hepatocytes).
- a“sample derived from a subject” refers to blood or plasma drawn from the subject. In further embodiments, a“sample derived from a subject” refers to liver tissue derived from the subject.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered to a subject such that the antisense polynucleotide agent is delivered to a specific site within the subject.
- the inhibition of expression of IGFALS may be assessed using measurements of the level or change in the level of IGFALS mRNA or IGFALS protein in a sample derived from fluid or tissue from the specific site within the subject.
- the site is the liver.
- the site may also be a subsection or subgroup of cells from any one of the aforementioned sites.
- the site may also include cells that express a particular type of receptor.
- contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent includes contacting a cell by any possible means.
- Contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent includes contacting a cell in vitro with the antisense polynucleotide agent or contacting a cell in vivo with the antisense polynucleotide agent.
- the contacting may be done directly or indirectly.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may be put into physical contact with the cell by the individual performing the method, or alternatively, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be put into a situation that will permit or cause it to subsequently come into contact with the cell.
- Contacting a cell in vitro may be done, for example, by incubating the cell with the antisense polynucleotide agent.
- Contacting a cell in vivo may be done, for example, by injecting the antisense polynucleotide agent into or near the tissue where the cell is located, or by injecting the antisense polynucleotide agent into another area, e.g., the bloodstream or the subcutaneous space, such that the agent will subsequently reach the tissue where the cell to be contacted is located.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may contain or be coupled to a ligand, e.g., GalNAc3, that directs the antisense polynucleotide agent to a site of interest, e.g., the liver.
- a ligand e.g., GalNAc3
- a site of interest e.g., the liver.
- a cell may also be contacted in vitro with an antisense polynucleotide agent and subsequently transplanted into a subject.
- contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent includes “introducing” or“delivering the antisense polynucleotide agent into the cell” by facilitating or effecting uptake or absorption into the cell.
- Absorption or uptake of an antisense polynucleotide agent can occur through unaided diffusive or active cellular processes, or by auxiliary agents or devices.
- Introducing an antisense polynucleotide agent into a cell may be in vitro or in vivo. For example, for in vivo introduction, antisense polynucleotide agent can be injected into a tissue site or administered systemically.
- In vivo delivery can also be done by a beta-glucan delivery system, such as those described in U.S. Patent Nos.5,032,401 and 5,607,677, and U.S. Publication No. 2005/0281781, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
- In vitro introduction into a cell includes methods known in the art such as electroporation and lipofection. Further approaches are described herein below or are known in the art. VIII. Methods for Treating or Preventing an IGFALS-Associated Disorder
- the present invention also provides therapeutic and prophylactic methods which include administering to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer, a polynucleotide agent, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent, or pharmaceutical compositions comprising a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent.
- an IGFALS-associated disease e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer
- a polynucleotide agent e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent
- pharmaceutical compositions comprising a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent.
- the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the treatment methods (and uses) of the invention include administering to the subject, e.g., a human, a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, thereby treating the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer, which include administering to the subject, e.g., a human, a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, and an additional therapeutic agent for the treatment of cancer, acromegaly, gigantism, or other interventions such as radiation or surgery, thereby treating the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- an IGFALS-associated disease e.g., acromegaly, gigantism
- cancer e.g., a human
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene e.g., a human
- a pharmaceutical composition
- the invention provides methods of preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS- associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the methods include administering to the subject a prophylactically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, thereby preventing at least one symptom in the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
- the invention provides methods for preventing acromegaly or cancer in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- acromegaly or cancer e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- Therapeutically effective amount is intended to include the amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent, that, when administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, is sufficient to effect treatment of the disease (e.g., by diminishing, ameliorating or maintaining the existing disease or one or more symptoms of disease).
- the "therapeutically effective amount” may vary depending on the antisense polynucleotide agent, how the agent is administered, the disease and its severity and the history, age, weight, family history, genetic makeup, the types of preceding or concomitant treatments, if any, and other individual characteristics of the subject to be treated.
- “Prophylactically effective amount,” as used herein, is intended to include the amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent that, when administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associate disease but not yet (or currently) experiencing or displaying symptoms of the disease, or a subject at risk of developing or suffering a recurrence of an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly or cancer, is sufficient to prevent or ameliorate the disease or one or more symptoms of the disease. Ameliorating the disease includes slowing the course of the disease or reducing the severity of later- developing disease.
- the “prophylactically effective amount” may vary depending on the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered, the degree of risk of disease, and the history, age, weight, family history, genetic makeup, the types of preceding or concomitant treatments, if any, and other individual characteristics of the patient to be treated.
- a “therapeutically effective amount” or“prophylactically effective amount” also includes an amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent that produces some desired local or systemic effect at a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to any treatment.
- Antisense polynucleotide agents employed in the methods of the present invention may be administered in a sufficient amount to produce a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to such treatment.
- the present invention provides uses of a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression.
- the present invention provides uses of a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention and an additional therapeutic agent or intervention, e.g., radiation or surgery, for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression.
- an additional therapeutic agent or intervention e.g., radiation or surgery
- the present invention provides use of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene in the manufacture of a medicament for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the present invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene in the manufacture of a medicament for use in combination with an additional therapeutic agent, for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- a subject e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, and an additional therapeutic agent, for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- the present invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention in the manufacture of a medicament for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as a an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression such as a an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS is administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease such that IGFALS levels, e.g., in a cell, most commonly a liver cell, of the subject are reduced as compared to an appropriate control by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to a level below the level of detection of the assay method as compared to an appropriate control.
- Additional therapeutic agents and interventions include the standard of care as well as other therapies that provide a benefit to the subject. Treatments for acromegaly and cancer are discussed below.
- the methods of the invention comprising administration of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention and treatments including the standard of care, e.g., surgery or radiation, as well as other therapies which provide a benefit to the subject.
- the additional therapeutic agents may be administered to the subject at the same time as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or at a different time.
- the additional therapeutic agent may be administered to the subject in the same formulation as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or in a different formulation as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS.
- the methods and uses of the invention include administering a composition described herein such that expression of the target IGFALS gene is decreased, such as for at least about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 12, 16, 18, 24, 28, 32, 36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64, 68, 72, 76, or 80 hours.
- expression of the target IGFALS gene is decreased for an extended duration, e.g., at least two, three, four, five, six, seven days or more, e.g., one week, two weeks, three weeks, or four weeks, or longer.
- Administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent according to the methods and uses of the invention may result in a reduction of the severity, signs, symptoms, or markers of such diseases or disorders in a patient with an IGFALS-associated disease.
- reduction in this context is meant a statistically significant decrease in such level as compared to an appropriate control.
- the reduction can be, for example, at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay used for detection.
- the reduction is the normalization of the level of a sign or symptom of a disease, a reduction in the difference between the subject level of a sign of the disease and the normal level of the sign for the disease (e.g., upper level of normal, lower level of normal, average of upper and lower level of normal).
- reduction can be understood as normalization of blood pressure, decreasing an elevated blood pressure or increasing a low blood pressure to reduce the difference from a normal reading.
- Efficacy of treatment or prevention of disease can be assessed, for example by measuring disease progression, disease remission, symptom severity, reduction in pain, dose of a medication required to sustain a treatment effect, level of a disease marker or any other measurable parameter appropriate for a given disease being treated or targeted for prevention. It is well within the ability of one skilled in the art to monitor efficacy of treatment or prevention by measuring any one of such parameters, or any combination of parameters. For example, efficacy of treatment of acromegaly and cancer are discussed below. Comparisons of the later readings with the initial readings provide a physician an indication of whether the treatment is effective. It is well within the ability of one skilled in the art to monitor efficacy of treatment or prevention by measuring any one of such parameters, or any combination of parameters.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or pharmaceutical composition thereof "effective against" an IGFALS- associated disease indicates that administration in a clinically appropriate manner results in a beneficial effect for at least a statistically significant fraction of patients, such as improvement of symptoms, a cure, a reduction in disease, extension of life, or other effect generally recognized as positive by medical doctors familiar with treating a IGFALS -associated disease and the related causes.
- a treatment or preventive effect is evident when there is a statistically significant improvement in one or more parameters of disease status, or by a failure to worsen or to develop symptoms where they would otherwise be anticipated.
- a favorable change of at least 10% in a measurable parameter of disease, and preferably at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50% or more can be indicative of effective treatment.
- Efficacy for a given antisense polynucleotide agent drug or formulation of that drug can also be judged using an experimental animal model for the given disease as known in the art. When using an experimental animal model, efficacy of treatment is evidenced when a statistically significant reduction in a marker or symptom is observed.
- the efficacy can be measured by a reduction in the severity of disease as determined by one skilled in the art of diagnosis based on a clinically accepted criteria as discussed below. Any positive change resulting in e.g., lessening of severity of disease measured using the appropriate scale, represents adequate treatment using an antisense polynucleotide agent or antisense polynucleotide agent formulation as described herein.
- Subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.01 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg, 0.1 mg/kg, 0.15 mg/kg, 0.2 mg/kg, 0.25 mg/kg, 0.3 mg/kg, 0.35 mg/kg, 0.4 mg/kg, 0.45 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, 0.55 mg/kg, 0.6 mg/kg, 0.65 mg/kg, 0.7 mg/kg, 0.75 mg/kg, 0.8 mg/kg, 0.85 mg/kg, 0.9 mg/kg, 0.95 mg/kg, 1.0 mg/kg, 1.1 mg/kg, 1.2 mg/kg, 1.3 mg/kg, 1.4mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg, 1.6 mg/kg, 1.7 mg/kg, 1.8 mg/kg, 1.9 mg/kg, 2.0 mg/kg, 2.1mg/kg, 2.2mg/kg, 2.3 mg/kg, 2.4 mg/kg, 2.5 mg/kg, 2.6 mg/kg, 2.7 mg/kg,
- composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and a lipid
- subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.01 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg,
- the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6,
- a composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and an N-acetylgalactosamine
- subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose of about 0.1 to 50 mg/kg, 0.25 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.1 to
- composition of the invention when a composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and an N-acetylgalactosamine, subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of 10 to 30 mg/kg of antisense polynucleotide agent. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
- subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5
- the antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered by intravenous infusion over a period of time, such as over a 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, or a 25 minute period.
- the administration may be repeated, for example, on a regular basis, such as weekly, biweekly (i.e., every two weeks) for one month, two months, three months, four months or longer.
- the treatments can be administered on a less frequent basis. For example, after administration weekly or biweekly for three months, administration can be repeated once per month, for six months or a year or longer.
- Administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent can reduce IGFALS levels, e.g., in a cell, tissue, blood, urine or other compartment of the patient by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay method used.
- patients Before administration of a full dose of the antisense polynucleotide agent, patients can be administered a smaller dose, such as a 5% infusion, and monitored for adverse effects, such as an allergic reaction.
- the patient can be monitored for unwanted immunostimulatory effects, such as increased cytokine (e.g., TNF-alpha or INF-alpha) levels.
- cytokine e.g., TNF-alpha or INF-alpha
- a composition according to the invention or a pharmaceutical composition prepared therefrom can enhance the quality of life.
- An antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be administered in“naked” form, or as a“free antisense polynucleotide agent.”
- a naked antisense polynucleotide agent is administered in the absence of a pharmaceutical composition.
- the naked antisense polynucleotide agent may be in a suitable buffer solution.
- the buffer solution may comprise acetate, citrate, prolamine, carbonate, or phosphate, or any combination thereof.
- the buffer solution is phosphate buffered saline (PBS).
- PBS phosphate buffered saline
- the pH and osmolarity of the buffer solution containing the antisense polynucleotide agent can be adjusted such that it is suitable for administering to a subject.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be administered as a pharmaceutical composition, such as an antisense polynucleotide agent liposomal formulation.
- Subjects that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS gene expression are those having an IGFALS-associated disease or disorder as described herein.
- a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has acromegaly.
- a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has giantism.
- a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has cancer.
- a subject having an IGFALS- associated disease has metastatic cancer.
- the invention further provides methods and uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent or a pharmaceutical composition thereof (including methods and uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent and compositions and methods known in the art for treating a subject that would benefit from reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, e.g., a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, in combination with other pharmaceuticals or other therapeutic methods, e.g., with known pharmaceuticals or known therapeutic methods, such as, for example, those which are currently employed for treating these disorders.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS is
- an agent useful in treating an IGFALS-associated disease as described elsewhere herein is administered in combination with, e.g., an agent useful in treating an IGFALS-associated disease as described elsewhere herein.
- the antisense polynucleotide agent and an additional therapeutic agent or treatment may be administered at the same time or in the same combination, e.g., parenterally, or the additional therapeutic agent can be administered as part of a separate composition or at separate times or by another method known in the art or described herein.
- the present invention also provides methods of using an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition containing an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention to reduce or inhibit IGFALS expression in a cell.
- the present invention provides an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for use in reducing or inhibiting IGFALS expression in a cell.
- use of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for the manufactuire of a medicament for reducing or inhibiting IGFALS expression in a cell are provided.
- the methods and uses include contacting the cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent, e.g., a antisense polynucleotide agent, of the invention and maintaining the cell for a time sufficient to obtain antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALS gene in the cell.
- an antisense polynucleotide agent e.g., a antisense polynucleotide agent
- Acromegaly is a clinical syndrome that, depending on its stage of progression, may not manifest with clear diagnostic features. Diagnosis should be considered in patients with 2 or more of the following comorbidities: new-onset diabetes, diffuse arthralgias, new-onset or difficult-to-control hypertension, cardiac disease including biventricular hypertrophy and dia- stolic or systolic dysfunction, fatigue, headaches, carpal tunnel syndrome, sleep apnea syndrome, diaphoresis, loss of vision, colon polyps, and progressive jaw malocclusion.
- a serum IGF-I level if accompanied by a large number of results from age- and sex-matched normal subjects, is a good tool to assess integrated GH secretion and is excellent for diagnosis, monitoring, and especially screening.
- a random IGF-I value (a marker of integrated GH secretion) should be measured for diagnosis and for monitoring after a therapeutic intervention.
- Serum GH assays are not standardized and should not be used nterchangeably. The nadir GH suppression after administration of glucose has been considered the“gold standard” test for acromegaly, however, a conflict exists regarding the threshold for diagnosis. The panel recommends that GH measurements be performed at baseline, then every 30 minutes for a total of 120 minutes after administration of glucose.
- the inability to suppress serum GH to less than 1 ng/mL after glucose administration is typically considered the diagnostic criterion for acromegaly, however, in a consensus guideline in 2000, the diagnosis of acromegaly was excluded if the patient had a random GH measurement less than 0.4 ng/mL and a normal IGF-1 value. Although a nadir GH concentration of less than 1 ng/mL after administration of glucose is the standard
- the 2011 panel suggests consideration of a lower nadir GH cut point at 0.4 ng/mL after glucose administration because of the enhanced assay sensitivity and more frequent finding of modest GH hypersecretion.
- a diagnosis of acromegaly will be made by one of skill in the art considering the totality of the evidence for the patient under consideration.
- MRI magnetic resonance imaging
- Visual field testing should be performed if there is optic chiasmal compression noted on the MRI or if the patient has complaints of reduced peripheral vision.
- Further biochemical testing should include a serum prolactin level (to evaluate for hyperprolactinemia) and assessment of anterior and posterior pituitary function (for potential hypopituitarism).
- the goals of therapy for acromegaly are to (1) control biochemical indices of activity, (2) control tumor size and prevent local mass effects, (3) reduce signs and symptoms of disease, (4) prevent or improve medical comorbidities, and (5) prevent early mortality.
- the primary mode of therapy is surgery, which is recommended for all patients with
- microadenomas and for all patients who have macroadenomas with associated mass effects.
- a role for surgical de-bulking of macroadenomas to improve the response to subsequent medical therapy has been advocated, as well as primary medical therapy alone.
- Medical therapy is generally used in the adjuvant setting. Irradiation, either conventional fractionated RT or stereotactic radiosurgery, is largely relegated to an adjuvant role. Availability of specific therapeutic options and cost of these interventions are taken into account with decisions regarding therapy.
- Surgical interventions can be curative for many subjects. Surgically resected tissue should be analyzed to understand the tumor biology to potentially provide guidance for treatment. Biochemical analyses are also performed post-operatively to assess the surgical outcome.
- RNAs provided herein can be used at any time in conjunction with surgical intervention (i.e., before or after surgery).
- Adjunctive medical therapy is used in patients who cannot achieve a complete cure by surgical intervention.
- Medical therapies fall into three catagories: dopamine agonists, somatostatin analogs (SSAs), and a GH receptor antagonist.
- SSAs somatostatin analogs
- GH receptor antagonist a GH receptor antagonist
- Dopamine agonists include cabergoline and bromocriptine.
- the agents are a good first line therapy, especially in patients with mild biochemical activity, as they are realtively inexpensive and orally administered.
- side effects include gastrointestinal upset, orthostatic hypotension, headache, and nasal congestion.
- Somatostatin analogs include octreotide (Sandostatin®) LAR (long-acting release, administered as an intramuscular injection) and lanreotide (Somatuline®) Autogel (administered as a deep subcutaneous depot injection).
- SSAs are less convenient for use than dopamine agonists as they must be administered by injection (50 mcg three times daily Sandostatin® Injection subcutaneously for 2 weeks followed by Sandostatin® LAR 20 mg intragluteally every 4 weeks for 3 months; or 60, 90, or 120mg of Somatuline® every 28 days by deep subcutaneous injection).
- SSAs are effective in normalizing IGF-I and GH levels in approximately 55% of patients.
- the clinical and biochemical responses to SSAs are inversely related to tumor size and degree of GH hypersecretion.
- Octreotide LAR and lanreotide Autogel have similar efficacy profiles.
- cabergoline or pegvisomant may be effective for further lowering one or both of GH and IGF-1 levels.
- Potential side effects of SSAs include gastrointestinal upset, malabsorption, constipation, gallbladder disease, hair loss, and bradycardia.
- Pegvisomant a GH receptor antagonist
- Side effects of pegvisomant include flulike illness, allergic reactions, and increase in liver enzymes. Patients treated with pegvisomant must undergo routine liver enzyme tests. Because endogenous GH levels increase with pegvisomant administration and pegvisomant may be cross-measured in GH assays, serum GH levels are not specific and should not be monitored in patients receiving pegvisomant. Instead, serum IGF-1 levels are monitored.
- Combinations of various medical therapies may be useful in the treatment of some acromegaly patients.
- Radiation therapy is used as an adjunctive treatment is patients who do not respond sufficiently to surgical or medical interventions.
- Surgical interventions e.g., carpal tunnel release, joint replacement surgery
- physical therapy e.g., physical therapy
- analgesic medications can be used to treat conditions associated with bone or soft tissue overgrowth.
- Respiratory disorders including sleep apnea and higher susceptibility to respiratory infections can be treated with standard interventions and preventive strategies (e.g., influenza and pneumococcal vaccinations).
- Cardiovascular disease, hypertension, and stroke can be managed using standard monitoring (e.g., blood pressure, cholesterol, and lipid level monitoring) and medical treatment.
- Treatment can include, but does not require, resolution of the co-morbidities of acromegaly. Treatment can include, but does not require, prevention or reduction of the development of one or more of the comorbidities associated with
- treatment for acromegaly can further include, but does not require, treatment of one or more of the comorbidities associated with acromegaly.
- iRNA administered to an iRNA provided herein is not considered to have a favorable response to or be effectively treated by the iRNA.
- the development of PD after a period of CR, PR, or PD is understood as having been effectively treated by the iRNA provided herein.
- RNA agents provided herein can be used in conjunction with other interventions for the treatment of cancer, e.g., surgery, chemotherapy, or radiation.
- all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art to which this invention belongs.
- suitable methods and materials are described below. All publications, patent applications, patents, and other references mentioned herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety. In case of conflict, the present specification, including definitions, will control.
- the materials, methods, and examples are illustrative only and not intended to be limiting.
- the antisense polynucleotides targeting IGFALS were synthesized using standard synthesis methods well known in the art.
- a set of antisense polynucleotide agents targeting the human IGFALS (insulin like growth factor binding protein acid labile subunit) were designed using custom R and Python scripts.
- the rationale and method for the set of designs is as follows: the predicted efficacy for every potential 19mer from position 1 through the end of the mRNA was determined with a linear model derived the direct measure of mRNA knockdown from more than 20,000 distinct antisense polynucleotide agent designs targeting a large number of vertebrate genes. Starting from position 1 a set of oligos was created by
- Mouse Hepa1-6 cells (ATCC order# CRL-1830) were seeded at a density of 20000 cells/well in regular, white-walled 96-well tissue culture plates. Plasmid (IGFALS-Luc reporter from Alnylam, SEQ ID NO: 6) transfection was carried out at a concentration of 50ng/well with 0.5 ⁇ l/well
- Lipofectamine2000 (Invitrogen GmbH, Düsseldorf, Germany, cat.# 11668-019) as described by the manufacturer.
- IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agents and controls (Aha-1 siRNA XD-00033, inactive F-Luc siRNA XD-00194 and R-Luc siRNA XD-00379) were added simultaneously at a concentration of 10nM.
- Cells were incubated for 24 hours in a humidified incubator at 37°C/5% CO 2 . Twenty-four hours post-transfection, cells were lysed using luciferase reagents as described by the manufacturer (Promega, Dual-Glo Luciferase Assay System, cat.# E2980).
- Renilla luciferase protein levels were normalized to firefly luciferase levels.
- IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agent and control four individual data points were collected.
- an active R-Luc siRNA XD-00379 with full match to the renilla open reading frame was synthesized and tested in parallel to the IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agents. Transfections of Aha-1 and F-Luc siRNAs as well as mock treatment were used for normalization since target sites of these molecules were unrelated to IGFALS target sites on the reporter plasmid.
- nucleotide monomers used in nucleic acid sequence representation. It will be understood that these monomers, when present in an oligonucleotide, are mutually linked by 5'-3'- h h i r n
Landscapes
- Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
- Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
- Molecular Biology (AREA)
- Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
- Biochemistry (AREA)
- Biomedical Technology (AREA)
- Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
- Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
- Epidemiology (AREA)
- Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
- Organic Chemistry (AREA)
- Zoology (AREA)
- Biotechnology (AREA)
- Public Health (AREA)
- Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
- Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
- Microbiology (AREA)
- Plant Pathology (AREA)
- Biophysics (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
- Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
Abstract
The invention relates to antisense polynucleotide agents insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) gene, and methods of using such antisense polynucleotide agents to inhibit expression of IGFALS and to treat subjects having an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly and cancer.
Description
POLYNUCLEOTIDE AGENTS TARGETING INSULIN-LIKE GROWTH FACTOR BINDING PROTEIN, ACID LABILE SUBUNIT (IGFALS) AND METHODS OF USE
THEREOF Related Applications
This application claims the benefit of priority to U.S. Provisional Patent Application No.: 62/315,255, filed on March 30, 2016, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference. Sequence Listing
The instant application contains a Sequence Listing which has been submitted electronically in ASCII format and is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. Said ASCII copy, created on January 11, 2017, is named 121301-05720_SL.txt and is 141,038 bytes in size. Background of the Invention
Acromegaly is a progressive and life threatening disease resulting from growth hormone hypersecretion from a benign pituitary tumor. Excess growth hormone leads to approximately a 10 year reduction in lifespan and a reduced quality of life. Acromegaly is associated with cardiovascular disease including hypertension and cardiac hypertrophy, cerebrovascular disease including stroke, metabolic disease including diabetes, and respiratory disease including sleep apnea. Mortality rates in acromegaly are correlated with growth hormone and IGF-1 levels, with increased growth hormone concentrations being associated with shorter life spans (Holdaway et al., JCEM, 2004). Clinical features most commonly associated with acromegaly are acral enlargement, maxofacial changes, excessive sweating, athralgias, headache, hypogonadal symptoms, visual deficit, fatigue, weight gain, and galactorrhea. Diagnostic criteria are provided in the American Association of Clinical Endocrinologists Medical Guidelines for Clinical Practice for the Diagnosis and Treatment of Acromegaly– 2011 Update (Katznelson et al., Endocr. Pract. 17(Suppl. 4). As the foregoing symptoms may be associated with a number of diseases or conditions, diagnosis of acromegaly often does not occur until several years after the initiation of growth hormone hypersecretion. Diagnosis includes detection of an increased level of insulin growth factor-1 (IGF-1) and growth hormone elevation in an oral glucose tolerance test. The diagnosis is confirmed by detection of a GH-hypersecreting pituitary tumor, typically by MRI.
Current treatment options for acromegaly are insufficient for many patients.
Surgical removal of the pituitary adenoma by transsphenoidal surgery results in a cure for about 50-60% of patients. Subjects for whom surgical intervention is not possible or does not result in a cure are treated with first-line pharmacological therapy which includes dopamine agonists or sustained-release somatostatin analogs (SSAs). This therapy results in a good control for the disease for about 70% of these patients for whom surgery cannot
provide a cure. The use of SSAs, however, is limited to subjects expressing a somatostatin receptor on their tumor. Subjects whose disease cannot be controlled by the first-line pharmacological therapy are treated with SOMAVERT® (pegvisomant), a growth hormone receptor antagonist, which is administered by daily subcutaneous injection. Finally, radiotherapy, which suffers from low efficacy and high side effects, is used as a last resort.
The insulin growth factor system is also associated with abnormal growth in cancer and metastasis (see, e.g., Samani et al., Endocrine Rev., 2007). The IGF system has become a target for anticancer agents, both as primary and adjunctive therapy.
Currently, treatments for acromegaly and cancer do not fully meet patient needs. Therefore, there is a need for therapies for subjects suffering from acromegaly or cancer. Summary of the Invention
The present invention provides polynucleotide agents and compositions comprising such agents which which target nucleic acids encoding insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid. The IGFALS nucleic acid may be within a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human. The present invention also provides methods and combination therapies for treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS mRNA, e.g., an IGFALS -associated disease, such as acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer using the polynucleotide agents and compositions of the invention.
Accordingly, in some aspects, the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS). The agents comprise 4 to 50 contiguous nucleotides, wherein at least one of the contiguous nucleotides is a modified nucleotide, and wherein the nucleotide sequence of the agent is at least 80% complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5.
In certain embodiments, the equivalent region is a target region of SEQ ID NO:1, e.g., at least 14 contiguous nucleotides selected from the group consisting of residues 23-42, 87-106, 121- 207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417-470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132-1163,1220-1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1. In certain embodiments, the equivalent region is any one of the target regions of SEQ ID NO:1 provided in Table 3 or 5.
In an aspect, the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises at least 8 contiguous nucleotides differing by no more than 3 nucleotides from any one of the nucleotide sequences listed in Table 3 or 5. In an aspect, the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises at least 8 contiguous nucleotides differing by no more than 3 nucleotides from residues 23-42, 87-106, 121-207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417-470, 396-472,
549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132-1163,1220- 1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1.
In some embodiments, substantially all of the nucleotides of the polynucleotide agents of the invention are modified nucleotides. In other embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the polynucleotide agent are modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, the polynucleotides are modified as shown in Table 5.
The polynucleotide agent may be about 10 to about 40 nucleotides in length; about 10 to about 30 nucleotides in length; about 18 to about 30 nucleotides in length; about 10 to about 24 nucleotides in length; about 18 to about 24 nucleotides in length; about 12 or about 20 nucleotides in length.
In one embodiment, the modified nucleotide comprises a modified sugar moiety selected from the group consisting of a 2′-O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′- methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
In one embodiment, the bicyclic sugar moiety has a (—CRH—)n group forming a bridge between the 2′ oxygen and the 4′ carbon atoms of the sugar ring, wherein n is 1 or 2 and wherein R is H, CH3 or CH3OCH3.
In a further embodiment, n is 1 and R is CH3.
In another embodiment, the modified nucleotide is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, the modified nucleotide comprises a modified internucleoside linkage, such as a phosphorothioate internucleoside linkage.
In one embodiment, an agent of the invention comprises a plurality of 2′-deoxynucleotides flanked on each side by at least one nucleotide having a modified sugar moiety.
In one embodiment, the agent is a gapmer comprising a gap segment comprised of linked 2′- deoxynucleotides positioned between a 5′ and a 3′ wing segment.
In one embodiment, the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′- O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
In one embodiment, the 5’-wing segment is about 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2, 3, 4, or 5 nucleotides in length.
In one embodiment, the 3’-wing segment is about 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2, 3, 4, or 5 nucleotides in length.
In one embodiment, the gap segment is about 5 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 8-12, 10 nucleotides in length.
In one aspect, the present invention provides polynucleotide agents for inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression, comprising a gap segment consisting of linked deoxynucleotides; a 5’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides; a 3’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides; wherein the gap segment is positioned between the 5’-wing segment
and the 3’-wing segment and wherein each nucleotide of each wing segment comprises a modified sugar.
In one embodiment, the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is five nucleotides in length.
In another embodiment, the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is four nucleotides in length.
In yet another embodiment, the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is three nucleotides in length.
In another embodiment, the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is two nucleotides in length.
In one embodiment, the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′- O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety.
In some embodiments, the agents of the invention further comprise a ligand.
In certain embodiments, the ligand is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc). The ligand may be one or more GalNAc attached to the agent through a monovalent, a bivalent, or a trivalent branched linker. In one embodiment, the agent is conjugated to the ligand at the 3’-terminus.
In some embodiments, the agents of the invention comprise a plurality, e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6, of GalNAc, each independently attached to a plurality of nucleotides of the agent through a plurality of monovalent linkers.
In one embodiment, the ligand is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) derivative.
In one embodiment, the ligand is
In one aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutical compositions for inhibiting expression of an insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) gene comprising the agents of the invention.
In one embodiment, the agent is present in an unbuffered solution, such as saline or water. In another embodiment, the agent is is present in a buffer solution, such as a buffer comprising acetate, citrate, prolamine, carbonate, or phosphate or any combination thereof.
In one embodiment, the buffer solution is phosphate buffered saline (PBS).
In another aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutical composition comprising an agent of the invention and a lipid formulation, such as a lipid formulation comprising an LNP or a MC3.
In one aspect, the present invention provides methods of inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression in a cell. The methods include contacting the cell with the agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention; and maintaining the cell for a time sufficient to obtain antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALSgene in the cell.
In some embodiments, the cell is within a subject.
In some embodiments, the subject is a human. In some embodiments, the subject is not human.
In certain embodiments, the IGFALS expression is inhibited by at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay, preferably using the method provided in Example 2 with the antisense oligonucleotide at a concentration of 10 nM. In certain embodiments, the IGFALS expression is inhibited by at least 40% using the method and cell line provided in Example 2 with the antisense oligonucleotide at a concentration of 10 nM.
In another aspect, the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression. The methods include administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of an agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention, thereby treating the subject.
In yet another aspect, the present invention provides methods of preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression. The methods include administering to the subject a prophylactically effective amount of the agent of the invention or a pharmaceutical composition of the invention, thereby preventing at least one symptom in the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
In one embodiment, the administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent to the subject causes a decrease or normalization in one or more signs of symptoms of an IGFALS-associated disease or condition, a decrease in IGFALS protein levels, or a decrease in the IGFALS signaling pathway.
In one embodiment, the disorder is an IGFALS-associated disease.
In another embodiment, the IGFALS-associated disease is selected from acromegaly, gigantism, and cancer.
In some embodiments, the IGFALS-associated disease is acromegaly.
In other embodiments, the IGFALS-associated disease is or gigantism.
In other embodiments, the IGFALS-associated disease is cancer.
In some embodiments the subject is human. In some embodiments, the subject is not human.
In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an additional agent for the treatment of an IGFALS-associated disease to the subject. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an inhibitor of growth hormone to a subject with an IGFALS-associated disease. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering an inhibitor of signaling in the IGF pathway to a subject with an IGFALS associated disease. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include administering a chemotherapeutic agent to the subject.
In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include treating the subject with radiation. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include treating the subject with surgery.
In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include measuring IGFALs levels in the subject. In some embodiments, the methods of the invention further include measuring signaling in the IGF pathway in the subject. Brief Description of the Drawings
Figure 1 is a schematic showing various aspects of the IGF signaling pathway. Detailed Description of the Invention
The present invention provides polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, and compositions comprising such agents which target nucleic acids encoding insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) (e.g., mRNA encoding IGFALS as provided in, for example, any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-4). The polynucleotide agents bind to nucleic acids encoding IGFALS via, e.g.,Watson-Crick base pairing, and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid.
The polynucleotide agents of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, include a nucleotide sequence which is 4 to 50 nucleotides or less in length and which is 80% complementary to at least part of an mRNA transcript of an IGFALS gene. The use of these polynucleotide agents enables the targeted inhibition of RNA expression or activity of an IGFALS gene in mammals.
The present inventors have demonstrated that polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, targeting IGFALS can mediate antisense inhibition in vitro resulting in significant inhibition of expression of an IGFALS gene. Thus, methods and compositions including these polynucleotide agents are useful for treating a subject who would benefit by a reduction in the levels or activity of an IGFALS protein, such as a subject having an IGFALS associated disease, such as acromegaly, or gigantism, or cancer.
The present invention also provides methods and combination therapies for treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS gene, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, such as acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer using the
polynucleotide agents and compositions of the invention.
The present invention also provides methods for preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disorder that would benefit from inhibiting or reducing the expression of an IGFALS gene,
e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease. For example, when the disease is acromegaly, at least one sign or symptom of acromegaly previously displayed in the subject including, elevated IGF-1 level, sleep apnea, joint pain, symptomatic carpal tunnel syndrome, hypertension,
biventricular cardiac hypertrophy, cardiac arrhythmia, fatigue, and weakness is prevented using the methods of the invention. These symptoms may be assessed in vitro or in vivo using any method known in the art. Although the nadir GH suppression ofter administration of glucose can be considered the“gold standard” test for acromegaly (Katznelson et al., 2011, Endocrine Practice), suppression may not be observed after treatment with the RNAi agents provided herein due to their proposed mechanism of action. Moreover, subjects may have accomplished clinically relevant beneficial outcomes with lowering of IGF-1 without reaching normal GH levels.
It is understood that normal IGF-1 levels are dependent both on the age and gender of the subject, with younger subjects having lower IGF-1 levels than older subjects. Therefore, when comparing IGF-1 levels to determine the lowering or normalizing of the level, an appropriate control must be selected. Appropriate controls include, for example, an IGF-1 level prior to treatment (when available) or an age and gender matched control. In certain embodiments, IGF-1 levels are monitored or tested on multiple occasions to confirm a change in IGF-1 level in a subject. In preferred embodiments, the IGF-1 level is decreased sufficiently to provide a clinically beneficial outcome for the subject.
When the disease is cancer, signs or symptoms of the disease can be monitored by evaluating a subject for maintenance or preferably reduction of tumor burden of the primary tumor or metastatic tumor(s) or the prevention of metastasis. Methods for detection and monitoring of tumor burden are known in the art, e.g., RECIST criteria as provided in Eisenhauer et al., 2009, New response evaluation criteria in solid tumours: Revised RECIST guideline (version 1.1). Eur. J. Cancer. 45:228-247.
. The present invention further provides compositions comprising polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, which effect antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene. The IGFALS gene may be within a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human.
The combination therapies of the present invention include administering to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, a polynucleotide agent of the invention and an additional therapeutic or intervention depending on the disease to be treated (e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer) and as discussed herein. In certain embodiments, combination therapies can include radiation treatments. In certain embodiments, combination treatments can include surgery. The following detailed description discloses how to make and use polynucleotide agents to inhibit the mRNA or protein expression of an IGFALS gene, as well as compositions, uses, and methods for treating subjects having diseases and disorders that would benefit from inhibition or reduction of the expression of this gene.
I. Definitions
In order that the present invention may be more readily understood, certain terms are first defined. In addition, it should be noted that whenever a value or range of values of a parameter are recited, it is intended that values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
The articles“a” and“an” are used herein to refer to one or to more than one (i.e., to at least one) of the grammatical object of the article. By way of example,“an element” means one element or more than one element, e.g., a plurality of elements.
The term "including" is used herein to mean, and is used interchangeably with, the phrase "including but not limited to".
The term "or" is used herein to mean, and is used interchangeably with, the term "and/or," unless context clearly indicates otherwise. For example, a nucleoside with a modified base or a modified sugar is understood to include the options of a nucleoside with a modified base, a nucleoside with a modified sugar, and a nucleoside with a modified base and a modified sugar.
The term“about” is used herein to mean within the typical ranges of tolerances in the art. For example,“about” can be understood as about 2 standard deviations from the mean. In certain embodiments, about means +10%. In certain embodiments, about means +5%. When about is present before a series of numbers or a range, it is understood that“about” can modify each of the numbers in the series or range.
The term“at least” prior to a number or series of numbers is understood to include the number adjacent to the term“at least”, and all subsequent numbers or integers that could logically be included, as clear from context. For example, the number of nucleotides in a nucleic acid molecule must be an integer. For example,“at least 17 nucleotides of a 20 nucleotide nucleic acid molecule” means that 17, 18, 19, or 20 nucleotides have the indicated property. When at least is present before a series of numbers or a range, it is understood that“at least” can modify each of the numbers in the series or range.
As used herein,“no more than” or“less than” is understood as the value adjacent to the phrase and logical lower values or intergers, as logical from context, to zero. For example, a duplex with mismatches to a target site of“no more than 2 nucleotides” has a 2, 1, or 0 mismatches. When “no more than” is present before a series of numbers or a range, it is understood that“no more than” can modify each of the numbers in the series or range.
As used herein,“up to” as in“up to 10” is understood as up to and including 10, i.e., 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10.
Ranges provided herein are understood to include all individual interger values and all subranges within the ranges.
In the event of an inconsistency between the sequence and the indicated site targeted on a sequence provided in the sequence listing or database, the sequence provided in the table
predominates.
As used herein,“insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit” or “IGFALS” is a serum protein that binds insulin-like growth factors, increasing their half-life and their vascular localization. Production of the encoded protein, predominantly in the liver, which contains twenty leucine-rich repeats, is stimulated by growth hormone. Defects in this gene are a cause of acid-labile subunit deficiency, which maifests itself in a delayed and slow puberty. Three transcript variants encoding two different isoforms have been found for this gene. The gene can also be known as ALS or ACLSD. Further information on IGFALS is provided, for example in the NCBI Gene database at www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/gene/3483 (which is incorporated herein by reference as of the date of filing this application).
As used herein,“insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit,” used interchangeably with the term“IGFALS,” refers to the naturally occurring gene that encodes an IGF-1 binding protein. The amino acid and complete coding sequences of the reference sequence of the human IGFALS gene may be found in, for example, GenBank Accession No. GI: 225579150 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_004970.2; SEQ ID NO:1) and GenBank
Accession No. GI:225579151 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_001146006.1; SEQ ID NO: 5). Mammalian orthologs of the human IGFALS gene may be found in, for example, GI:
142388344 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_008340.3, mouse; SEQ ID NO:2); GI: 71896591 (RefSeq Accession No. NM_053329.2, rat; SEQ ID NO:2); GenBank Accession Nos. GI: 544514850 (RefSeq Accession No. XM_005590898.1, cynomolgus monkey; SEQ ID NO:4).
A number of naturally occurring SNPs are known and can be found, for example, in the SNP database at the NCBI at www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/SNP/snp_ref.cgi?locusId=3483 (which is incorporated herein by reference as of the date of filing this application) which lists SNPs in human IGFALS. In preferred embodiments, such naturally occuring variants are included within the scope of the IGFALS gene sequence.
Additional examples of IGFALS mRNA sequences are readily available using publicly available databases, e.g., GenBank, UniProt, and OMIM.
The terms“polynucleotide agent,”“antisense polynucleotide agent”“antisense compound”, and“agent” as used interchangeably herein, refer to an agent comprising a single-stranded oligonucleotide that contains RNA as that term is defined herein, and which targets nucleic acid molecules encoding IGFALS (e.g., mRNA encoding IGFALS as provided in, for example, any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5). The antisense polynucleotide agents specifically bind to the target nucleic acid molecules via hydrogen bonding (e.g., Watson-Crick, Hoogsteen, or reversed Hoogsteen hydrogen bonding) and interfere with the normal function of the targeted nucleic acid (e.g., by an antisense mechanism of action). This interference with or modulation of the function of a target nucleic acid by the polynucleotide agents of the present invention is referred to as“antisense inhibition.”
The functions of the target nucleic acid molecule to be interfered with may include functions such as, for example, translocation of the RNA to the site of protein translation, translation of protein from the RNA, splicing of the RNA to yield one or more mRNA species, and catalytic activity which may be engaged in or facilitated by the RNA.
In some embodiments, antisense inhibition refers to“inhibiting the expression” of target nucleic acid levels or target protein levels in a cell, e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a mammalian subject, in the presence of the antisense polynucleotide agent complementary to a target nucleic acid as compared to target nucleic acid levels or target protein levels in the absence of the antisense polynucleotide agent. For example, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention can inhibit translation in a stoichiometric manner by base pairing to the mRNA and physically obstructing the translation machinery, see Dias, N. et al., (2002) Mol Cancer Ther 1:347-355.
As used herein,“target sequence” refers to a contiguous portion of the nucleotide sequence of an mRNA molecule formed during the transcription of an IGFALS gene, including mRNA that is a product of RNA processing of a primary transcription product.
As used herein,“target nucleic acid” refers to a nucleic acid molecule to which an antisense polynucleotide agent specifically hybridizes.
As used herein, the term“specifically hybridizes” refers to an antisense polynucleotide agent having a sufficient degree of complementarity between the antisense polynucleotide agent and a target nucleic acid to induce a desired effect, while exhibiting minimal or no effects on non-target nucleic acids under conditions in which specific binding is desired, e.g., under physiological conditions in the case of in vivo assays and therapeutic treatments.
A target sequence may be about 4-50 nucleotides in length, e.g., about 8-45, 10-45, 10-40, 10- 35, 10-30, 10-20, 11-45, 11-40, 11-35, 11-30, 11-20, 12-45, 12-40, 12-35, 12-30, 12-25, 12-20, 13-45, 13-40, 13-35, 13-30, 13-25, 13-20, 14-45, 14-40, 14-35, 14-30, 14-25, 14-20, 15-45, 15-40, 15-35, 15- 30, 15-25, 15-20, 16-45, 16-40, 16-35, 16-30, 16-25, 16-20, 17-45, 17-40, 17-35, 17-30, 17-25, 17-20, 18-45, 18-40, 18-35, 18-30, 18-25, 18-20, 19-45, 19-40, 19-35, 19-30, 19-25, 19-20, e.g., 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 contiguous nucleotides of the nucleotide sequence of an mRNA molecule formed during the transcription of an IGFALS gene. Ranges and lengths intermediate to the above recited ranges and lengths are also contemplated to be part of the invention.
The terms“complementary,”“fully complementary” and“substantially complementary” are used herein with respect to the base matching between an antisense polynucleotide agent and a target sequence. The term“complementarity” refers to the capacity for pairing between nucleobases of a first nucleic acid and a second nucleic acid.
As used herein, an antisense polynucleotide agent that is“substantially complementary to at least part of” a messenger RNA (mRNA) refers to an antisense polynucleotide agent that is substantially complementary to a contiguous portion of the mRNA of interest (e.g., an mRNA encoding IGFALS). For example, a polynucleotide is complementary to at least a part of an IGFALS mRNA if the sequence is substantially complementary to a non-interrupted portion of an mRNA encoding IGFALS.
As used herein, the term“region of complementarity” refers to the region of the antisense polynucletiode agent that is substantially complementary to a sequence, for example a target
sequence, e.g., an IGFALS nucleotide sequence, as defined herein. Where the region of complementarity is not fully complementary to the target sequence, the mismatches can be in the internal or terminal regions of the molecule. Generally, the most tolerated mismatches are in the terminal regions, e.g., within 5, 4, 3, or 2 nucleotides of the 5’- or 3’-terminus of the antisense polynucleotide.
As used herein, and unless otherwise indicated, the term“complementary,” when used to describe a first nucleotide sequence in relation to a second nucleotide sequence, refers to the ability of a polynucleotide comprising the first nucleotide sequence to hybridize and form a duplex structure under certain conditions with the second nucleotide sequence, as will be understood by the skilled person. Such conditions can, for example, be stringent conditions, where stringent conditions can include: 400 mM NaCl, 40 mM PIPES pH 6.4, 1 mM EDTA, 50oC or 70oC for 12-16 hours followed by washing (see, e.g.,“Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Sambrook, et al. (1989) Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press). Other conditions, such as physiologically relevant conditions as can be encountered inside an organism, can apply. The skilled person will be able to determine the set of conditions most appropriate for a test of complementarity of two sequences in accordance with the ultimate application of the nucleotides.
Complementary sequences include those nucleotide sequences of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention that base-pair to a second nucleotide sequence over the entire length of one or both nucleotide sequences. Such sequences can be referred to as“fully complementary” with respect to each other herein. However, where a first sequence is referred to as“substantially complementary” with respect to a second sequence herein, the two sequences can be fully complementary, or they can form one or more, but generally not more than 5, 4, 3, or 2 mismatched base pairs upon hybridization for a duplex up to 30 base pairs, while retaining the ability to hybridize under the conditions most relevant to their ultimate application, e.g., antisense inhibition of target gene expression.
“Complementary” sequences, as used herein, can also include, or be formed entirely from, non-Watson-Crick base pairs or base pairs formed from non-natural and modified nucleotides, in so far as the above requirements with respect to their ability to hybridize are fulfilled. Such non-Watson- Crick base pairs include, but are not limited to, G:U Wobble or Hoogstein base pairing.
As used herein, the term“strand comprising a sequence” refers to an oligonucleotide comprising a chain of nucleotides that is described by the sequence referred to using the standard nucleotide nomenclature.
“G,”“C,”“A,”“T,” and“U” each generally stand for a nucleotide that contains guanine, cytosine, adenine, thymidine and uracil as a base, respectively. However, it will be understood that the terms“deoxyribonucleotide”,“ribonucleotide” and“nucleotide” can also refer to a modified nucleotide, as further detailed below, or a surrogate replacement moiety (see, e.g., Table 2). The skilled person is well aware that guanine, cytosine, adenine, and uracil can be replaced by other moieties without substantially altering the base pairing properties of an oligonucleotide comprising a nucleotide bearing such replacement moiety. For example, without limitation, a nucleotide comprising inosine as its base can base pair with nucleotides containing adenine, cytosine, or uracil.
Hence, nucleotides containing uracil, guanine, or adenine can be replaced in the nucleotide sequences of the agents featured in the invention by a nucleotide containing, for example, inosine. In another example, adenine and cytosine anywhere in the oligonucleotide can be replaced with guanine and uracil, respectively to form G-U Wobble base pairing with the target mRNA. Sequences containing such replacement moieties are suitable for the compositions and methods featured in the invention.
A“nucleoside” is a base-sugar combination. The“nucleobase” (also known as“base”) portion of the nucleoside is normally a heterocyclic base moiety.“Nucleotides” are nucleosides that further include a phosphate group covalently linked to the sugar portion of the nucleoside. For those nucleosides that include a pentofuranosyl sugar, the phosphate group can be linked to the 2′, 3′, or 5′ hydroxyl moiety of the sugar.“Polynucleotides,” also referred to as“oligonucleotides,” are formed through the covalent linkage of adjacent nucleosides to one another, to form a linear polymeric oligonucleotide. Within the polynucleotide structure, the phosphate groups are commonly referred to as forming the internucleoside linkages of the polynucleotide.
In general, the majority of nucleotides of the antisense polynucleotide agents are
ribonucleotides, but as described in detail herein, the agents may also include one or more non- ribonucleotides, e.g., a deoxyribonucleotide. In addition, as used in this specification, an“antisense polynucleotide agent” may include nucleotides (e.g., ribonucleotides or deoxyribonucleotides) with chemical modifications; an antisense polynucleotide agent may include substantial modifications at multiple nucleotides.
As used herein, the term“modified nucleotide” refers to a nucleotide having, independently, a modified sugar moiety, a modified internucleotide linkage, or modified nucleobase. Thus, the term modified nucleotide encompasses substitutions, additions or removal of, e.g., a functional group or atom, to internucleoside linkages, sugar moieties, or nucleobases. The modifications suitable for use in the antisense polynucleiotde agents of the invention include all types of modifications disclosed herein or known in the art. Any such modifications, as used in nucleotides, are encompassed by “antisense polynucleotide agent” for the purposes of this specification and claims.
As used herein, a“subject” is an animal, such as a mammal, including a primate (such as a human, a non-human primate, e.g., a monkey, and a chimpanzee), a non-primate (such as a cow, a pig, a camel, a llama, a horse, a goat, a rabbit, a sheep, a hamster, a guinea pig, a cat, a dog, a rat, a mouse, a horse, and a whale), or a bird (e.g., a duck or a goose). In an embodiment, the subject is a human, such as a human being treated or assessed for a disease, disorder, or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression; a human at risk for a disease, disorder, or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression; or a human having a disease, disorder or condition that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
As used herein, the terms“treating” or“treatment” refer to a beneficial or desired result including, but not limited to, alleviation or amelioration of one or more symptoms associated with e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer. "Treatment" can also mean prolonging survival as compared to expected survival in the absence of treatment.
The term“lower” or“reduce” and the like in the context of the level of an IGFALS in a subject or a disease marker or symptom refers to a statistically significant decrease in such level. The decrease can be, for example, at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, or 95%. In certain embodiments, the decrease is down to a level accepted as within the range of normal for an individual without such disorder which can also be referred to as a normalization of a level. For example, lowering cholesterol to 180 mg/dl or lower would be considered to be within the range of normal for a subject. A subject having a cholesterol level of 230 mg/dl with a cholesterol level decreased to 210 mg/dl would have a cholesterol level that was decreased by 40% (230-210/230-180 = 20/50 = 40% reduction). In certain embodiments, the reduction is the normalization of the level of a sign or symptom of a disease, a reduction in the difference between the subject level of a sign of the disease and the normal level of the sign for the disease (e.g., upper level of normal, lower level of normal, average of upper and lower level of normal). For example, reduction can be understood as normalization of blood pressure, decreasing an elevated blood pressure or increasing a low blood pressure to reduce the difference from a normal reading.
As used herein,“prevention” or“preventing,” when used in reference to a disease, disorder or condition thereof, that would benefit from a reduction in expression of an IGFALS gene or production of IGFALS protein, refers to a reduction in the likelihood that a subject will develop a symptom associated with such a disease, disorder, or condition, e.g., a symptom of IGFALS gene expression, such as the presence of elevated levels of proteins in the IGF signaling pathway, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer. The failure to develop a disease, disorder or condition, or the reduction in the development of a symptom or comorbidity associated with such a disease, disorder or condition (e.g., by at least about 10% on a clinically accepted scale for that disease or disorder), or the exhibition of delayed symptoms or disease progression (e.g., delayed cancer progression as determined using RECIST criteria) by days, weeks, months or years is considered effective prevention.
As used herein, the term " insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit” or “IGFALS-associated disease,” is a disease or disorder that is caused by, or associated with IGFALS gene expression or IGFALS protein production. The term "IGFALS-associated disease” includes a disease, disorder or condition that would benefit from a decrease in IGFALS gene expression, replication, or protein activity. Non-limiting examples of IGFALS-associated diseases include, for example, acromegaly, gigantism (a type of acromegaly, which refers to excess GH secretion that occurs during childhood when growth plates are open, leading to accelerated growth), and cancer, especially metastatic cancer.
In some embodiments, an IGFALS-associated disease is acromegaly. In some embodiments, an IGFALS-associated disease is gigantism. In other embodiments, an IGFALS-associated disease is cancer.
II. Polynucleotide Agents of the Invention
The present invention provides polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, and compositions comprising such agents, which target an IGFALS gene and inhibit the expression of the IGFALS gene. In one embodiment, the polynucleotide agents, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, inhibit the expression of an IGFALS gene in a cell, such as a cell within a subject, e.g., a mammal, such as a human having an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
The polynucleotde agents of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, include a region of complementarity which is complementary to at least a part of an mRNA formed in the expression of an IGFALS gene. The region of complementarity may be about 50 nucleotides or less in length (e.g., 22-12, 20-14, 50, 49, 48, 47, 46, 45, 44, 43, 42, 41, 40, 39, 38, 37, 36, 35, 34, 33, 32, 31, 30, 29, 28, 27, 26, 25, 24, 23, 22, 21, 20, 19, 18, 17, 16, 15, 14, 13, 12, 11, or 10 nucleotides or less in length). Upon contact with a cell expressing the IGFALS gene, the antisense polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene (e.g., a human, a primate, a non-primate, or a bird IGFALS gene) by at least 20% as assayed by, for example, a PCR or branched DNA (bDNA)-based method, or by a protein-based method, such as by immunofluorescence analysis, using, for example, western blotting, or flow cytometric techniques. In preferred embodiments, the inhibition of expression is determined at a 10 nM concetration using the cell line, delivery method, and qPCR method provided in Example 2 herein. In preferred embodiments, the polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene by at least 40% by the assay in Example 2. In certain embodiments, the polynucleotide agent inhibits the expression of the IGFALS gene by at least 40% by the assay in Example 2.
The region of complementarity between an antisense polynucleotide agent and a target sequence may be substantially complementary (e.g., there is a sufficient degree of complementarity between the antisense polynucleotide agent and a target nucleic acid to so that they specifically hybridize and induce a desired effect), but is generally fully complementary to the target sequence. The target sequence can be derived from the sequence of an mRNA formed during the expression of an IGFALS gene.
Accordingly, in one aspect, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention specifically hybridizes to a target nucleic acid molecule, such as the mRNA encoding IGFALS, and comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence which corresponds to the reverse complement of a nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5.
In some embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be substantially complementary to the target sequence. For example, an antisense polynucleotide agent that is substantially complementary to the target sequence may include a contiguous nucleotide sequence comprising no more than 5 mismatches (e.g., no more than 1, no more than 2, no more than 3, no more than 4, or no more than 5 mismatches) when hybridizing to a target sequence, such as to the corresponding region of a nucleic acid which encodes a mammalian IGFALS mRNA. In some embodiments, the contiguous nucleotide sequence comprises no more than a single mismatch when
hybridizing to the target sequence, such as the corresponding region of a nucleic acid which encodes a mammalian IGFALS mRNA.
In some embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention that are substantially complementary to the target sequence comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence which is at least 80% complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5, such as at least 85%, 90%, 95%, or 100% complementary.
In some embodiments, an antisense polynucleotide agent comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence which is fully complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs: 1-5 (or a fragment of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5). For example, the nucleotide sequence of an antisense polynucleotide agent is fully complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of nucleotides 1-20 of GenBank Accession No. GI: 225579150 (SEQ ID NO:1) (see, e.g., Table 3 or 5).
An antisense polynucleotide agent may comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence of about 4 to 50 nucleotides in length, or any subrange falling within that range, e.g., about 8-49, 8-48, 8-47, 8- 46, 8-45, 8-44, 8-43, 8-42, 8-41, 8-40, 8-39, 8-38, 8-37, 8-36, 8-35, 8-34, 8-33, 8-32, 8-31, 8-30, 8-29, 8-28, 8-27, 8-26, 8-25, 8-24, 8-23, 8-22, 8-21, 8-20, 8-19, 8-18, 8-17, 8-16, 8-15, 8-14, 8-13, 8-12, 8- 11, 8-10, 8-9, 10-49, 10-48, 10-47, 10-46, 10-45, 10-44, 10-43, 10-42, 10-41, 10-40, 10-39, 10-38, 10- 37, 10-36, 10-35, 10-34, 10-33, 10-32, 10-31, 10-30, 10-29, 10-28, 10-27, 10-26, 10-25, 10-24, 10-23, 10-22, 10-21, 10-20, 10-19, 10-18, 10-17, 10-16, 10-15, 10-14, 10-13, 10-12, 10-11,11-49, 11-48, 11- 47, 11-46, 11-45, 11-44, 11-43, 11-42, 11-41, 11-40, 11-39, 11-38, 11-37, 11-36, 11-35, 11-34, 11-33, 11-32, 11-31, 11-30, 11-29, 11-28, 11-27, 11-26, 11-25, 11-24, 11-23, 11-22, 11-21, 11-20, 11-19, 11- 18, 11-17, 11-16, 11-15, 11-14, 11-13, 11-12, 12-49, 12-48, 12-47, 12-46, 12-45, 12-44, 12-43, 12-42, 12-41, 12-40, 12-39, 12-38, 12-37, 12-36, 12-35, 12-34, 12-33, 12-32, 12-31, 12-30, 12-29, 12-28, 12- 27, 12-26, 12-25, 12-24, 12-23, 12-22, 12-21, 12-20, 12-19, 12-18, 12-17, 12-16, 12-15, 12-14, 12-13, 13-49, 13-48, 13-47, 13-46, 13-45, 13-44, 13-43, 13-42, 13-41, 13-40, 13-39, 13-38, 13-37, 13-36, 13- 35, 13-34, 13-33, 13-32, 13-31, 13-30, 13-29, 13-28, 13-27, 13-26, 13-25, 13-24, 13-23, 13-22, 13-21, 13-20, 13-19, 13-18, 13-17, 13-16, 13-15, 13-14, 14-49, 14-48, 14-47, 14-46, 14-45, 14-44, 14-43, 14- 42, 14-41, 14-40, 14-39, 14-38, 14-37, 14-36, 14-35, 14-34, 14-33, 14-32, 14-31, 14-30, 14-29, 14-28, 14-27, 14-26, 14-25, 14-24, 14-23, 14-22, 14-21, 14-20, 14-19, 14-18, 14-17, 14-16, 14-15, 15-49, 15- 48, 15-47, 15-46, 15-45, 15-44, 15-43, 15-42, 15-41, 15-40, 15-39, 15-38, 15-37, 15-36, 15-35, 15-34, 15-33, 15-32, 15-31, 15-30, 15-29, 15-28, 15-27, 15-26, 15-25, 15-24, 15-23, 15-22, 15-21, 15-20, 15- 19, 15-18, 15-17, 15-16,16-49, 16-48, 16-47, 16-46, 16-45, 16-44, 16-43, 16-42, 16-41, 16-40, 16-39, 16-38, 16-37, 16-36, 16-35, 16-34, 16-33, 16-32, 16-31, 16-30, 16-29, 16-28, 16-27, 16-26, 16-25, 16- 24, 16-23, 16-22, 16-21, 16-20, 16-19, 16-18, 16-17, 17-49, 17-48, 17-47, 17-46, 17-45, 17-44, 17-43, 17-42, 17-41, 17-40, 17-39, 17-38, 17-37, 17-36, 17-35, 17-34, 17-33, 17-32, 17-31, 17-30, 17-29, 17- 28, 17-27, 17-26, 17-25, 17-24, 17-23, 17-22, 17-21, 17-20, 17-19, 17-18, 18-49, 18-48, 18-47, 18-46, 18-45, 18-44, 18-43, 18-42, 18-41, 18-40, 18-39, 18-38, 18-37, 18-36, 18-35, 18-34, 18-33, 18-32, 18- 31, 18-30, 18-29, 18-28, 18-27, 18-26, 18-25, 18-24, 18-23, 18-22, 18-21, 18-20, 19-49, 19-48, 19-47,
19-46, 19-45, 19-44, 19-43, 19-42, 19-41, 19-40, 19-39, 19-38, 19-37, 19-36, 19-35, 19-34, 19-33, 19- 32, 19-31, 19-30, 19-29, 19-28, 19-27, 19-26, 19-25, 19-24, 19-23, 19-22, 19-21, 19-20, 20-49, 20-48, 20-47, 20-46, 20-45, 20-44, 20-43, 20-42, 20-41, 20-40, 20-39, 20-38, 20-37, 20-36, 20-35, 20-34, 20- 33, 20-32, 20-31, 20-30, 20-29, 20-28, 20-27, 20-26, 20-25, 20-24,20-23, 20-22, 20-21, 21-49, 21-48, 21-47, 21-46, 21-45, 21-44, 21-43, 21-42, 21-41, 21-40, 21-39, 21-38, 21-37, 21-36, 21-35, 21-34, 21- 33, 21-32, 21-31, 21-30, 21-29, 21-28, 21-27, 21-26, 21-25, 21-24, 21-23, 21-22, 22-49, 22-48, 22-47, 22-46, 22-45, 22-44, 22-43, 22-42, 22-41, 22-40, 22-39, 22-38, 22-37, 22-36, 22-35, 22-34, 22-33, 22- 32, 22-31, 22-30, 22-29, 22-28, 22-27, 22-26, 22-25, 22-24, 22-23, 23-49, 23-48, 23-47, 23-46, 23-45, 23-44, 23-43, 23-42, 23-41, 23-40, 23-39, 23-38, 23-37, 23-36, 23-35, 23-34, 23-33, 23-32, 23-31, 23- 30, 23-29, 23-28, 23-27, 23-26, 23-25, 23-24, 24-49, 24-48, 24-47, 24-46, 24-45, 24-44, 24-43, 24-42, 24-41, 24-40, 24-39, 24-38, 24-37, 24-36, 24-35, 24-34, 24-33, 24-32, 24-31, 24-30, 24-29, 24-28, 24- 27, 24-26, 24-25, 25-49, 25-48, 25-47, 25-46, 25-45, 25-44, 25-43, 25-42, 25-41, 25-40, 25-39, 25-38, 25-37, 25-36, 25-35, 25-34, 25-33, 25-32, 25-31, 25-30, 25-29, 25-28, 25-27, 25-26,26-49, 26-48, 26- 47, 26-46, 26-45, 26-44, 26-43, 26-42, 26-41, 26-40, 26-39, 26-38, 26-37, 26-36, 26-35, 26-34, 26-33, 26-32, 26-31, 26-30, 26-29, 26-28, 26-27, 27-49, 27-48, 27-47, 27-46, 27-45, 27-44, 27-43, 27-42, 27- 41, 27-40, 27-39, 27-38, 27-37, 27-36, 27-35, 27-34, 27-33, 27-32, 27-31, 27-30, 27-29, 27-28, 28-49, 28-48, 28-47, 28-46, 28-45, 28-44, 28-43, 28-42, 28-41, 28-40, 28-39, 28-38, 28-37, 28-36, 28-35, 28- 34, 28-33, 28-32, 28-31, 28-30, 28-29, 29-49, 29-48, 29-47, 29-46, 29-45, 29-44, 29-43, 29-42, 29-41, 29-40, 29-39, 29-38, 29-37, 29-36, 29-35, 29-34, 29-33, 29-32, 29-31, 29-30, 30-49, 30-48, 30-47, 30- 46, 30-45, 30-44, 30-43, 30-42, 30-41, 30-40, 30-39, 30-38, 30-37, 30-36, 30-35, 30-34, 30-33, 30-32, or 30-31 nucleotides in length, e.g., 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 nucleotides in length.
In some embodiments, an antisense polynucleotide agent may comprise a contiguous nucleotide sequence of no more than 22 nucleotides, e.g., no more than any of 21 nucleotides, 20 nucleotides, 19 nucleotides, no more than 18 nucleotides, 17 nucleotides, 16 nucleotides, than 15 nucleotides, or 14 nucleotides. In other embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are 20 nucleotides in length. In other embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are 14 nucleotides in length. In certain embodiments, the polynucleotide is at least 12 nucleotides in length.
In one aspect, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention includes a sequence selected from sequences provided in Table 3 or Table 5. It will be understood that, although the sequences in Table 5 are described as modified or conjugated sequences, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, may also comprise any one of the sequences set forth in Table 5 that is un-modified, un- conjugated, or modified or conjugated differently than described therein.
By virtue of the nature of the nucleotide sequences provided in Table 3 or 5, antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may include one of the sequences of Table 3 or 5 minus only a few nucleotides on one or both ends and yet remain similarly effective as compared to the antisense polynucleotide agents described above. Hence, antisense polynucleotide agents having a sequence of
at least 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14,15, 16, 17, 18, 19, or 20 contiguous nucleotides derived from one of the sequences of Table 3 or 5 and differing in their ability to inhibit the expression of an IGFALS gene by not more than 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, or 30% inhibition from an antisense polynucleotide agent comprising the full sequence, are contemplated to be within the scope of the present invention.
In addition, the antisense polynucleotide agents provided in Table 3 and 5 identify a region(s) in an IGFALS transcript that is susceptible to antisense inhibition (e.g., the regions encompassed by the start and end positions relative to the in nucleotide sequences in Table 3, or at least 14 contiguous nucleotides of residues 23-42, 87-106, 121-207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417- 470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672-700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132- 1163,1220-1239, 1354-1382, or 1737-1756 of SEQ ID NO:1). As such, the present invention further features antisense polynucleotide agents that target within one of these sites.
As used herein, an antisense polynucleotide agent is said to target within a particular site of an RNA transcript if the antisense polynucleotide agent promotes antisense inhibition of the target at that site. Such an antisense polynucleotide agent will generally include at least 14 contiguous nucleotides from one of the sequences provided in Table 3 or 5 coupled to additional nucleotide sequences taken from the region contiguous to the selected sequence in an IGFALS gene.
While a target sequence is generally 4-50 nucleotides in length, there is wide variation in the suitability of particular sequences in this range for directing antisense inhibition of any given target RNA. Various software packages and the guidelines set out herein provide guidance for the identification of optimal target sequences for any given gene target, but an empirical approach can also be taken in which a“window” or“mask” of a given size (as a non-limiting example, 20 nucleotides) is literally or figuratively (including, e.g., in silico) placed on the target RNA sequence to identify sequences in the size range that can serve as target sequences. By moving the sequence “window” progressively one nucleotide upstream or downstream of an initial target sequence location, the next potential target sequence can be identified, until the complete set of possible sequences is identified for any given target size selected. This process, coupled with systematic synthesis and testing of the identified sequences (using assays as described herein or as known in the art) to identify those sequences that perform optimally can identify those RNA sequences that, when targeted with an antisense polynucleotide agent, mediate the best inhibition of target gene expression. Thus, while the sequences identified, for example, in Table 3 or 5 represent effective target sequences, it is contemplated that further optimization of antisense inhibition efficiency can be achieved by progressively“walking the window” one nucleotide upstream or downstream of the given sequences to identify sequences with equal or better inhibition characteristics.
Further, it is contemplated that for any sequence identified, e.g., in Table 3 or 5, further optimization could be achieved by systematically either adding or removing nucleotides to generate longer or shorter sequences and testing those sequences generated by walking a window of the longer or shorter size up or down the target RNA from that point. Again, coupling this approach to generating new candidate targets with testing for effectiveness of antisense polynucleotide agents based on those target sequences in an inhibition assay as known in the art or as described herein can
lead to further improvements in the efficiency of inhibition. Further still, such optimized sequences can be adjusted by, e.g., the introduction of modified nucleotides as described herein or as known in the art, addition or changes in length, or other modifications as known in the art or discussed herein to further optimize the molecule (e.g., increasing serum stability or circulating half-life, increasing thermal stability, enhancing transmembrane delivery, targeting to a particular location or cell type, increasing interaction with silencing pathway enzymes, increasing release from endosomes) as an expression inhibitor. III. Polynucleotide Agents of the Invention
In some embodiments, the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, are un-modified, and do not comprise, e.g., chemical modifications or conjugations known in the art and described herein. In another embodiment, at least one of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention is chemically modified to enhance stability or other beneficial characteristics. In certain embodiments of the invention, substantially all of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention are modified. In other embodiments of the invention, all of the nucleotides of a polynucleotide agent of the invention are modified. Antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention in which“substantially all of the nucleotides are modified” are largely but not wholly modified and can include not more than 5, 4, 3, 2, or 1 unmodified nucleotides. Exemplary modified antisense polynucleotide agents are provided in Table 5.
The nucleic acids featured in the invention can be synthesized or modified by standard methods known in the art as further discussed below, e.g., solution-phase or solid-phase organic synthesis or both, e.g., by use of an automated DNA synthesizer, such as are commercially available from, for example, Biosearch, Applied Biosystems, Inc. Well-established methods for the synthesis or modification of the nucleic acids featured in the invention are described in, for example,“Current protocols in nucleic acid chemistry,” Beaucage, S.L. et al. (Edrs.), John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New York, NY, USA, which is hereby incorporated herein by reference. Modifications include, for example, end modifications, e.g., 5’-end modifications (phosphorylation, conjugation, inverted linkages) or 3’-end modifications (conjugation, DNA nucleotides, inverted linkages, etc.); base modifications, e.g., replacement with stabilizing bases, destabilizing bases, or bases that base pair with an expanded repertoire of partners, removal of bases (abasic nucleotides), or conjugated bases; sugar modifications (e.g., at the 2’-position or 4’-position) or replacement of the sugar; or backbone modifications, including modification or replacement of the phosphodiester linkages.
Specific examples of modified nucleotides useful in the embodiments described herein include, but are not limited to nucleotides containing modified backbones or no natural
internucleoside linkages. Nucleotides having modified backbones include, among others, those that do not have a phosphorus atom in the backbone. For the purposes of this specification, and as sometimes referenced in the art, modified nucleotides that do not have a phosphorus atom in their internucleoside backbone can also be considered to be oligonucleosides. In some embodiments, a modified antisense polynucleotide agent will have a phosphorus atom in its internucleoside backbone.
Modified nucleotide backbones include, for example, phosphorothioates, chiral phosphorothioates, phosphorodithioates, phosphotriesters, aminoalkylphosphotriesters, methyl and other alkyl phosphonates including 3'-alkylene phosphonates and chiral phosphonates, phosphinates, phosphoramidates including 3'-amino phosphoramidate and aminoalkylphosphoramidates, thionophosphoramidates, thionoalkylphosphonates, thionoalkylphosphotriesters, and
boranophosphates having normal 3'-5' linkages, 2'-5'-linked analogs of these, and those having inverted polarity wherein the adjacent pairs of nucleoside units are linked 3'-5' to 5'-3' or 2'-5' to 5'-2'. Various salts, mixed salts and free acid forms are also included.
Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of the above phosphorus-containing linkages include, but are not limited to, U.S. Patent Nos.3,687,808; 4,469,863; 4,476,301; 5,023,243; 5,177,195; 5,188,897; 5,264,423; 5,276,019; 5,278,302; 5,286,717; 5,321,131; 5,399,676; 5,405,939; 5,453,496; 5,455,233; 5,466,677; 5,476,925; 5,519,126; 5,536,821; 5,541,316; 5,550,111; 5,563,253; 5,571,799; 5,587,361; 5,625,050; 6,028,188; 6,124,445; 6,160,109; 6,169,170; 6,172,209; 6, 239,265; 6,277,603; 6,326,199; 6,346,614; 6,444,423; 6,531,590; 6,534,639; 6,608,035; 6,683,167; 6,858,715; 6,867,294; 6,878,805; 7,015,315; 7,041,816; 7,273,933; 7,321,029; and US Pat RE39464, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Modified nucleotide backbones that do not include a phosphorus atom therein have backbones that are formed by short chain alkyl or cycloalkyl internucleoside linkages, mixed heteroatoms and alkyl or cycloalkyl internucleoside linkages, or one or more short chain heteroatomic or heterocyclic internucleoside linkages. These include those having morpholino linkages (formed in part from the sugar portion of a nucleoside); siloxane backbones; sulfide, sulfoxide and sulfone backbones;
formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; methylene formacetyl and thioformacetyl backbones; alkene containing backbones; sulfamate backbones; methyleneimino and methylenehydrazino backbones; sulfonate and sulfonamide backbones; amide backbones; and others having mixed N, O, S and CH2 component parts.
Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of the above oligonucleosides include, but are not limited to, U.S. Patent Nos.5,034,506; 5,166,315; 5,185,444; 5,214,134; 5,216,141;
5,235,033; 5,64,562; 5,264,564; 5,405,938; 5,434,257; 5,466,677; 5,470,967; 5,489,677; 5,541,307; 5,561,225; 5,596,086; 5,602,240; 5,608,046; 5,610,289; 5,618,704; 5,623,070; 5,663,312; 5,633,360; 5,677,437; and, 5,677,439, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
In other embodiments, suitable nucleotide mimetics are contemplated for use in antisense polynucleotide agents, in which both the sugar and the internucleoside linkage, i.e., the backbone, of the nucleotide units are replaced with novel groups. The base units are maintained for hybridization with an appropriate nucleic acid target compound. One such oligomeric compound, an RNA mimetic that has been shown to have excellent hybridization properties, is referred to as a peptide nucleic acid (PNA). In PNA compounds, the sugar backbone of an RNA is replaced with an amide containing backbone, in particular an aminoethylglycine backbone. The nucleobases are retained and are bound directly or indirectly to aza nitrogen atoms of the amide portion of the backbone. Representative U.S.
patents that teach the preparation of PNA compounds include, but are not limited to, U.S. Patent Nos. 5,539,082; 5,714,331; and 5,719,262, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference. Additional PNA compounds suitable for use in the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention are described in, for example, in Nielsen et al., Science, 1991, 254, 1497-1500.
Some embodiments featured in the invention include polynucleotides with phosphorothioate backbones and oligonucleosides with heteroatom backbones, and in particular --CH2--NH--CH2-, -- CH2--N(CH3)--O--CH2--[known as a methylene (methylimino) or MMI backbone], --CH2--O-- N(CH3)--CH2--, --CH2--N(CH3)--N(CH3)--CH2-- and --N(CH3)--CH2--CH2--[wherein the native phosphodiester backbone is represented as --O--P--O--CH2--] of the above-referenced U.S. Patent No. 5,489,677, and the amide backbones of the above-referenced U.S. Patent No.5,602,240. In some embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents featured herein have morpholino backbone structures of the above-referenced U.S. Patent No.5,034,506.
Modified nucleotides can also contain one or more modified or substituted sugar moieties. The antisense polynucleotide agents featured herein can include one of the following at the 2'- position: OH; F; O-, S-, or N-alkyl; O-, S-, or N-alkenyl; O-, S- or N-alkynyl; or O-alkyl-O-alkyl, wherein the alkyl, alkenyl and alkynyl can be substituted or unsubstituted C1 to C10 alkyl or C2 to C10 alkenyl and alkynyl. Exemplary suitable modifications include O[(CH2)nO] mCH3, O(CH2).nOCH3, O(CH2)nNH2, O(CH2) nCH3, O(CH2)nONH2, and O(CH2)nON[(CH2)nCH3)]2, where n and m are from 1 to 10.
In other embodiments, antisense polynucleotide agents include one of the following at the 2' position: C1 to C10 lower alkyl, substituted lower alkyl, alkaryl, aralkyl, O-alkaryl or O-aralkyl, SH, SCH3, OCN, Cl, Br, CN, CF3, OCF3, SOCH3, SO2CH3, ONO2, NO2, N3, NH2, heterocycloalkyl, heterocycloalkaryl, aminoalkylamino, polyalkylamino, substituted silyl, an RNA cleaving group, a reporter group, an intercalator, a group for improving the pharmacokinetic properties of an antisense polynucleotide, or a group for improving the pharmacodynamic properties of an antisense
polynucleotide agent, and other substituents having similar properties. In some embodiments, the modification includes a 2'-methoxyethoxy (2'-O--CH2CH2OCH3, also known as 2'-O-(2- methoxyethyl) or 2'-MOE) (Martin et al., Helv. Chim. Acta, 1995, 78:486-504) i.e., an alkoxy-alkoxy group. Another exemplary modification is 2'-dimethylaminooxyethoxy, i.e., a O(CH2)2ON(CH3)2 group, also known as 2'-DMAOE, as described in examples herein below, and 2'- dimethylaminoethoxyethoxy (also known in the art as 2'-O-dimethylaminoethoxyethyl or 2'- DMAEOE), i.e., 2'-O--CH2--O--CH2--N(CH2)2.
Other modifications include 2'-methoxy (2'-OCH3), 2'-aminopropoxy (2'-OCH2CH2CH2NH2) and 2'-fluoro (2'-F). Similar modifications can also be made at other positions on a nucleotide of an antisense polynucleotide agent, particularly the 3' position of the sugar on the 3' terminal nucleotide. Antisense polynucleotide agents can also have sugar mimetics such as cyclobutyl moieties in place of the pentofuranosyl sugar. Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of such modified sugar structures include, but are not limited to, U.S. Patent Nos.4,981,957; 5,118,800; 5,319,080; 5,359,044; 5,393,878; 5,446,137; 5,466,786; 5,514,785; 5,519,134; 5,567,811; 5,576,427; 5,591,722;
5,597,909; 5,610,300; 5,627,053; 5,639,873; 5,646,265; 5,658,873; 5,670,633; and 5,700,920, certain of which are commonly owned with the instant application. The entire contents of each of the foregoing are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Additional nucleotides having modified or substituted sugar moieties for use in the polynucleotide agents of the invention include nucleotides comprising a bicyclic sugar. A“bicyclic sugar” is a furanosyl ring modified by the bridging of two atoms. A“bicyclic nucleoside” (“BNA”) is a nucleoside having a sugar moiety comprising a bridge connecting two carbon atoms of the sugar ring, thereby forming a bicyclic ring system. In certain embodiments, the bridge connects the 4′- carbon and the 2′-carbon of the sugar ring. Thus, in some embodiments an antisense polynucleotide agent may include one or more locked nucleic acids. A“locked nucleic acid” (“LNA”) is a nucleotide having a modified ribose moiety in which the ribose moiety comprises an extra bridge connecting the 2' and 4' carbons. In other words, an LNA is a nucleotide comprising a bicyclic sugar moiety comprising a 4'-CH2-O-2' bridge. This structure effectively "locks" the ribose in the 3'-endo structural conformation. The addition of locked nucleic acids to santisense polynucleotide agents has been shown to increase santisense polynucleotide agent stability in serum, and to reduce off-target effects (Elmen, J. et al., (2005) Nucleic Acids Research 33(1):439-447; Mook, OR. et al., (2007) Mol Canc Ther 6(3):833-843; Grunweller, A. et al., (2003) Nucleic Acids Research 31(12):3185-3193).
Examples of bicyclic nucleosides for use in the polynucleotides of the invention include without limitation nucleosides comprising a bridge between the 4′ and the 2′ ribosyl ring atoms. In certain embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention include one or more bicyclic nucleosides comprising a 4′ to 2′ bridge. Examples of such 4′ to 2′ bridged bicyclic nucleosides, include but are not limited to 4′-(CH2)—O-2′ (LNA); 4′-(CH2)—S-2′; 4′-(CH2)2—O-2′ (ENA); 4′-CH(CH3)—O-2′ (also referred to as“constrained ethyl” or“cEt”) and 4′- CH(CH2OCH3)—O-2′ (and analogs thereof; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No.7,399,845); 4′-C(CH3)(CH3)— O-2′ (and analogs thereof; see e.g., US Patent No.8,278,283); 4′-CH2—N(OCH3)-2′ (and analogs thereof; see e.g., US Patent No.8,278,425); 4′-CH2—O—N(CH3)-2′ (see, e.g.,U.S. Patent
Publication No.2004/0171570); 4′-CH2—N(R)—O-2′, wherein R is H, C1-C12 alkyl, or a protecting group (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No.7,427,672); 4′-CH2—C(H)(CH3)-2′ (see, e.g., Chattopadhyaya et al., J. Org. Chem., 2009, 74, 118-134); and 4′-CH2—C(═CH2)-2′ (and analogs thereof; see, e.g., US Patent No.8,278,426). The entire contents of each of the foregoing are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Additional representative U.S. Patents and US Patent Publications that teach the preparation of locked nucleic acid nucleotides include, but are not limited to, the following: U.S. Patent Nos. 6,268,490; 6,525,191; 6,670,461; 6,770,748; 6,794,499; 6,998,484; 7,053,207; 7,034,133;7,084,125; 7,399,845; 7,427,672; 7,569,686; 7,741,457; 8,022,193; 8,030,467; 8,278,425; 8,278,426; 8,278,283; US 2008/0039618; and US 2009/0012281, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Any of the foregoing bicyclic nucleosides can be prepared having one or more stereochemical sugar configurations including for example α-L-ribofuranose and β-D-ribofuranose (see WO
99/14226).
In one particular embodiment of the invention, an antisense polynucleotide agent can include one or more constrained ethyl nucleotides. As used herein, a "constrained ethyl nucleotide" or "cEt" is a locked nucleic acid comprising a bicyclic sugar moiety comprising a 4'-CH(CH3)-O-2' bridge. In one embodiment, a constrained ethyl nucleotide is in an S conformation and is referred to as an“S- constrained ethyl nucleotide” or“S-cEt.”
Modified nucleotides included in the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention can also contain one or more sugar mimetics. For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may include a “modified tetrahydropyran nucleotide” or“modified THP nucleotide.” A“modified tetrahydropyran nucleotide” has a six-membered tetrahydropyran“sugar” substituted in for the pentofuranosyl residue in normal nucleotides (a sugar surrogate). Modified THP nucleotides include, but are not limited to, what is referred to in the art as hexitol nucleic acid (HNA), anitol nucleic acid (ANA), manitol nucleic acid (MNA) (see, e.g., Leumann, Bioorg. Med. Chem., 2002, 10, 841-854), or fluoro HNA (F-HNA).
In some embodiments of the invention, sugar surrogates comprise rings having more than 5 atoms and more than one heteroatom. For example nucleotides comprising morpholino sugar moieties and their use in oligomeric compounds has been reported (see for example: Braasch et al.,
Biochemistry, 2002, 41, 4503-4510; and U.S. Patent Nos.5,698,685; 5,166,315; 5,185,444; and 5,034,506). Morpholinos may be modified, for example by adding or altering various substituent groups from the above morpholino structure. Such sugar surrogates are referred to herein as“modified morpholinos.”
Combinations of modifications are also provided without limitation, such as 2′-F-5′-methyl substituted nucleosides (see PCT International Application WO 2008/101157 published on Aug.21, 2008 for other disclosed 5′, 2′-bis substituted nucleosides) and replacement of the ribosyl ring oxygen atom with S and further substitution at the 2′-position (see published U.S. Patent Application US2005- 0130923, published on Jun.16, 2005) or alternatively 5′-substitution of a bicyclic nucleic acid (see PCT International Application WO 2007/134181, published on 11/22/07 wherein a 4′-CH2-0-2′ bicyclic nucleoside is further substituted at the 5′ position with a 5′-methyl or a 5′-vinyl group). The synthesis and preparation of carbocyclic bicyclic nucleosides along with their oligomerization and biochemical studies have also been described (see, e.g., Srivastava et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc.2007, 129(26), 8362-8379).
In certain embodiments, antisense compounds comprise one or more modified cyclohexenyl nucleosides, which is a nucleoside having a six-membered cyclohexenyl in place of the
pentofuranosyl residue in naturally occurring nucleosides. Modified cyclohexenyl nucleosides include, but are not limited to those described in the art (see for example commonly owned, published PCT Application WO 2010/036696, published on Apr.10, 2010, Robeyns et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2008, 130(6), 1979-1984; Horvath et al., Tetrahedron Letters, 2007, 48, 3621-3623; Nauwelaerts et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2007, 129(30), 9340-9348; Gu et al., Nucleosides, Nucleotides & Nucleic
Acids, 2005, 24(5-7), 993-998; Nauwelaerts et al., Nucleic Acids Research, 2005, 33(8), 2452-2463; Robeyns et al., Acta Crystallographica, Section F: Structural Biology and Crystallization
Communications, 2005, F61(6), 585-586; Gu et al., Tetrahedron, 2004, 60(9), 2111-2123; Gu et al., Oligonucleotides, 2003, 13(6), 479-489; Wang et al., J. Org. Chem., 2003, 68, 4499-4505; Verbeure et al., Nucleic Acids Research, 2001, 29(24), 4941-4947; Wang et al., J. Org. Chem., 2001, 66, 8478- 82; Wang et al., Nucleosides, Nucleotides & Nucleic Acids, 2001, 20(4-7), 785-788; Wang et al., J. Am. Chem., 2000, 122, 8595-8602; Published PCT application, WO 06/047842; and Published PCT Application WO 01/049687; the text of each is incorporated by reference herein, in their entirety).
An antisense polynucleotide agent can also include nucleobase modifications or substitutions. As used herein,“unmodified” or“natural” nucleobases include the purine bases adenine (A) and guanine (G), and the pyrimidine bases thymine (T), cytosine (C) and uracil (U). Modified nucleobases include other synthetic and natural nucleobases such as deoxy-thymine (dT), 5-methylcytosine (5-me- C), 5-hydroxymethyl cytosine, xanthine, hypoxanthine, 2-aminoadenine, 6-methyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2-propyl and other alkyl derivatives of adenine and guanine, 2- thiouracil, 2-thiothymine and 2-thiocytosine, 5-halouracil and cytosine, 5-propynyl uracil and cytosine, 6-azo uracil, cytosine and thymine, 5-uracil (pseudouracil), 4-thiouracil, 8-halo, 8-amino, 8- thiol, 8-thioalkyl, 8-hydroxyl anal other 8-substituted adenines and guanines, 5-halo, particularly 5- bromo, 5-trifluoromethyl and other 5-substituted uracils and cytosines, 7-methylguanine and 7- methyladenine, 8-azaguanine and 8-azaadenine, 7-deazaguanine and 7-daazaadenine and 3- deazaguanine and 3-deazaadenine. Further nucleobases include those disclosed in U.S. Patent No.3,687,808, those disclosed in“Modified Nucleosides in Biochemistry,” Biotechnology and Medicine, Herdewijn, P. ed. Wiley-VCH, 2008; those disclosed in The Concise Encyclopedia Of Polymer Science And Engineering, pages 858-859, Kroschwitz, J. L, ed. John Wiley & Sons, 1990, these disclosed by Englisch et al., Angewandte Chemie, International Edition, 1991, 30, 613, and those disclosed by Sanghvi, Y S., Chapter 15, antisense polynucleotide agent Research and
Applications, pages 289-302, Crooke, S. T. and Lebleu, B., Ed., CRC Press, 1993. Certain of these nucleobases are particularly useful for increasing the binding affinity of the agents featured in the invention. These include 5-substituted pyrimidines, 6-azapyrimidines and N-2, N-6 and 0-6 substituted purines, including 2-aminopropyladenine, 5-propynyluracil and 5-propynylcytosine.5- methylcytosine substitutions have been shown to increase nucleic acid duplex stability by 0.6-1.2°C (Sanghvi, Y. S., Crooke, S. T. and Lebleu, B., Eds., antisense polynucleotide agent Research and Applications, CRC Press, Boca Raton, 1993, pp.276-278) and are exemplary base substitutions, even more particularly when combined with 2'-O-methoxyethyl sugar modifications.
Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of certain of the above noted modified nucleobases as well as other modified nucleobases include, but are not limited to, the above noted U.S. Patent Nos.3,687,808, 4,845,205; 5,130,30; 5,134,066; 5,175,273; 5,367,066; 5,432,272;
5,457,187; 5,459,255; 5,484,908; 5,502,177; 5,525,711; 5,552,540; 5,587,469; 5,594,121, 5,596,091; 5,614,617; 5,681,941; 5,750,692; 6,015,886; 6,147,200; 6,166,197; 6,222,025; 6,235,887; 6,380,368;
6,528,640; 6,639,062; 6,617,438; 7,045,610; 7,427,672; and 7,495,088, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
One or more of the nucleotides of an iRNA of the invention may also include a
hydroxymethyl substituted nucleotide. A“hydroxymethyl substituted nucleotide” is an acyclic 2’-3’- seco-nucleotide, also referred to as an“unlocked nucleic acid” (“UNA”) modification.
Representative U.S. publications that teach the preparation of UNA include, but are not limited to, US Patent No.8,314,227; and US Patent Publication Nos.2013/0096289; 2013/0011922; and
2011/0313020, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
Additional modification which may potentially stabilize the ends of antisense polynucleotide agents can include N- (acetylaminocaproyl)-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6-NHAc), N-(caproyl-4- hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6), N-(acetyl-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-NHAc), thymidine-2'-0- deoxythymidine (ether), N-(aminocaproyl)-4-hydroxyprolinol (Hyp-C6-amino), 2-docosanoyl- uridine-3"- phosphate, inverted base dT(idT) and others. Disclosure of this modification can be found in US20120142101.
Any of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be optionally conjugated with a GalNAc derivative ligand, as described below.
As described in more detail below, an agent that contains conjugations of one or more carbohydrate moieties to an antisense polynucleotide agent can optimize one or more properties of the agent. In many cases, the carbohydrate moiety will be attached to a modified subunit of the antisense polynucleotide agent. For example, the ribose sugar of one or more ribonucleotide subunits of an agent can be replaced with another moiety, e.g., a non-carbohydrate (preferably cyclic) carrier to which is attached a carbohydrate ligand. A ribonucleotide subunit in which the ribose sugar of the subunit has been so replaced is referred to herein as a ribose replacement modification subunit (RRMS). A cyclic carrier may be a carbocyclic ring system, i.e., all ring atoms are carbon atoms, or a heterocyclic ring system, i.e., one or more ring atoms may be a heteroatom, e.g., nitrogen, oxygen, sulfur. The cyclic carrier may be a monocyclic ring system, or may contain two or more rings, e.g. fused rings. The cyclic carrier may be a fully saturated ring system, or it may contain one or more double bonds.
The ligand may be attached to the polynucleotide via a carrier. The carriers include (i) at least one“backbone attachment point,” preferably two“backbone attachment points” and (ii) at least one “tethering attachment point.” A“backbone attachment point” as used herein refers to a functional group, e.g. a hydroxyl group, or generally, a bond available for, and that is suitable for incorporation of the carrier into the backbone, e.g., the phosphate, or modified phosphate, e.g., sulfur containing, backbone, of a ribonucleic acid. A“tethering attachment point” (TAP) in some embodiments refers to a constituent ring atom of the cyclic carrier, e.g., a carbon atom or a heteroatom (distinct from an atom which provides a backbone attachment point), that connects a selected moiety. The moiety can be, e.g., a carbohydrate, e.g. monosaccharide, disaccharide, trisaccharide, tetrasaccharide, oligosaccharide and polysaccharide. Optionally, the selected moiety is connected by an intervening tether to the cyclic carrier. Thus, the cyclic carrier will often include a functional group, e.g., an amino group, or
generally, provide a bond, that is suitable for incorporation or tethering of another chemical entity, e.g., a ligand to the constituent ring.
The antisense polynucleotide agents may be conjugated to a ligand via a carrier, wherein the carrier can be cyclic group or acyclic group; preferably, the cyclic group is selected from pyrrolidinyl, pyrazolinyl, pyrazolidinyl, imidazolinyl, imidazolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, [1,3]dioxolane, oxazolidinyl, isoxazolidinyl, morpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, quinoxalinyl, pyridazinonyl, tetrahydrofuryl and and decalin; preferably, the acyclic group is selected from serinol backbone or diethanolamine backbone.
In certain specific embodiments, the antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the methods of the invention is an agent selected from the group of agents listed in Table 3 or 5. These agents may further comprise a ligand, as described below. A. Antisense Polynucleotide Agents Comprising Motifs
In certain embodiments of the invention, at least one of the contiguous nucleotides of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the invention may be a modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified sugars. In other embodiments, the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified nucleobases. In yet other embodiments, the modified nucleotide comprises one or more modified internucleoside linkages. In some embodiments, the modifications (sugar modifications, nucleobase modifications, or linkage modifications) define a pattern or motif. In one embodiment, the patterns of modifications of sugar moieties, internucleoside linkages, and nucleobases are each independent of one another.
Antisense polynucleotide agents having modified oligonucleotides arranged in patterns, or motifs may, for example, confer to the agents properties such as enhanced inhibitory activity, increased binding affinity for a target nucleic acid, or resistance to degradation by in vivo nucleases. For example, such agents may contain at least one region modified so as to confer increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid, or increased inhibitory activity. A second region of such agents may optionally serve as a substrate for the cellular endonuclease RNase H, which cleaves the RNA strand of an RNA:DNA duplex.
An exemplary antisense polynucleotide agent having modified oligonucleotides arranged in patterns, or motifs is a gapmer. In a“gapmer”, an internal region or "gap" having a plurality of linked nucleotides that supports RNaseH cleavage is positioned between two external flanking regions or "wings" having a plurality of linked nucleotides that are chemically distinct from the linked nucleotides of the internal region. The gap segment generally serves as the substrate for endonuclease cleavage, while the wing segments comprise modified nucleotides.
The three regions of a gapmer motif (the 5 '-wing, the gap, and the 3 '-wing) form a contiguous sequence of nucleotides and may be described as“X-Y-Z”, wherein“X” represents the length of the 5-wing,“Y” represents the length of the gap, and“Z” represents the length of the 3’- wing. In one embodiment, a gapmer described as“X-Y-Z” has a configuration such that the gap
segment is positioned immediately adjacent to each of the 5′ wing segment and the 3′ wing segment. Thus, no intervening nucleotides exist between the 5′ wing segment and gap segment, or the gap segment and the 3′ wing segment. Any of the antisense compounds described herein can have a gapmer motif. In some embodiments, X and Z are the same, in other embodiments they are different.
In certain embodiments, the regions of a gapmer are differentiated by the types of modified nucleotides in the region. The types of modified nucleotides that may be used to differentiate the regions of a gapmer, in some embodiments, include β-D-ribonucleotides, β-D-deoxyribonucleotides, 2′-modified nucleotides, e.g., 2′-modified nucleotides (e.g., 2′-MOE, and 2′-O—CH3), and bicyclic sugar modified nucleotides (e.g., those having a 4′-(CH2)n-O-2′ bridge, where n=1 or n=2).
In one embodiment, at least some of the modified nucleotides of each of the wings may differ from at least some of the modified nucleotides of the gap. For example, at least some of the modified nucleotides of each wing that are closest to the gap (the 3 '-most nucleotide of the 5'-wing and the 5'- most nucleotide of the 3 -wing) differ from the modified nucleotides of the neighboring gap nucleotides, thus defining the boundary between the wings and the gap. In certain embodiments, the modified nucleotides within the gap are the same as one another. In certain embodiments, the gap includes one or more modified nucleotides that differ from the modified nucleotides of one or more other nucleotides of the gap.
The length of the 5'- wing (X) of a gapmer may be 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2 to 6, 2 to 5, 3 to 6, 3 to 5, 1 to 5, 1 to 4, 1 to 3, 2 to 4 nucleotides in length, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides in length.
The length of the 3'- wing (Z) of a gapmer may be 1 to 6 nucleotides in length, e.g., 2 to 6, 2- 5, 3 to 6, 3 to 5, 1 to 5, 1 to 4, 1 to 3, 2 to 4 nucleotides in length, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 nucleotides in length.
The length of the gap (Y) of a gapmer may be 5 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 5 to 13, 5 to 12, 5 to 11, 5 to 10, 5 to 9, 5 to 8, 5 to 7, 5 to 6, 6 to 14, 6 to 13, 6 to 12, 6 to 11, 6 to 10, 6 to 9, 6 to 8, 6 to 7, 7 to 14, 7 to 13, 7 to 12, 7 to 11, 7 to 10, 7 to 9, 7 to 8, 8 to 14, 8 to 13, 8 to 12, 8 to 11, 8 to 10, 8 to 9, 9 to 14, 9 to 13, 9 to 12, 9 to 11, 9 to 10, 10 to 14, 10 to 13, 10 to 12, 10 to 11, 11 to 14, 11 to 13, 11 to 12, 12 to 14, 12 to 13, or 13 to 14 nucleotides in length, e.g., 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, or 14 nucleotides in length.
In some embodiments of the invention X consists of 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 nucleotides, Y consists of 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, or 12 nucleotides, and Z consists of 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 nucleotides. Such gapmers include (X-Y-Z) 2-7-2, 2-7-3, 2-7-4, 2-7-5, 2-7-6, 3-7-2, 3-7-3, 3-7-4, 3-7-5, 3-7-6, 4-7-3, 4-7-4, 4-7-5, 4-7-6, 5-7-3, 5-7-4, 5-7-5, 5-7-6, 6-7-3, 6-7-4, 6-7-5, 6-7-6, 3-7-3, 3-7-4, 3-7-5, 3-7-6, 4-7-3, 4-7-4, 4-7-5, 4- 7-6, 5-7-3, 5-7-4, 5-7-5, 5-7-6, 6-7-3, 6-7-4, 6-7-5, 6-7-6, 2-8-2, 2-8-3, 2-8-4, 2-8-5, 2-8-6, 3-8-2, 3-8- 3, 3-8-4, 3-8-5, 3-8-6, 4-8-3, 4-8-4, 4-8-5, 4-8-6, 5-8-3, 5-8-4, 5-8-5, 5-8-6, 6-8-3, 6-8-4, 6-8-5, 6-8-6, 2-9-2, 2-9-3, 2-9-4, 2-9-5, 2-9-6, 3-9-2, 3-9-3, 3-9-4, 3-9-5, 3-9-6, 4-9-3, 4-9-4, 4-9-5, 4-9-6, 5-9-3, 5- 9-4, 5-9-5, 5-9-6, 6-9-3, 6-9-4, 6-9-5, 6-9-6, 2-10-2, 2-10-3, 2-10-4, 2-10-5, 2-10-6, 3-10-2, 3-10-3, 3- 10-4, 3-10-5, 3-10-6, 4-10-3, 4-10-4, 4-10-5, 4-10-6, 5-10-3, 5-10-4, 5-10-5, 5-10-6, 6-10-3, 6-10-4, 6-10-5, 6-10-6, 2-11-2, 2-11-3, 2-11-4, 2-11-5, 2-11-6, 3-11-2, 3-11-3, 3-11-4, 3-11-5, 3-11-6, 4-11-3,
4-11-4, 4-11-5, 4-11-6, 5-11-3, 5-11-4, 5-11-5, 5-11-6, 6-11-3, 6-11-4, 6-11-5, 6-11-6, 2-12-2, 2-12-3, 2-12-4, 2-12-5, 2-12-6, 3-12-2, 3-12-3, 3-12-4, 3-12-5, 3-12-6, 4-12-3, 4-12-4, 4-12-5, 4-12-6, 5-12-3, 5-12-4, 5-12-5, 5-12-6, 6-12-3, 6-12-4, 6-12-5, or 6-12-6.
In some embodiments of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 5-10-5 gapmer motif. In other embodiments of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 4-10-4 gapmer motif. In another embodiment of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 3-10-3 gapmer motif. In yet other embodiments of the invention, antisense polynucleotide agents targeting IGFALS include a 2-10-2 gapmer motif.
The 5'- wing or 3’-wing of a gapmer may independently include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
In some embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least two modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least three modified nucleotides. In yet another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least four modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least five modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'-wing of a gapmer is a modified nucleotide.
In some embodiments, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least two modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least three modified nucleotides. In yet another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least four modified nucleotides. In another embodiment, the 3'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least five modified nucleotides. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a modified nucleotide.
In certain embodiments, the regions of a gapmer are differentiated by the types of sugar moieties of the nucleotides. In one embodiment, the nucleotides of each distinct region comprise uniform sugar moieties. In other embodiments, the nucleotides of each distinct region comprise different sugar moieties. In certain embodiments, the sugar nucleotide modification motifs of the two wings are the same as one another. In certain embodiments, the sugar nucleotide modification motifs of the 5'-wing differs from the sugar nucleotide modification motif of the 3'-wing.
The 5’-wing of a gapmer may include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
In one embodiment, at least one modified nucleotide of the 5'-wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide, such as a constrained ethyl nucleotide, or an LNA. In another embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 bicyclic nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes at least 1, 2, 3, 4, or 5 constrained ethyl nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a constrained ethyl nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 5'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one LNA nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 LNA nucleotides. In other embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is an LNA nucleotide.
In certain embodiments, at least one modified nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a non- bicyclic modified nucleotide, e.g., a 2 '-substituted nucleotide. A“2 '-substituted nucleotide” is a nucleotide comprising a modification at the 2’-position which is other than H or OH, such as a 2’- OMe nucleotide, or a 2’-MOE nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5’-wing of a gapmer comprises 2, 3, 4, or 52 '-substituted nucleotides. In one embodiment, each nucleotide of the 5’-wing of a gapmer is a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’-OMe nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’-OMe nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’-OMe nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’- MOE nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’- MOE nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’- MOE nucleotide.
In certain embodiments, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a 2'-deoxynucleotide. In a certain embodiments, the 5'- wing of a gapmer comprises at least one ribonucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 5'- wing of a gapmer is a ribonucleotide.
The 3’-wing of a gapmer may include 1-6 modified nucleotides, e.g., 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6 modified nucleotides.
In one embodiment, at least one modified nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide, such as a constrained ethyl nucleotide, or an LNA. In another embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 bicyclic nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3’- wing of a gapmer is a bicyclic nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes at least one constrained ethyl nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 constrained ethyl nucleotides. In some embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a constrained ethyl nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one LNA nucleotide. In another embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer includes 2, 3, 4, or 5 LNA nucleotides. In other embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is an LNA nucleotide.
In certain embodiments, at least one modified nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a non- bicyclic modified nucleotide, e.g., a 2 '-substituted nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises 2, 3, 4, or 52 '-substituted nucleotides. In one embodiment, each nucleotide of the 3’-wing of a gapmer is a 2 '-substituted nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’-OMe nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’-OMe nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’-OMe nucleotide.
In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2’- MOE nucleotide. In one embodiment, the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, or 52’- MOE nucleotides. In one embodiment, each of the nucleotides of the 3’-wing of a gapmer comprises a 2’- MOE nucleotide.
In certain embodiments, the 3'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a 2'-deoxynucleotide. In a certain embodiments, the 3'-wing of a gapmer comprises at least one ribonucleotide. In certain embodiments, each nucleotide of the 3'-wing of a gapmer is a ribonucleotide.
The gap of a gapmer may include 5-14 modified nucleotides, e.g., 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, or 14 modified nucleotides.
In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least one 5-methylcytosine. In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, or 135- methylcytosines. In one embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the the gap of a gapmer are 5- methylcytosines.
In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least one 2'-deoxynucleotide. In one embodiment, the gap of a gapmer comprises at least 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, or 132'- deoxynucleotides. In one embodiment, all of the nucleotides of the the gap of a gapmer are 2'- deoxynucleotides.
A gapmer may include one or more modified internucleotide linkages. In some embodiments, a gapmer includes one or more phosphodiester internucleotide linkages. In other embodiments, a gapmer includes one or more phosphorothioate internucleotide linkages.
In one embodiment, each nucleotide of a 5’-wing of a gapmer are linked via a
phosphorothioate internucleotide linkage. In another embodiment, each nucleotide of a 3’-wing of a gapmer are linked via a phosphorothioate internucleotide linkage. In yet another embodiment, each nucleotide of a gap segment of a gapmer is linked via a phosphorothioate internucleotide linkage. In one embodiment, all of the nucleotides in a gapmer are linked via phosphorothioate internucleotide linkages.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising 5 nucleotides.
In another embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides.
In another embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides.
In another embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and
between a 5’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides.
In one embodiment, each nucleotide of a 5-wing flanking a gap segment of 102′- deoxyribonucleotides comprises a modified nucleotide. In another embodiment, each nucleotide of a 3-wing flanking a gap segment of 102′-deoxyribonucleotides comprises a modified nucleotide. In one embodiment, each of the modified 5’-wing nucleotides and each of the modified 3’-wing nucleotides comprise a 2′-sugar modification. In one embodiment, the 2′-sugar modification is a 2’- OMe modification. In another embodiment, the 2′-sugar modification is a 2’-MOE modification. In one embodiment, each of the modified 5’-wing nucleotides and each of the modified 3’-wing nucleotides comprise a bicyclic nucleotide. In one embodiment, the bicyclic nucleotide is a constrained ethyl nucleotide. In another embodiment, the bicyclic nucleotide is an LNA nucleotide. In one embodiment, each cytosine in an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In one embodiment, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine. In some embodiments, the agent further comprises a ligand.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising five nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In one embodiment, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine. In some embodiments, the agent further comprises a ligand.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising five constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising five LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising five LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage
of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising four nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising four LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising four LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising three nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising three LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising three LNA
nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’OMe modification, wherein each internucleotde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification and a 3’-wing segment comprising two nucleotides comprising a 2’MOE modification, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5- methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two constrained ethyl nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two constrained ethyl nucleotides, wherein each internucleoitde linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene comprises a gap segment of ten 2′-deoxyribonucleotides positioned immediately adjacent to and between a 5’- wing segment comprising two LNA nucleotides and a 3’-wing segment comprising two LNA nucleotides, wherein each internucleotide linkage of the agent is a phosphorothioate linkage. In some embodiments, each cytosine of the agent is a 5-methylcytosine.
Further gapmer designs suitable for use in the agents, compositions, and methods of the invention are disclosed in, for example, U.S. Patent Nos.7,687,617 and 8,580,756; U.S. Patent Publication Nos.20060128646, 20090209748, 20140128586, 20140128591, 20100210712, and 20080015162A1; and International Publication No. WO 2013/159108, the entire content of each of which are incorporated herein by reference. IV. Polynucleotide Agents Conjugated to Ligands
Another modification of the polynucleotide agents of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, involves chemically linking to the agent one or more ligands, moieties, or conjugates that enhance the activity, cellular distribution, or cellular uptake of the antisense polynucleotide agent. Such moieties include but are not limited to lipid moieties such as a cholesterol moiety (Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acid. Sci. USA, 1989, 86: 6553-6556), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Biorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1994, 4:1053-1060), a thioether, e.g., beryl-S-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306-309; Manoharan et al., Biorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765-2770), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1992, 20:533-538), an aliphatic
chain, e.g., dodecandiol or undecyl residues (Saison-Behmoaras et al., EMBO J, 1991, 10:1111-1118; Kabanov et al., FEBS Lett., 1990, 259:327-330; Svinarchuk et al., Biochimie, 1993, 75:49-54), a phospholipid, e.g., di-hexadecyl-rac-glycerol or triethyl-ammonium 1,2-di-O-hexadecyl-rac-glycero- 3-phosphonate (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651-3654; Shea et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1990, 18:3777-3783), a polyamine or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al.,
Nucleosides & Nucleotides, 1995, 14:969-973), or adamantane acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651-3654), a palmityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264:229-237), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-carbonyloxycholesterol moiety (Crooke et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 1996, 277:923-937).
In one embodiment, a ligand alters the distribution, targeting, or lifetime of an antisense polynucleotide agent into which it is incorporated. In preferred embodiments a ligand provides an enhanced affinity for a selected target, e.g., molecule, cell, or cell type; compartment, e.g., a cellular or organ compartment, tissue, organ, or region of the body, as, e.g., compared to a species absent such a ligand. Preferred ligands will not take part in hybridization of an antisense polynucleotide agent to the targeted mRNA.
Ligands can include a naturally occurring substance, such as a protein (e.g., human serum albumin (HSA), low-density lipoprotein (LDL), or globulin); carbohydrate (e.g., a dextran, pullulan, chitin, chitosan, inulin, cyclodextrin, N-acetylgalactosamine, or hyaluronic acid); or a lipid. The ligand can also be a recombinant or synthetic molecule, such as a synthetic polymer, e.g., a synthetic polyamino acid. Examples of polyamino acids include polyamino acid is a polylysine (PLL), poly L-aspartic acid, poly L-glutamic acid, styrene-maleic acid anhydride copolymer, poly(L-lactide- co-glycolied) copolymer, divinyl ether-maleic anhydride copolymer, N-(2- hydroxypropyl)methacrylamide copolymer (HMPA), polyethylene glycol (PEG), polyvinyl alcohol (PVA), polyurethane, poly(2-ethylacryllic acid), N-isopropylacrylamide polymers, or
polyphosphazine. Example of polyamines include: polyethylenimine, polylysine (PLL), spermine, spermidine, polyamine, pseudopeptide-polyamine, peptidomimetic polyamine, dendrimer polyamine, arginine, amidine, protamine, cationic lipid, cationic porphyrin, quaternary salt of a polyamine, or an alpha helical peptide.
Ligands can also include targeting groups, e.g., a cell or tissue targeting agent, e.g., a lectin, glycoprotein, lipid, or protein, e.g., an antibody, that binds to a specified cell type such as a kidney cell. A targeting group can be a thyrotropin, melanotropin, lectin, glycoprotein, surfactant protein A, Mucin carbohydrate, multivalent lactose, multivalent galactose, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl- gulucoseamine multivalent mannose, multivalent fucose, glycosylated polyaminoacids, multivalent galactose, transferrin, bisphosphonate, polyglutamate, polyaspartate, a lipid, cholesterol, a steroid, bile acid, folate, vitamin B12, vitamin A, biotin, or an RGD peptide or RGD peptide mimetic.
Other examples of ligands include dyes, intercalating agents (e.g. acridines), cross-linkers (e.g. psoralene, mitomycin C), porphyrins (TPPC4, texaphyrin, Sapphyrin), polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., phenazine, dihydrophenazine), artificial endonucleases (e.g. EDTA), lipophilic molecules, e.g., cholesterol, cholic acid, adamantane acetic acid, 1-pyrene butyric acid,
dihydrotestosterone, 1,3-Bis-O(hexadecyl)glycerol, geranyloxyhexyl group, hexadecylglycerol, borneol, menthol, 1,3-propanediol, heptadecyl group, palmitic acid, myristic acid,O3- (oleoyl)lithocholic acid, O3-(oleoyl)cholenic acid, dimethoxytrityl, or phenoxazine)and peptide conjugates (e.g., antennapedia peptide, Tat peptide), alkylating agents, phosphate, amino, mercapto, PEG (e.g., PEG-40K), MPEG, [MPEG]2, polyamino, alkyl, substituted alkyl, radiolabeled markers, enzymes, haptens (e.g. biotin), transport/absorption facilitators (e.g., aspirin, vitamin E, folic acid), synthetic ribonucleases (e.g., imidazole, bisimidazole, histamine, imidazole clusters, acridine- imidazole conjugates, Eu3+ complexes of tetraazamacrocycles), dinitrophenyl, HRP, or AP.
Ligands can be proteins, e.g., glycoproteins, or peptides, e.g., molecules having a specific affinity for a co-ligand, or antibodies e.g., an antibody, that binds to a specified cell type such as a hepatic cell. Ligands can also include hormones and hormone receptors. They can also include non- peptidic species, such as lipids, lectins, carbohydrates, vitamins, cofactors, multivalent lactose, multivalent galactose, N-acetyl-galactosamine, N-acetyl-gulucosamine multivalent mannose, or multivalent fucose. The ligand can be, for example, a lipopolysaccharide, an activator of p38 MAP kinase, or an activator of NF-κB.
The ligand can be a substance, e.g., a drug, which can increase the uptake of the antisense polynucleotide agent into the cell, for example, by disrupting the cell’s cytoskeleton, e.g., by disrupting the cell’s microtubules, microfilaments, or intermediate filaments. The drug can be, for example, taxon, vincristine, vinblastine, cytochalasin, nocodazole, japlakinolide, latrunculin A, phalloidin, swinholide A, indanocine, or myoservin.
In some embodiments, a ligand attached to an antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein acts as a pharmacokinetic modulator (PK modulator). PK modulators include lipophiles, bile acids, steroids, phospholipid analogues, peptides, protein binding agents, PEG, vitamins etc.
Exemplary PK modulators include, but are not limited to, cholesterol, fatty acids, cholic acid, lithocholic acid, dialkylglycerides, diacylglyceride, phospholipids, sphingolipids, naproxen, ibuprofen, vitamin E, biotin etc. Oligonucleotides that comprise a number of phosphorothioate linkages are also known to bind to serum protein, thus short oligonucleotides, e.g., oligonucleotides of 5 bases, 10 bases, 15 bases or 20 bases, comprising multiple of phosphorothioate linkages in the backbone are also amenable to the present invention as ligands (e.g. as PK modulating ligands). In addition, aptamers that bind serum components (e.g. serum proteins) are also suitable for use as PK modulating ligands in the embodiments described herein.
Ligand-conjugated polynucleotides of the invention may be synthesized by the use of a polynucleotide that bears a pendant reactive functionality, such as that derived from the attachment of a linking molecule onto the oligonucleotide (described below). This reactive polynucleotide may be reacted directly with commercially-available ligands, ligands that are synthesized bearing any of a variety of protecting groups, or ligands that have a linking moiety attached thereto.
The polynucleotides used in the conjugates of the present invention may be conveniently and routinely made through the well-known technique of solid-phase synthesis. Equipment for such synthesis is sold by several vendors including, for example, Applied Biosystems (Foster City, Calif.).
Any other means for such synthesis known in the art may additionally or alternatively be employed. It is also known to use similar techniques to prepare other polynucleotides, such as the
phosphorothioates and alkylated derivatives.
In the ligand-conjugated polynucleotides and ligand-molecule bearing sequence-specific linked nucleosides of the present invention, the polynucleotides and polynucleosides may be assembled on a suitable DNA synthesizer utilizing standard nucleotide or nucleoside precursors, or nucleotide or nucleoside conjugate precursors that already bear the linking moiety, ligand-nucleotide or nucleoside-conjugate precursors that already bear the ligand molecule, or non-nucleoside ligand- bearing building blocks.
When using nucleotide-conjugate precursors that already bear a linking moiety, the synthesis of the sequence-specific linked nucleosides is typically completed, and the ligand molecule is then reacted with the linking moiety to form the ligand-conjugated oligonucleotide. In some embodiments, the polynucleotides or linked nucleosides of the present invention are synthesized by an automated synthesizer using phosphoramidites derived from ligand-nucleoside conjugates in addition to the standard phosphoramidites and non-standard phosphoramidites that are commercially available and routinely used in oligonucleotide synthesis.
A. Lipid Conjugates
In one embodiment, the ligand or conjugate is a lipid or lipid-based molecule. Such a lipid or lipid-based molecule preferably binds a serum protein, e.g., human serum albumin (HSA). An HSA binding ligand allows for distribution of the conjugate to a target tissue, e.g., a non-kidney target tissue of the body. For example, the target tissue can be the liver, including parenchymal cells of the liver. Other molecules that can bind HSA can also be used as ligands. For example, naproxen or aspirin can be used. A lipid or lipid-based ligand can (a) increase resistance to degradation of the conjugate, (b) increase targeting or transport into a target cell or cell membrane, or (c) can be used to adjust binding to a serum protein, e.g., HSA.
A lipid based ligand can be used to inhibit, e.g., control the binding of the conjugate to a target tissue. For example, a lipid or lipid-based ligand that binds to HSA more strongly will be less likely to be targeted to the kidney and therefore less likely to be cleared from the body. A lipid or lipid-based ligand that binds to HSA less strongly can be used to target the conjugate to the kidney.
In a preferred embodiment, the lipid based ligand binds HSA. Preferably, it binds HSA with a sufficient affinity such that the conjugate will be preferably distributed to a non-kidney tissue. However, it is preferred that the affinity not be so strong that the HSA-ligand binding cannot be reversed.
In another preferred embodiment, the lipid based ligand binds HSA weakly or not at all, such that the conjugate will be preferably distributed to the kidney. Other moieties that target to kidney cells can also be used in place of or in addition to the lipid based ligand.
In another aspect, the ligand is a moiety, e.g., a vitamin, which is taken up by a target cell, e.g., a proliferating cell. These are particularly useful for treating disorders characterized by unwanted cell proliferation, e.g., of the malignant or non-malignant type, e.g., cancer cells.
Exemplary vitamins include vitamin A, E, and K. Other exemplary vitamins include are B vitamin, e.g., folic acid, B12, riboflavin, biotin, pyridoxal or other vitamins or nutrients taken up by target cells such as liver cells. Also included are HSA and low density lipoprotein (LDL).
B. Cell Permeation Agents
In another aspect, the ligand is a cell-permeation agent, preferably a helical cell-permeation agent. Preferably, the agent is amphipathic. An exemplary agent is a peptide such as tat or antennopedia. If the agent is a peptide, it can be modified, including a peptidylmimetic, invertomers, non-peptide or pseudo-peptide linkages, and use of D-amino acids. The helical agent is preferably an alpha-helical agent, which preferably has a lipophilic and a lipophobic phase.
The ligand can be a peptide or peptidomimetic. A peptidomimetic (also referred to herein as an oligopeptidomimetic) is a molecule capable of folding into a defined three-dimensional structure similar to a natural peptide. The attachment of peptide and peptidomimetics to antisense
polynucleotide agents can affect pharmacokinetic distribution of the agent, such as by enhancing cellular recognition and absorption. The peptide or peptidomimetic moiety can be 5-50 amino acids long, e.g., 5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30, 35, 40, 45, or 50 amino acids long.
A peptide or peptidomimetic can be, for example, a cell permeation peptide, cationic peptide, amphipathic peptide, or hydrophobic peptide (e.g., consisting primarily of Tyr, Trp or Phe). The peptide moiety can be a dendrimer peptide, constrained peptide or crosslinked peptide. In another alternative, the peptide moiety can include a hydrophobic membrane translocation sequence (MTS). An exemplary hydrophobic MTS-containing peptide is RFGF having the amino acid sequence AAVALLPAVLLALLAP (SEQ ID NO: 7). An RFGF analogue (e.g., amino acid sequence
AALLPVLLAAP (SEQ ID NO:8) containing a hydrophobic MTS can also be a targeting moiety. The peptide moiety can be a“delivery” peptide, which can carry large polar molecules including peptides, oligonucleotides, and protein across cell membranes. For example, sequences from the HIV Tat protein (GRKKRRQRRRPPQ (SEQ ID NO: 9) and the Drosophila Antennapedia protein (RQIKIWFQNRRMKWKK (SEQ ID NO:10) have been found to be capable of functioning as delivery peptides. A peptide or peptidomimetic can be encoded by a random sequence of DNA, such as a peptide identified from a phage-display library, or one-bead-one-compound (OBOC) combinatorial library (Lam et al., Nature, 354:82-84, 1991). Examples of a peptide or
peptidomimetic tethered to an antisens epolynucleotide agent via an incorporated monomer unit for cell targeting purposes is an arginine-glycine-aspartic acid (RGD)-peptide, or RGD mimic. A peptide moiety can range in length from 5 amino acids to 40 amino acids. The peptide moieties can have a structural modification, such as to increase stability or direct conformational properties. Any of the structural modifications described below can be utilized.
An RGD peptide for use in the compositions and methods of the invention may be linear or cyclic, and may be modified, e.g., glycosylated or methylated, to facilitate targeting to a specific tissue(s). RGD-containing peptides and peptidiomimemtics may include D-amino acids, as well as synthetic RGD mimics. In addition to RGD, one can use other moieties that target the integrin ligand. Preferred conjugates of this ligand target PECAM-1 or VEGF.
A“cell permeation peptide” is capable of permeating a cell, e.g., a microbial cell, such as a bacterial or fungal cell, or a mammalian cell, such as a human cell. A microbial cell-permeating peptide can be, for example, an α-helical linear peptide (e.g., LL-37 or Ceropin P1), a disulfide bond- containing peptide (e.g., α -defensin, β-defensin or bactenecin), or a peptide containing only one or two dominating amino acids (e.g., PR-39 or indolicidin). A cell permeation peptide can also include a nuclear localization signal (NLS). For example, a cell permeation peptide can be a bipartite amphipathic peptide, such as MPG, which is derived from the fusion peptide domain of HIV-1 gp41 and the NLS of SV40 large T antigen (Simeoni et al., Nucl. Acids Res.31:2717-2724, 2003).
C. Carbohydrate Conjugates
In some embodiments of the compositions and methods of the invention, an antisense polynucleotide agent further comprises a carbohydrate. The carbohydrate conjugated agents are advantageous for the in vivo delivery of nucleic acids, as well as compositions suitable for in vivo therapeutic use, as described herein (see, e.g., Prakash, et al. (2014) Nuc Acid Res doi
10.1093/nar/gku531). As used herein,“carbohydrate” refers to a compound which is either a carbohydrate per se made up of one or more monosaccharide units having at least 6 carbon atoms (which can be linear, branched or cyclic) with an oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur atom bonded to each carbon atom; or a compound having as a part thereof a carbohydrate moiety made up of one or more monosaccharide units each having at least six carbon atoms (which can be linear, branched or cyclic), with an oxygen, nitrogen or sulfur atom bonded to each carbon atom. Representative carbohydrates include the sugars (mono-, di-, tri- and oligosaccharides containing from 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 monosaccharide units), and polysaccharides such as starches, glycogen, cellulose and polysaccharide gums. Specific monosaccharides include C5 and above (e.g., C5, C6, C7, or C8) sugars; di- and trisaccharides include sugars having two or three monosaccharide units (e.g., C5, C6, C7, or C8).
In one embodiment, a carbohydrate conjugate for use in the compositions and methods of the invention is a monosaccharide. In one embodiment, the monosaccharide is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) or a GalNAc derivative.
In one embodiment, a carbohydrate conjugate for use in the compositions and methods of the invention is selected from the rou consisting of:
Another representative carbohydrate conjugate for use in the embodiments described herein includes, but is not limited to,
(Formula XXIII),
when one of X or Y is an oligonucleotide, the other is a hydrogen.
In certain embodiments of the invention, the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a monovalent linker. In some embodiments, the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a bivalent linker. In yet other embodiments of the invention, the GalNAc or GalNAc derivative is attached to an agent of the invention via a trivalent linker.
In one embodiment, the agents of the invention comprise one GalNAc or GalNAc derivative attached to the agent. In another embodiment, the agents of the invention comprise a plurality (e.g., 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6) GalNAc or GalNAc derivatives, each independently attached to a plurality of nucleotides of the RNAi agent through a plurality of monovalent linkers.
In some embodiments, the carbohydrate conjugate further comprises one or more additional ligands as described above, such as, but not limited to, a PK modulator or a cell permeation peptide.
D. Linkers
In some embodiments, the conjugate or ligand described herein can be attached to an antisense polynucleotide agent with various linkers that can be cleavable or non-cleavable.
The term "linker" or“linking group” means an organic moiety that connects two parts of a compound, e.g., covalently attaches two parts of a compound. Linkers typically comprise a direct bond or an atom such as oxygen or sulfur, a unit such as NR8, C(O), C(O)NH, SO, SO2, SO2NH or a chain of atoms, such as, but not limited to, substituted or unsubstituted alkyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkenyl, substituted or unsubstituted alkynyl, arylalkyl, arylalkenyl, arylalkynyl, heteroarylalkyl, heteroarylalkenyl, heteroarylalkynyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heterocyclylalkenyl, heterocyclylalkynyl, aryl, heteroaryl, heterocyclyl, cycloalkyl, cycloalkenyl, alkylarylalkyl, alkylarylalkenyl, alkylarylalkynyl, alkenylarylalkyl, alkenylarylalkenyl, alkenylarylalkynyl, alkynylarylalkyl, alkynylarylalkenyl, alkynylarylalkynyl, alkylheteroarylalkyl, alkylheteroarylalkenyl, alkylheteroarylalkynyl, alkenylheteroarylalkyl, alkenylheteroarylalkenyl, alkenylheteroarylalkynyl, alkynylheteroarylalkyl, alkynylheteroarylalkenyl, alkynylheteroarylalkynyl, alkylheterocyclylalkyl, alkylheterocyclylalkenyl, alkylhererocyclylalkynyl, alkenylheterocyclylalkyl,
alkenylheterocyclylalkenyl, alkenylheterocyclylalkynyl, alkynylheterocyclylalkyl,
alkynylheterocyclylalkenyl, alkynylheterocyclylalkynyl, alkylaryl, alkenylaryl, alkynylaryl, alkylheteroaryl, alkenylheteroaryl, alkynylhereroaryl, which one or more methylenes can be interrupted or terminated by O, S, S(O), SO2, N(R8), C(O), substituted or unsubstituted aryl, substituted or unsubstituted heteroaryl, substituted or unsubstituted heterocyclic; where R8 is hydrogen, acyl, aliphatic or substituted aliphatic. In one embodiment, the linker is between 1-24 atoms or any subrange within that range, e.g., 2-24, 3-24, 4-24, 5-24, 6-24, 6-18, 7-18, 8-18, 7-17, 8- 17, 6-16, 7-16, or 8-16 atoms.
A cleavable linking group is one which is sufficiently stable outside the cell, but which upon entry into a target cell is cleaved to release the two parts the linker is holding together. In a preferred embodiment, the cleavable linking group is cleaved at least 10 times, 20, times, 30 times, 40 times, 50 times, 60 times, 70 times, 80 times, 90 times or more, or at least 100 times faster in a target cell or under a first reference condition (which can, e.g., be selected to mimic or represent intracellular conditions) than in the blood of a subject, or under a second reference condition (which can, e.g., be selected to mimic or represent conditions found in the blood or serum).
Cleavable linking groups are susceptible to cleavage agents, e.g., pH, redox potential or the presence of degradative molecules. Generally, cleavage agents are more prevalent or found at higher levels or activities inside cells than in serum or blood. Examples of such degradative agents include: redox agents which are selected for particular substrates or which have no substrate specificity, including, e.g., oxidative or reductive enzymes or reductive agents such as mercaptans, present in cells, that can degrade a redox cleavable linking group by reduction; esterases; endosomes or agents that can create an acidic environment, e.g., those that result in a pH of five or lower; enzymes that can hydrolyze or degrade an acid cleavable linking group by acting as a general acid, peptidases (which can be substrate specific), and phosphatases.
A cleavable linkage group, such as a disulfide bond can be susceptible to pH. The pH of human serum is 7.4, while the average intracellular pH is slightly lower, ranging from about 7.1-7.3. Endosomes have a more acidic pH, in the range of 5.5-6.0, and lysosomes have an even more acidic
pH at around 5.0. Some linkers will have a cleavable linking group that is cleaved at a preferred pH, thereby releasing a cationic lipid from the ligand inside the cell, or into the desired compartment of the cell.
A linker can include a cleavable linking group that is cleavable by a particular enzyme. The type of cleavable linking group incorporated into a linker can depend on the cell to be targeted. For example, a liver-targeting ligand can be linked to a cationic lipid through a linker that includes an ester group. Liver cells are rich in esterases, and therefore the linker will be cleaved more efficiently in liver cells than in cell types that are not esterase-rich. Other cell-types rich in esterases include cells of the lung, renal cortex, and testis.
Linkers that contain peptide bonds can be used when targeting cell types rich in peptidases, such as liver cells and synoviocytes.
In general, the suitability of a candidate cleavable linking group can be evaluated by testing the ability of a degradative agent (or condition) to cleave the candidate linking group. It will also be desirable to also test the candidate cleavable linking group for the ability to resist cleavage in the blood or when in contact with other non-target tissue. Thus, one can determine the relative susceptibility to cleavage between a first and a second condition, where the first is selected to be indicative of cleavage in a target cell and the second is selected to be indicative of cleavage in other tissues or biological fluids, e.g., blood or serum. The evaluations can be carried out in cell free systems, in cells, in cell culture, in organ or tissue culture, or in whole animals. It can be useful to make initial evaluations in cell-free or culture conditions and to confirm by further evaluations in whole animals. In preferred embodiments, useful candidate compounds are cleaved at least 2, 4, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 times faster in the cell (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic intracellular conditions) as compared to blood or serum (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic extracellular conditions).
i. Redox cleavable linking groups
In one embodiment, a cleavable linking group is a redox cleavable linking group that is cleaved upon reduction or oxidation. An example of reductively cleavable linking group is a disulphide linking group (-S-S-). To determine if a candidate cleavable linking group is a suitable “reductively cleavable linking group,” or for example is suitable for use with a particular antisense polynucleotide agent moiety and particular targeting agent one can look to methods described herein. For example, a candidate can be evaluated by incubation with dithiothreitol (DTT), or other reducing agent using reagents know in the art, which mimic the rate of cleavage which would be observed in a cell, e.g., a target cell. The candidates can also be evaluated under conditions which are selected to mimic blood or serum conditions. In one, candidate compounds are cleaved by at most 10% in the blood. In other embodiments, useful candidate compounds are degraded at least 2, 4, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, or 100 times faster in the cell (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic intracellular conditions) as compared to blood (or under in vitro conditions selected to mimic extracellular conditions). The rate of cleavage of candidate compounds can be determined using
standard enzyme kinetics assays under conditions chosen to mimic intracellular media and compared to conditions chosen to mimic extracellular media.
ii. Phosphate-based cleavable linking groups
In another embodiment, a cleavable linker comprises a phosphate-based cleavable linking group. A phosphate-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by agents that degrade or hydrolyze the phosphate group. An example of an agent that cleaves phosphate groups in cells are enzymes such as phosphatases in cells. Examples of phosphate-based linking groups are -O-P(O)(ORk)-O-, -O- P(S)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(S)(SRk)-O-, -S-P(O)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(O)(ORk)-S-, -S-P(O)(ORk)-S-, -O- P(S)(ORk)-S-, -S-P(S)(ORk)-O-, -O-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -O-P(S)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(S)(Rk)-O-, -S-P(O)(Rk)-S-, -O-P(S)( Rk)-S-. Preferred embodiments are -O-P(O)(OH)-O-, -O-P(S)(OH)-O-, -O- P(S)(SH)-O-, -S-P(O)(OH)-O-, -O-P(O)(OH)-S-, -S-P(O)(OH)-S-, -O-P(S)(OH)-S-, -S-P(S)(OH)-O-, -O-P(O)(H)-O-, -O-P(S)(H)-O-, -S-P(O)(H)-O, -S-P(S)(H)-O-, -S-P(O)(H)-S-, -O-P(S)(H)-S-. A preferred embodiment is -O-P(O)(OH)-O-. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above.
iii. Acid cleavable linking groups
In another embodiment, a cleavable linker comprises an acid cleavable linking group. An acid cleavable linking group is a linking group that is cleaved under acidic conditions. In preferred embodiments acid cleavable linking groups are cleaved in an acidic environment with a pH of 6.5 or lower (e.g., 6.0, 5.75, 5.5, 5.25, 5.0, or lower), or by agents such as enzymes that can act as a general acid. In a cell, specific low pH organelles, such as endosomes and lysosomes can provide a cleaving environment for acid cleavable linking groups. Examples of acid cleavable linking groups include but are not limited to hydrazones, esters, and esters of amino acids. Acid cleavable groups can have the general formula -C=NN-, C(O)O, or -OC(O). A preferred embodiment is when the carbon attached to the oxygen of the ester (the alkoxy group) is an aryl group, substituted alkyl group, or tertiary alkyl group such as dimethyl pentyl or t-butyl. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above.
iv. Ester-based linking groups
In another embodiment, a cleavable linker comprises an ester-based cleavable linking group. An ester-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by enzymes such as esterases and amidases in cells. Examples of ester-based cleavable linking groups include but are not limited to esters of alkylene, alkenylene and alkynylene groups. Ester cleavable linking groups have the general formula -C(O)O-, or -OC(O)-. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above. v. Peptide-based cleaving groups
In yet another embodiment, a cleavable linker comprises a peptide-based cleavable linking group. A peptide-based cleavable linking group is cleaved by enzymes such as peptidases and proteases in cells. Peptide-based cleavable linking groups are peptide bonds formed between amino acids to yield oligopeptides (e.g., dipeptides, tripeptides etc.) and polypeptides. Peptide-based cleavable groups do not include the amide group (-C(O)NH-). The amide group can be formed between any alkylene, alkenylene or alkynelene. A peptide bond is a special type of amide bond
formed between amino acids to yield peptides and proteins. The peptide based cleavage group is generally limited to the peptide bond (i.e., the amide bond) formed between amino acids yielding peptides and proteins and does not include the entire amide functional group. Peptide-based cleavable linking groups have the general formula– NHCHRAC(O)NHCHRBC(O)-, where RA and RB are the R groups of the two adjacent amino acids. These candidates can be evaluated using methods analogous to those described above.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention is conjugated to a carbohydrate through a linker. Non-limiting examples of antisense polynucleotide agent carbohydrate conjugates with linkers of the compositions and methods of the invention include, but are not limited
(Formula XXX), when one of X or Y is an oligonucleotide, the other is a hydrogen.
In certain embodiments of the compositions and methods of the invention, a ligand is one or more“GalNAc” (N-acetylgalactosamine) derivatives attached through a bivalent or trivalent branched linker.
In one embodiment, a antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention is conjugated to a bivalent or trivalent branched linker selected from the group of structures shown in any of formula (XXXII)– (XXXV):
wherein:
q2A, q2B, q3A, q3B, q4A, q4B, q5A, q5B and q5C represent independently for each occurrence 0-20 and wherein the repeating unit can be the same or different;
P2A, P2B, P3A, P3B, P4A, P4B, P5A, P5B, P5C, T2A, T2B, T3A, T3B, T4A, T4B, T4A, T5B, T5C are each independently for each occurrence absent, CO, NH, O, S, OC(O), NHC(O), CH2, CH2NH or CH2O; Q2A, Q2B, Q3A, Q3B, Q4A, Q4B, Q5A, Q5B, Q5C are independently for each occurrence absent, alkylene, substituted alkylene wherin one or more methylenes can be interrupted or terminated by one or more of O, S, S(O), SO2, N(RN), C(R’)=C(R’’), C≡C or C(O);
R2A, R2B, R3A, R3B, R4A, R4B, R5A, R5B, R5C are each independently for each occurrence absent, NH, O,
L2A, L2B, L3A, L3B, L4A, L4B, L5A, L5B and L5C represent the ligand; i.e. each independently for each occurrence a monosaccharide (such as GalNAc), disaccharide, trisaccharide, tetrasaccharide, oligosaccharide, or polysaccharide; andRa is H or amino acid side chain.Trivalent conjugating GalNAc derivatives are particularly useful for use with antisense polynucleotide agents for inhibiting the expression of a target gene, such as those of formula (XXXVI):
,
wherein L5A, L5B and L5C represent a monosaccharide, such as GalNAc derivative. Examples of suitable bivalent and trivalent branched linker groups conjugating GalNAc derivatives include, but are not limited to, the structures recited above as formulas II, VII, XI, X, and XIII.
Representative U.S. patents that teach the preparation of RNA conjugates include, but are not limited to, U.S. Pat. Nos.4,828,979; 4,948,882; 5,218,105; 5,525,465; 5,541,313; 5,545,730;
5,552,538; 5,578,717, 5,580,731; 5,591,584; 5,109,124; 5,118,802; 5,138,045; 5,414,077; 5,486,603; 5,512,439; 5,578,718; 5,608,046; 4,587,044; 4,605,735; 4,667,025; 4,762,779; 4,789,737; 4,824,941; 4,835,263; 4,876,335; 4,904,582; 4,958,013; 5,082,830; 5,112,963; 5,214,136; 5,082,830; 5,112,963; 5,214,136; 5,245,022; 5,254,469; 5,258,506; 5,262,536; 5,272,250; 5,292,873; 5,317,098; 5,371,241, 5,391,723; 5,416,203, 5,451,463; 5,510,475; 5,512,667; 5,514,785; 5,565,552; 5,567,810; 5,574,142; 5,585,481; 5,587,371; 5,595,726; 5,597,696; 5,599,923; 5,599,928 and 5,688,941; 6,294,664;
6,320,017; 6,576,752; 6,783,931; 6,900,297; 7,037,646; 8,106,022, the entire contents of each of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference.
It is not necessary for all positions in a given compound to be uniformly modified, and in fact more than one of the aforementioned modifications can be incorporated in a single compound or even at a single nucleoside within an antisense polynucleotide agent. The present invention also includes antisense polynucleotide agents that are chimeric compounds.
“Chimeric” antisense polynucleotide agents or“chimeras,” in the context of this invention, are antisense polynucleotide agent compounds, which contain two or more chemically distinct regions, each made up of at least one monomer unit, i.e., a nucleotide in the case of an antisense polynucleotide agent. These antisense polynucleotide agents typically contain at least one region wherein the RNA is modified so as to confer upon the antisense polynucleotide agent increased resistance to nuclease degradation, increased cellular uptake, or increased binding affinity for the target nucleic acid. An additional region of the antisense polynucleotide agent can serve as a substrate for enzymes capable of cleaving RNA:DNA or RNA:RNA hybrids. By way of example, RNase H is a cellular endonuclease which cleaves the RNA strand of an RNA:DNA duplex. Activation of RNase H, therefore, results in cleavage of the RNA target, thereby greatly enhancing the efficiency of antisense polynucleotide agent inhibition of gene expression. Consequently, comparable results can often be obtained with shorter antisense polynucleotide agents when chimeric antisense
polynucleotide agents are used, compared to phosphorothioate deoxy antisense polynucleotide agents
hybridizing to the same target region. Cleavage of the RNA target can be routinely detected by gel electrophoresis and, if necessary, associated nucleic acid hybridization techniques known in the art.
In certain instances, the nucleotide of an antisense polynucleotide agent can be modified by a non-ligand group. A number of non-ligand molecules have been conjugated to antisense
polynucleotide agents in order to enhance the activity, cellular distribution or cellular uptake of the antisense polynucleotide agent, and procedures for performing such conjugations are available in the scientific literature. Such non-ligand moieties have included lipid moieties, such as cholesterol (Kubo, T. et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm., 2007, 365(1):54-61; Letsinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 1989, 86:6553), cholic acid (Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 1994, 4:1053), a thioether, e.g., hexyl-S-tritylthiol (Manoharan et al., Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1992, 660:306; Manoharan et al., Bioorg. Med. Chem. Let., 1993, 3:2765), a thiocholesterol (Oberhauser et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1992, 20:533), an aliphatic chain, e.g., dodecandiol or undecyl residues (Saison-Behmoaras et al., EMBO J., 1991, 10:111; Kabanov et al., FEBS Lett., 1990, 259:327; Svinarchuk et al., Biochimie, 1993, 75:49), a phospholipid, e.g., di-hexadecyl-rac-glycerol or triethylammonium 1,2-di-O- hexadecyl-rac-glycero-3-H-phosphonate (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651; Shea et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 1990, 18:3777), a polyamine or a polyethylene glycol chain (Manoharan et al., Nucleosides & Nucleotides, 1995, 14:969), or adamantane acetic acid (Manoharan et al., Tetrahedron Lett., 1995, 36:3651), a palmityl moiety (Mishra et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 1995, 1264:229), or an octadecylamine or hexylamino-carbonyl-oxycholesterol moiety (Crooke et al., J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 1996, 277:923). Representative United States patents that teach the preparation of such RNA conjugates have been listed above. Typical conjugation protocols involve the synthesis of an RNAs bearing an aminolinker at one or more positions of the sequence. The amino group is then reacted with the molecule being conjugated using appropriate coupling or activating reagents. The conjugation reaction can be performed either with the RNA still bound to the solid support or following cleavage of the RNA, in solution phase. Purification of the RNA conjugate by HPLC typically affords the pure conjugate. V. Delivery of a Polynucleotide Agent of the Invention
The delivery of a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents, to a cell e.g., a cell within a subject, such as a human subject (e.g., a subject in need thereof, such as a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease) can be achieved in a number of different ways. For example, delivery may be performed by contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention either in vitro or in vivo. In vivo delivery may also be performed directly by administering a composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent to a subject.
In general, any method of delivering a nucleic acid molecule (in vitro or in vivo) can be adapted for use with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention (see e.g., Akhtar S. and Julian RL. (1992) Trends Cell. Biol.2(5):139-144 and WO94/02595, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties). For in vivo delivery, factors to consider in order to deliver an antisense polynucleotide agent include, for example, biological stability of the delivered molecule, prevention
of non-specific effects, and accumulation of the delivered molecule in the target tissue. The non- specific effects of an antisense polynucleotide agent can be minimized by local administration, for example, by direct injection or implantation into a tissue or topically administering the preparation. Local administration to a treatment site maximizes local concentration of the agent, limits the exposure of the agent to systemic tissues that can otherwise be harmed by the agent or that can degrade the agent, and permits a lower total dose of the antisense polynucleotide agent to be administered.
Several studies have shown successful knockdown of gene products when an antisense polynucleotide agent is administered locally. For example, intraocular delivery of a VEGF antisense polynucleotide agent by intravitreal injection in cynomolgus monkeys (Tolentino, MJ., et al (2004) Retina 24:132-138) and subretinal injections in mice (Reich, SJ., et al (2003) Mol. Vis.9:210-216) were both shown to prevent neovascularization in an experimental model of age-related macular degeneration. In addition, direct intratumoral injection of a antisense polynucleotide agent in mice reduces tumor volume (Pille, J., et al (2005) Mol. Ther.11:267-274) and can prolong survival of tumor-bearing mice (Kim, WJ., et al (2006) Mol. Ther.14:343-350; Li, S., et al (2007) Mol. Ther. 15:515-523). RNA interference has also shown success with local delivery to the CNS by direct injection (Dorn, G., et al. (2004) Nucleic Acids 32:e49; Tan, PH., et al (2005) Gene Ther.12:59-66; Makimura, H., et al (2002) BMC Neurosci.3:18; Shishkina, GT., et al (2004) Neuroscience 129:521- 528; Thakker, ER., et al (2004) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A.101:17270-17275; Akaneya,Y., et al (2005) J. Neurophysiol.93:594-602) and to the lungs by intranasal administration (Howard, KA., et al (2006) Mol. Ther.14:476-484; Zhang, X., et al (2004) J. Biol. Chem.279:10677-10684; Bitko, V., et al (2005) Nat. Med.11:50-55).
For administering an antisense polynucleotide agent systemically for the treatment of a disease, the agent can be modified or alternatively delivered using a drug delivery system; both methods act to prevent the rapid degradation of the antisense polynucleotide agent by endo- and exo- nucleases in vivo. Modification of the agent or the pharmaceutical carrier can also permit targeting of the antisense polynucleotide agent composition to the target tissue and avoid undesirable off-target effects. Antisense polynucleotide agent can be modified by chemical conjugation to lipophilic groups such as cholesterol to enhance cellular uptake and prevent degradation. In an alternative embodiment, the antisense polynucleotide agent can be delivered using drug delivery systems such as a
nanoparticle, a dendrimer, a polymer, liposomes, or a cationic delivery system. Positively charged cationic delivery systems facilitate binding of an antisense polynucleotide agent molecule (negatively charged) and also enhance interactions at the negatively charged cell membrane to permit efficient uptake of an antisense polynucleotide agent by the cell. Cationic lipids, dendrimers, or polymers can either be bound to an antisense polynucleotide agent, or induced to form a vesicle or micelle (see e.g., Kim SH., et al (2008) Journal of Controlled Release 129(2):107-116) that encases an antisense polynucleotide agent. The formation of vesicles or micelles further prevents degradation of the antisense polynucleotide agent when administered systemically.
Methods for making and administering cationic-antisense polynucleotide agent complexes are well within the abilities of one skilled in the art (see e.g., Sorensen, DR., et al (2003) J. Mol. Biol 327:761-766; Verma, UN, et al (2003) Clin. Cancer Res.9:1291-1300; Arnold, AS et al (2007) J. Hypertens.25:197-205, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety). Some non- limiting examples of drug delivery systems useful for systemic delivery of antisense polynucleotide agents include DOTAP (Sorensen, DR., et al (2003), supra; Verma, UN., et al (2003), supra), Oligofectamine, "solid nucleic acid lipid particles" (Zimmermann, TS., et al (2006) Nature 441:111- 114), cardiolipin (Chien, PY., et al (2005) Cancer Gene Ther.12:321-328; Pal, A., et al (2005) Int J. Oncol.26:1087-1091), polyethyleneimine (Bonnet ME., et al (2008) Pharm. Res. Aug 16 Epub ahead of print; Aigner, A. (2006) J. Biomed. Biotechnol.71659), Arg-Gly-Asp (RGD) peptides (Liu, S. (2006) Mol. Pharm.3:472-487), and polyamidoamines (Tomalia, DA., et al (2007) Biochem. Soc. Trans.35:61-67; Yoo, H., et al (1999) Pharm. Res.16:1799-1804). In some embodiments, an antisense polynucleotide agent forms a complex with cyclodextrin for systemic administration.
Methods for administration and pharmaceutical compositions of antisense polynucleotide agents and cyclodextrins can be found in U.S. Patent No.7,427,605, which is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. VI. Pharmaceutical Compositions of the Invention
The present invention also includes pharmaceutical compositions and formulations which include the polynucleotide agents of the invention , e.g., antisense polynucleotide agents. In one embodiment, provided herein are pharmaceutical compositions containing an antisense polynucleotide agent, as described herein, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
The phrase "pharmaceutically acceptable" is employed herein to refer to those compounds, materials, compositions, or dosage forms which are, within the scope of sound medical judgment, suitable for use in contact with the tissues of human subjects and animal subjects without excessive toxicity, irritation, allergic response, or other problem or complication, commensurate with a reasonable benefit/risk ratio.
The phrase "pharmaceutically-acceptable carrier" as used herein means a pharmaceutically- acceptable material, composition or vehicle, such as a liquid or solid filler, diluent, excipient, manufacturing aid (e.g., lubricant, talc magnesium, calcium or zinc stearate, or steric acid), or solvent encapsulating material, involved in carrying or transporting the subject compound from one organ, or portion of the body, to another organ, or portion of the body. Each carrier must be "acceptable" in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not injurious to the subject being treated. Some examples of materials which can serve as pharmaceutically-acceptable carriers include: (1) sugars, such as lactose, glucose and sucrose; (2) starches, such as corn starch and potato starch; (3) cellulose, and its derivatives, such as sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose and cellulose acetate; (4) powdered tragacanth; (5) malt; (6) gelatin; (7) lubricating agents, such as magnesium state, sodium lauryl sulfate and talc; (8) excipients, such as cocoa butter and suppository waxes; (9) oils, such as peanut oil, cottonseed oil, safflower oil, sesame oil, olive oil, corn
oil and soybean oil; (10) glycols, such as propylene glycol; (11) polyols, such as glycerin, sorbitol, mannitol and polyethylene glycol; (12) esters, such as ethyl oleate and ethyl laurate; (13) agar; (14) buffering agents, such as magnesium hydroxide and aluminum hydroxide; (15) alginic acid; (16) pyrogen-free water; (17) isotonic saline; (18) Ringer's solution; (19) ethyl alcohol; (20) pH buffered solutions; (21) polyesters, polycarbonates or polyanhydrides; (22) bulking agents, such as polypeptides and amino acids (23) serum components, such as serum albumin, HDL and LDL; and (22) other non-toxic compatible substances employed in pharmaceutical formulations.
The pharmaceutical compositions containing the antisense polynucleotide agents are useful for treating a disease or disorder associated with the expression or activity of an IGFALS gene, e.g. an IGFALS-associated disease. Such pharmaceutical compositions are formulated based on the mode of delivery. One example is compositions that are formulated for systemic administration via parenteral delivery, e.g., by subcutaneous (SC) or intravenous (IV) delivery. The pharmaceutical compositions of the invention may be administered in dosages sufficient to inhibit expression of an IGFALS gene. In general, a suitable dose of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention will be in the range of 0.001 to 200.0 milligrams per kilogram body weight of the recipient per day, generally in the range of 1 to 50 mg per kilogram body weight per day. For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered at 0.01 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, 1 mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg, 2 mg/kg, 3 mg/kg, 10 mg/kg, 20 mg/kg, 30 mg/kg, 40 mg/kg, or 50 mg/kg per single dose.
For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 2, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
In another embodiment, the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered at a dose of about 0.1 to 50 mg/kg, 0.25 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.1 to 45 mg/kg, 0.25 to 45 mg/kg, 0.5 to 45 mg/kg, 0.75 to 45 mg/kg, 1 to 45 mg/mg, 1.5 to 45 mg/kb, 2 to 45 mg/kg, 2.5 to 45 mg/kg, 3 to 45 mg/kg, 3.5 to 45 mg/kg, 4 to 45 mg/kg, 4.5 to 45 mg/kg, 5 to 45 mg/kg, 7.5 to 45 mg/kg, 10 to 45 mg/kg, 15 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 30 to 45 mg/kg, 35 to 45 mg/kg, 40 to 45 mg/kg, 0.1 to 40 mg/kg, 0.25 to 40 mg/kg, 0.5 to 40 mg/kg, 0.75 to 40 mg/kg, 1 to 40 mg/mg, 1.5 to 40 mg/kb, 2 to 40 mg/kg, 2.5 to 40 mg/kg, 3 to 40 mg/kg, 3.5 to 40 mg/kg, 4 to 40 mg/kg, 4.5 to 40 mg/kg, 5 to 40 mg/kg, 7.5 to 40 mg/kg, 10 to 40 mg/kg, 15 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 30 to 40 mg/kg, 35 to 40 mg/kg, 0.1 to 30 mg/kg, 0.25 to 30 mg/kg, 0.5 to 30
mg/kg, 0.75 to 30 mg/kg, 1 to 30 mg/mg, 1.5 to 30 mg/kb, 2 to 30 mg/kg, 2.5 to 30 mg/kg, 3 to 30 mg/kg, 3.5 to 30 mg/kg, 4 to 30 mg/kg, 4.5 to 30 mg/kg, 5 to 30 mg/kg, 7.5 to 30 mg/kg, 10 to 30 mg/kg, 15 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 25 to 30 mg/kg, 0.1 to 20 mg/kg, 0.25 to 20 mg/kg, 0.5 to 20 mg/kg, 0.75 to 20 mg/kg, 1 to 20 mg/mg, 1.5 to 20 mg/kb, 2 to 20 mg/kg, 2.5 to 20 mg/kg, 3 to 20 mg/kg, 3.5 to 20 mg/kg, 4 to 20 mg/kg, 4.5 to 20 mg/kg, 5 to 20 mg/kg, 7.5 to 20 mg/kg, 10 to 20 mg/kg, or 15 to 20 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.01, 0.02, 0.03, 0.04, 0.05, 0.06, 0.07, 0.08, 0.09, 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 2, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
In another embodiment, the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered at a dose of about 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kgb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 45 mg/kg, 0.75 to 45 mg/kg, 1 to 45 mg/mg, 1.5 to 45 mg/kb, 2 to 45 mg/kg, 2.5 to 45 mg/kg, 3 to 45 mg/kg, 3.5 to 45 mg/kg, 4 to 45 mg/kg, 4.5 to 45 mg/kg, 5 to 45 mg/kg, 7.5 to 45 mg/kg, 10 to 45 mg/kg, 15 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 30 to 45 mg/kg, 35 to 45 mg/kg, 40 to 45 mg/kg, 0.5 to 40 mg/kg, 0.75 to 40 mg/kg, 1 to 40 mg/mg, 1.5 to 40 mg/kb, 2 to 40 mg/kg, 2.5 to 40 mg/kg, 3 to 40 mg/kg, 3.5 to 40 mg/kg, 4 to 40 mg/kg, 4.5 to 40 mg/kg, 5 to 40 mg/kg, 7.5 to 40 mg/kg, 10 to 40 mg/kg, 15 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 30 to 40 mg/kg, 35 to 40 mg/kg, 0.5 to 30 mg/kg, 0.75 to 30 mg/kg, 1 to 30 mg/mg, 1.5 to 30 mg/kb, 2 to 30 mg/kg, 2.5 to 30 mg/kg, 3 to 30 mg/kg, 3.5 to 30 mg/kg, 4 to 30 mg/kg, 4.5 to 30 mg/kg, 5 to 30 mg/kg, 7.5 to 30 mg/kg, 10 to 30 mg/kg, 15 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 25 to 30 mg/kg, 0.5 to 20 mg/kg, 0.75 to 20 mg/kg, 1 to 20 mg/kg, 1.5 to 20 mg/kg, 2 to 20 mg/kg, 2.5 to 20 mg/kg, 3 to 20 mg/kg, 3.5 to 20 mg/kg, 4 to 20 mg/kg, 4.5 to 20 mg/kg, 5 to 20 mg/kg, 7.5 to 20 mg/kg, 10 to 20 mg/kg, or 15 to 20 mg/kg. In one embodiment, the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered at a dose of 10mg/kg to 30 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
For example, subjects can be administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, a single therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4,
4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 10.5, 11, 11.5, 12, 12.5, 13, 13.5, 14, 14.5, 15, 15.5, 16, 16.5, 17, 17.5, 18, 18.5, 19, 19.5, 20, 20.5, 21, 21.5, 22, 22.5, 23, 23.5, 24, 24.5, 25, 25.5, 26, 26.5, 27, 27.5, 28, 28.5, 29, 29.5, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
In some embodiments, subjects are administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, multiple doses of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 10.5, 11, 11.5, 12, 12.5, 13, 13.5, 14, 14.5, 15, 15.5, 16, 16.5, 17, 17.5, 18, 18.5, 19, 19.5, 20, 20.5, 21, 21.5, 22, 22.5, 23, 23.5, 24, 24.5, 25, 25.5, 26, 26.5, 27, 27.5, 28, 28.5, 29, 29.5, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. A multi-dose regimine may include administration of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent daily, such as for two days, three days, four days, five days, six days, seven days, or longer.
In other embodiments, subjects are administered, e.g., subcutaneously or intravenously, a repeat dose of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose of about 0.1, 0.15, 0.2, 0.25, 0.3, 0.35, 0.4, 0.45, 0.5, 0.55, 0.6, 0.65, 0.7, 0.75, 0.8, 0.85, 0.9, 0.95, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 10.5, 11, 11.5, 12, 12.5, 13, 13.5, 14, 14.5, 15, 15.5, 16, 16.5, 17, 17.5, 18, 18.5, 19, 19.5, 20, 20.5, 21, 21.5, 22, 22.5, 23, 23.5, 24, 24.5, 25, 25.5, 26, 26.5, 27, 27.5, 28, 28.5, 29, 29.5, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. A repeat-dose regimine may include administration of a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent on a regular basis, such as every other day, every third day, every fourth day, twice a week, once a week, every other week, or once a month.
The pharmaceutical composition can be administered by intravenous infusion over a period of time, such as over about a 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, and 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, or 29 minute period. In certain embodiments, the infusion is administered over about 0.5, 1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3, 3.5, or 4 hours. The administration may be repeated, for example, on a regular basis, such as weekly, biweekly (i.e., every two weeks) for one month, two months, three months, four months or longer. After an initial treatment regimen, the treatments can be administered on a less frequent basis. For example, after administration weekly or biweekly for three months, administration can be repeated once per month, for six months or a year or longer.
The pharmaceutical composition can be administered once daily, or the antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered as two, three, or more sub-doses at appropriate intervals throughout the day or even using continuous infusion or delivery through a controlled release formulation. In that case, the antisense polynucleotide agent contained in each sub-dose must be correspondingly smaller in order to achieve the total daily dosage. The dosage unit can also be compounded for delivery over several days, e.g., using a conventional sustained release formulation which provides sustained release of the antisense polynucleotide agent over a several day period. Sustained release formulations are well known in the art and are particularly useful for delivery of agents at a particular site, such as could be used with the agents of the present invention. In this embodiment, the dosage unit contains a corresponding multiple of the daily dose.
In other embodiments, a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions can be long lasting, such that subsequent doses are administered at not more than 3, 4, or 5 day intervals, or at not more than 1, 2, 3, or 4 week intervals. In some embodiments of the invention, a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention is administered once per week. In other embodiments of the invention, a single dose of the pharmaceutical compositions of the invention is administered bi- monthly.
The skilled artisan will appreciate that certain factors can influence the dosage and timing required to effectively treat a subject, including but not limited to the severity of the disease or disorder, previous treatments, the general health or age of the subject, and other diseases present. Moreover, treatment of a subject with a therapeutically effective amount of a composition can include a single treatment or a series of treatments. Estimates of effective dosages and in vivo half-lives for the individual antisense polynucleotide agents encompassed by the invention can be made using conventional methodologies or on the basis of in vivo testing using an appropriate animal model, as described elsewhere herein.
Advances in mouse genetics have generated a number of mouse models for the study of various human diseases, such as a disorder that would benefit from reduction in the expression of IGFALS. Such models can be used for in vivo testing of an antisense polynucleotide agent, as well as for determining a therapeutically effective dose. Suitable mouse models are known in the art. For example, a mouse model of acromegaly was developed by Kovacs et al. (1997, Endocrinology) the entire contents of which are incorporated herein by reference. Bovine growth hormone transgenic mice also exhibit features of acromegaly (Palmiter et al., Science (1983), Olsson et al., Am J Phys Endo Metab (2003), Berryman et al, GH and IGF Res (2004), Izzard et al., GH and IGF Res (2009), Blutke et al., Mol and Cell Endo (2014)). Multiple animal models of cancer are known in the art.
The pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention can be administered in a number of ways depending upon whether local or systemic treatment is desired and upon the area to be treated. Administration can be topical (e.g., by a transdermal patch), pulmonary, e.g., by inhalation or insufflation of powders or aerosols, including by nebulizer; intratracheal, intranasal, epidermal and transdermal, oral or parenteral. Parenteral administration includes intravenous, intraarterial,
subcutaneous, intraperitoneal or intramuscular injection or infusion; subdermal, e.g., via an implanted device; or intracranial, e.g., by intraparenchymal, intrathecal or intraventricular, administration.
The antisense polynucleotide agent can be delivered in a manner to target a particular tissue, such as the liver (e.g., the hepatocytes of the liver).
Pharmaceutical compositions and formulations for topical administration can include transdermal patches, ointments, lotions, creams, gels, drops, suppositories, sprays, liquids and powders. Conventional pharmaceutical carriers, aqueous, powder or oily bases, thickeners and the like can be necessary or desirable. Coated condoms, gloves and the like can also be useful. Suitable topical formulations include those in which the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention are in admixture with a topical delivery agent such as lipids, liposomes, fatty acids, fatty acid esters, steroids, chelating agents and surfactants. Suitable lipids and liposomes include neutral (e.g., dioleoylphosphatidyl DOPE ethanolamine, dimyristoylphosphatidyl choline DMPC,
distearolyphosphatidyl choline) negative (e.g., dimyristoylphosphatidyl glycerol DMPG) and cationic (e.g., dioleoyltetramethylaminopropyl DOTAP and dioleoylphosphatidyl ethanolamine DOTMA). Antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be encapsulated within liposomes or can form complexes thereto, in particular to cationic liposomes. Alternatively, antisense
polynucleotide agents can be complexed to lipids, in particular to cationic lipids. Suitable fatty acids and esters include but are not limited to arachidonic acid, oleic acid, eicosanoic acid, lauric acid, caprylic acid, capric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein, dilaurin, glyceryl 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, an acylcarnitine, an acylcholine, or a C1-20 alkyl ester (e.g., isopropylmyristate IPM), monoglyceride, diglyceride or pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof). Topical formulations are described in detail in U.S. Patent No.6,747,014, which is incorporated herein by reference.
A. Polynucleotide Agent Formulations Comprising Membranous Molecular Assemblies An antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the compositions and methods of the invention can be formulated for delivery in a membranous molecular assembly, e.g., a liposome or a micelle. As used herein, the term“liposome” refers to a vesicle composed of amphiphilic lipids arranged in at least one bilayer, e.g., one bilayer or a plurality of bilayers. Liposomes include unilamellar and multilamellar vesicles that have a membrane formed from a lipophilic material and an aqueous interior. The aqueous portion contains the antisense polynucleotide agent composition. The lipophilic material isolates the aqueous interior from an aqueous exterior, which typically does not include the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, although in some examples, it may.
Liposomes are useful for the transfer and delivery of active ingredients to the site of action. Because the liposomal membrane is structurally similar to biological membranes, when liposomes are applied to a tissue, the liposomal bilayer fuses with bilayer of the cellular membranes. As the merging of the liposome and cell progresses, the internal aqueous contents that include the antisense polynucleotide agent are delivered into the cell where the antisense polynucleotide agent can specifically bind to a target RNA and can mediate antisense inhibition. In some cases the liposomes are also specifically targeted, e.g., to direct the antisense polynucleotide agent to particular cell types.
A liposome containing an antisense polynucleotide agent can be prepared by a variety of methods. In one example, the lipid component of a liposome is dissolved in a detergent so that micelles are formed with the lipid component. For example, the lipid component can be an amphipathic cationic lipid or lipid conjugate. The detergent can have a high critical micelle concentration and may be nonionic. Exemplary detergents include cholate, CHAPS, octylglucoside, deoxycholate, and lauroyl sarcosine. The antisense polynucleotide agent preparation is then added to the micelles that include the lipid component. The cationic groups on the lipid interact with the antisense polynucleotide agent and condense around the antisense polynucleotide agent to form a liposome. After condensation, the detergent is removed, e.g., by dialysis, to yield a liposomal preparation of antisense polynucleotide agent.
If necessary a carrier compound that assists in condensation can be added during the condensation reaction, e.g., by controlled addition. For example, the carrier compound can be a polymer other than a nucleic acid (e.g., spermine or spermidine). pH can also be adjusted to favor condensation.
Methods for producing stable polynucleotide delivery vehicles, which incorporate a polynucleotide/cationic lipid complex as structural components of the delivery vehicle, are further described in, e.g., WO 96/37194, the entire contents of which are incorporated herein by reference. Liposome formation can also include one or more aspects of exemplary methods described in Felgner, P. L. et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 8:7413-7417, 1987; U.S. Pat. No.4,897,355; U.S. Pat. No. 5,171,678; Bangham, et al. M. Mol. Biol.23:238, 1965; Olson, et al. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 557:9, 1979; Szoka, et al. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.75: 4194, 1978; Mayhew, et al. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 775:169, 1984; Kim, et al. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 728:339, 1983; and Fukunaga, et al. Endocrinol. 115:757, 1984. Commonly used techniques for preparing lipid aggregates of appropriate size for use as delivery vehicles include sonication and freeze-thaw plus extrusion (see, e.g., Mayer, et al.
Biochim. Biophys. Acta 858:161, 1986). Microfluidization can be used when consistently small (50 to 200 nm) and relatively uniform aggregates are desired (Mayhew, et al. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 775:169, 1984). These methods are readily adapted to packaging antisense polynucleotide agent preparations into liposomes.
Liposomes fall into two broad classes. Cationic liposomes are positively charged liposomes which interact with the negatively charged nucleic acid molecules to form a stable complex. The positively charged nucleic acid/liposome complex binds to the negatively charged cell surface and is internalized in an endosome. Due to the acidic pH within the endosome, the liposomes are ruptured, releasing their contents into the cell cytoplasm (Wang et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 1987, 147, 980-985).
Liposomes which are pH-sensitive or negatively-charged, entrap nucleic acids rather than complex with it. Since both the nucleic acid and the lipid are similarly charged, repulsion rather than complex formation occurs. Nevertheless, some nucleic acid is entrapped within the aqueous interior of these liposomes. pH-sensitive liposomes have been used to deliver nucleic acids encoding the
thymidine kinase gene to cell monolayers in culture. Expression of the exogenous gene was detected in the target cells (Zhou et al., Journal of Controlled Release, 1992, 19, 269-274).
One major type of liposomal composition includes phospholipids other than naturally-derived phosphatidylcholine. Neutral liposome compositions, for example, can be formed from dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (DMPC) or dipalmitoyl phosphatidylcholine (DPPC). Anionic liposome compositions generally are formed from dimyristoyl phosphatidylglycerol, while anionic fusogenic liposomes are formed primarily from dioleoyl phosphatidylethanolamine (DOPE). Another type of liposomal composition is formed from phosphatidylcholine (PC) such as, for example, soybean PC, and egg PC. Another type is formed from mixtures of phospholipid or phosphatidylcholine or cholesterol.
Examples of other methods to introduce liposomes into cells in vitro and in vivo include U.S. Pat. No.5,283,185; U.S. Pat. No.5,171,678; WO 94/00569; WO 93/24640; WO 91/16024; Felgner, J. Biol. Chem.269:2550, 1994; Nabel, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci.90:11307, 1993; Nabel, Human Gene Ther. 3:649, 1992; Gershon, Biochem.32:7143, 1993; and Strauss EMBO J.11:417, 1992.
Non-ionic liposomal systems have also been examined to determine their utility in the delivery of drugs to the skin, in particular systems comprising non-ionic surfactant and cholesterol. Non-ionic liposomal formulations comprising NovasomeTM I (glyceryl
dilaurate/cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether) and NovasomeTM II (glyceryl
distearate/cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether) were used to deliver cyclosporin-A into the dermis of mouse skin. Results indicated that such non-ionic liposomal systems were effective in facilitating the deposition of cyclosporine A into different layers of the skin (Hu et al. S.T.P.Pharma. Sci., 1994, 4(6) 466).
Liposomes also include“sterically stabilized” liposomes, a term which, as used herein, refers to liposomes comprising one or more specialized lipids that, when incorporated into liposomes, result in enhanced circulation lifetimes relative to liposomes lacking such specialized lipids. Examples of sterically stabilized liposomes are those in which part of the vesicle-forming lipid portion of the liposome (A) comprises one or more glycolipids, such as monosialoganglioside GM1, or (B) is derivatized with one or more hydrophilic polymers, such as a polyethylene glycol (PEG) moiety. While not wishing to be bound by any particular theory, it is thought in the art that, at least for sterically stabilized liposomes containing gangliosides, sphingomyelin, or PEG-derivatized lipids, the enhanced circulation half-life of these sterically stabilized liposomes derives from a reduced uptake into cells of the reticuloendothelial system (RES) (Allen et al., FEBS Letters, 1987, 223, 42; Wu et al., Cancer Research, 1993, 53, 3765).
Various liposomes comprising one or more glycolipids are known in the art. Papahadjopoulos et al. (Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci., 1987, 507, 64) reported the ability of monosialoganglioside GM1, galactocerebroside sulfate and phosphatidylinositol to improve blood half-lives of liposomes. These findings were expounded upon by Gabizon et al. (Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. U.S.A., 1988, 85, 6949). U.S. Pat. No.4,837,028 and WO 88/04924, both to Allen et al., disclose liposomes comprising (1) sphingomyelin and (2) the ganglioside GM1 or a galactocerebroside sulfate ester. U.S. Pat. No.
5,543,152 (Webb et al.) discloses liposomes comprising sphingomyelin. Liposomes comprising 1,2- sn-dimyristoylphosphatidylcholine are disclosed in WO 97/13499 (Lim et al).
In one embodiment, cationic liposomes are used. Cationic liposomes possess the advantage of being able to fuse to the cell membrane. Non-cationic liposomes, although not able to fuse as efficiently with the plasma membrane, are taken up by macrophages in vivo and can be used to deliver antisense polynucleotide agents to macrophages.
Further advantages of liposomes include: liposomes obtained from natural phospholipids are biocompatible and biodegradable; liposomes can incorporate a wide range of water and lipid soluble drugs; liposomes can protect encapsulated antisense polynucleotide agents in their internal compartments from metabolism and degradation (Rosoff, in "Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms," Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, volume 1, p.245). Important considerations in the preparation of liposome formulations are the lipid surface charge, vesicle size and the aqueous volume of the liposomes.
A positively charged synthetic cationic lipid, N-[1-(2,3-dioleyloxy)propyl]-N,N,N- trimethylammonium chloride (DOTMA) can be used to form small liposomes that interact spontaneously with nucleic acid to form lipid-nucleic acid complexes which are capable of fusing with the negatively charged lipids of the cell membranes of tissue culture cells, resulting in delivery of Antisense polynucleotide agent (see, e.g., Felgner, P. L. et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci., USA 8:7413- 7417, 1987 and U.S. Pat. No.4,897,355 for a description of DOTMA and its use with DNA).
A DOTMA analogue, 1,2-bis(oleoyloxy)-3-(trimethylammonia)propane (DOTAP) can be used in combination with a phospholipid to form DNA-complexing vesicles. Lipofectin™ Bethesda Research Laboratories, Gaithersburg, Md.) is an effective agent for the delivery of highly anionic nucleic acids into living tissue culture cells that comprise positively charged DOTMA liposomes which interact spontaneously with negatively charged polynucleotides to form complexes. When enough positively charged liposomes are used, the net charge on the resulting complexes is also positive. Positively charged complexes prepared in this way spontaneously attach to negatively charged cell surfaces, fuse with the plasma membrane, and efficiently deliver functional nucleic acids into, for example, tissue culture cells. Another commercially available cationic lipid, 1,2- bis(oleoyloxy)-3,3-(trimethylammonia)propane (“DOTAP”) (Boehringer Mannheim, Indianapolis, Indiana) differs from DOTMA in that the oleoyl moieties are linked by ester, rather than ether linkages.
Other reported cationic lipid compounds include those that have been conjugated to a variety of moieties including, for example, carboxyspermine which has been conjugated to one of two types of lipids and includes compounds such as 5-carboxyspermylglycine dioctaoleoylamide (“DOGS”) (Transfectam™, Promega, Madison, Wisconsin) and dipalmitoylphosphatidylethanolamine 5- carboxyspermyl-amide (“DPPES”) (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No.5,171,678).
Another cationic lipid conjugate includes derivatization of the lipid with cholesterol (“DC- Chol”) which has been formulated into liposomes in combination with DOPE (See, Gao, X. and Huang, L., Biochim. Biophys. Res. Commun.179:280, 1991). Lipopolylysine, made by conjugating
polylysine to DOPE, has been reported to be effective for transfection in the presence of serum (Zhou, X. et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta 1065:8, 1991). For certain cell lines, these liposomes containing conjugated cationic lipids, are said to exhibit lower toxicity and provide more efficient transfection than the DOTMA-containing compositions. Other commercially available cationic lipid products include DMRIE and DMRIE-HP (Vical, La Jolla, California) and Lipofectamine (DOSPA) (Life Technology, Inc., Gaithersburg, Maryland). Other cationic lipids suitable for the delivery of oligonucleotides are described in WO 98/39359 and WO 96/37194.
Liposomal formulations are particularly suited for topical administration; liposomes present several advantages over other formulations. Such advantages include reduced side effects related to high systemic absorption of the administered drug, increased accumulation of the administered drug at the desired target, and the ability to administer an antisense polynucleotide agent into the skin. In some implementations, liposomes are used for delivering antisense polynucleotide agenst to epidermal cells and also to enhance the penetration of antisense polynucleotide agenst into dermal tissues, e.g., into skin. For example, the liposomes can be applied topically. Topical delivery of drugs formulated as liposomes to the skin has been documented (see, e.g., Weiner et al., Journal of Drug Targeting, 1992, vol.2,405-410 and du Plessis et al., Antiviral Research, 18, 1992, 259-265; Mannino, R. J. and Fould-Fogerite, S., Biotechniques 6:682-690, 1988; Itani, T. et al. Gene 56:267- 276.1987; Nicolau, C. et al. Meth. Enz.149:157-176, 1987; Straubinger, R. M. and Papahadjopoulos, D. Meth. Enz.101:512-527, 1983; Wang, C. Y. and Huang, L., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 84:7851- 7855, 1987).
Non-ionic liposomal systems have also been examined to determine their utility in the delivery of drugs to the skin, in particular systems comprising non-ionic surfactant and cholesterol. Non-ionic liposomal formulations comprising Novasome I (glyceryl
dilaurate/cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether) and Novasome II (glyceryl distearate/ cholesterol/polyoxyethylene-10-stearyl ether) were used to deliver a drug into the dermis of mouse skin. Such formulations with antisense polynucleotide agents are useful for treating a dermatological disorder.
Liposomes that include antisense polynucleotide agent can be made highly deformable. Such deformability can enable the liposomes to penetrate through pore that are smaller than the average radius of the liposome. For example, transfersomes are a type of deformable liposomes.
Transferosomes can be made by adding surface edge activators, usually surfactants, to a standard liposomal composition. Transfersomes that include antisense polynucleotide agents can be delivered, for example, subcutaneously by infection in order to deliver antisense polynucleotide agents to keratinocytes in the skin. In order to cross intact mammalian skin, lipid vesicles must pass through a series of fine pores, each with a diameter less than 50 nm, under the influence of a suitable transdermal gradient. In addition, due to the lipid properties, these transferosomes can be self- optimizing (adaptive to the shape of pores, e.g., in the skin), self-repairing, and can frequently reach their targets without fragmenting, and often self-loading.
Other formulations amenable to the present invention are described in WO2009088892, WO2009086558, WO2009132131, and WO2008042973.
Transfersomes are yet another type of liposomes, and are highly deformable lipid aggregates which are attractive candidates for drug delivery vehicles. Transfersomes can be described as lipid droplets which are so highly deformable that they are easily able to penetrate through pores which are smaller than the droplet. Transfersomes are adaptable to the environment in which they are used, e.g., they are self-optimizing (adaptive to the shape of pores in the skin), self-repairing, frequently reach their targets without fragmenting, and often self-loading. To make transfersomes it is possible to add surface edge-activators, usually surfactants, to a standard liposomal composition. Transfersomes have been used to deliver serum albumin to the skin. The transfersome-mediated delivery of serum albumin has been shown to be as effective as subcutaneous injection of a solution containing serum albumin.
Surfactants find wide application in formulations such as emulsions (including
microemulsions) and liposomes. The most common way of classifying and ranking the properties of the many different types of surfactants, both natural and synthetic, is by the use of the
hydrophile/lipophile balance (HLB). The nature of the hydrophilic group (also known as the "head") provides the most useful means for categorizing the different surfactants used in formulations (Rieger, in“Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms”, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1988, p.285).
If the surfactant molecule is not ionized, it is classified as a nonionic surfactant. Nonionic surfactants find wide application in pharmaceutical and cosmetic products and are usable over a wide range of pH values. In general their HLB values range from 2 to 18 depending on their structure. Nonionic surfactants include nonionic esters such as ethylene glycol esters, propylene glycol esters, glyceryl esters, polyglyceryl esters, sorbitan esters, sucrose esters, and ethoxylated esters. Nonionic alkanolamides and ethers such as fatty alcohol ethoxylates, propoxylated alcohols, and
ethoxylated/propoxylated block polymers are also included in this class. The polyoxyethylene surfactants are the most popular members of the nonionic surfactant class.
If the surfactant molecule carries a negative charge when it is dissolved or dispersed in water, the surfactant is classified as anionic. Anionic surfactants include carboxylates such as soaps, acyl lactylates, acyl amides of amino acids, esters of sulfuric acid such as alkyl sulfates and ethoxylated alkyl sulfates, sulfonates such as alkyl benzene sulfonates, acyl isethionates, acyl taurates and sulfosuccinates, and phosphates. The most important members of the anionic surfactant class are the alkyl sulfates and the soaps.
If the surfactant molecule carries a positive charge when it is dissolved or dispersed in water, the surfactant is classified as cationic. Cationic surfactants include quaternary ammonium salts and ethoxylated amines. The quaternary ammonium salts are the most used members of this class.
If the surfactant molecule has the ability to carry either a positive or negative charge, the surfactant is classified as amphoteric. Amphoteric surfactants include acrylic acid derivatives, substituted alkylamides, N-alkylbetaines and phosphatides.
The use of surfactants in drug products, formulations and in emulsions has been reviewed (Rieger, in“Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms”, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1988, p.285).
The antisense polynucleotide agent for use in the compositions and methods of the invention can also be provided as micellar formulations.“Micelles” are defined herein as a particular type of molecular assembly in which amphipathic molecules are arranged in a spherical structure such that all the hydrophobic portions of the molecules are directed inward, leaving the hydrophilic portions in contact with the surrounding aqueous phase. The converse arrangement exists if the environment is hydrophobic.
A mixed micellar formulation suitable for delivery through transdermal membranes may be prepared by mixing an aqueous solution of the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, an alkali metal C8 to C22 alkyl sulphate, and a micelle forming compounds. Exemplary micelle forming compounds include lecithin, hyaluronic acid, pharmaceutically acceptable salts of hyaluronic acid, glycolic acid, lactic acid, chamomile extract, cucumber extract, oleic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, monoolein, monooleates, monolaurates, borage oil, evening of primrose oil, menthol, trihydroxy oxo cholanyl glycine and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, glycerin, polyglycerin, lysine, polylysine, triolein, polyoxyethylene ethers and analogues thereof, polidocanol alkyl ethers and analogues thereof, chenodeoxycholate, deoxycholate, and mixtures thereof. The micelle forming compounds may be added at the same time or after addition of the alkali metal alkyl sulphate. Mixed micelles will form with substantially any kind of mixing of the ingredients but vigorous mixing in order to provide smaller size micelles.
In one method a first micellar composition is prepared which contains the antisense polynucleotide agent composition and at least the alkali metal alkyl sulphate. The first micellar composition is then mixed with at least three micelle forming compounds to form a mixed micellar composition. In another method, the micellar composition is prepared by mixing the antisense polynucleotide agent composition, the alkali metal alkyl sulphate and at least one of the micelle forming compounds, followed by addition of the remaining micelle forming compounds, with vigorous mixing.
Phenol or m-cresol may be added to the mixed micellar composition to stabilize the formulation and protect against bacterial growth. Alternatively, phenol or m-cresol may be added with the micelle forming ingredients. An isotonic agent such as glycerin may also be added after formation of the mixed micellar composition.
For delivery of the micellar formulation as a spray, the formulation can be put into an aerosol dispenser and the dispenser is charged with a propellant. The propellant, which is under pressure, is in liquid form in the dispenser. The ratios of the ingredients are adjusted so that the aqueous and propellant phases become one, i.e., there is one phase. If there are two phases, it is necessary to shake the dispenser prior to dispensing a portion of the contents, e.g., through a metered valve. The dispensed dose of pharmaceutical agent is propelled from the metered valve in a fine spray.
Propellants may include hydrogen-containing chlorofluorocarbons, hydrogen-containing fluorocarbons, dimethyl ether and diethyl ether. In certain embodiments, HFA 134a (1,1,1,2 tetrafluoroethane) may be used.
The specific concentrations of the essential ingredients can be determined by relatively straightforward experimentation. For absorption through the oral cavities, it is often desirable to increase, e.g., at least double or triple, the dosage for through injection or administration through the gastrointestinal tract.
B. Lipid particles
Antisense polynucleotide agents of in the invention may be fully encapsulated in a lipid formulation, e.g., a LNP, or other nucleic acid-lipid particle.
As used herein, the term "LNP" refers to a stable nucleic acid-lipid particle comprising a lipid layer encapsulating a pharmaceutically active molecule. LNPs typically contain a cationic lipid, a non-cationic lipid, and a lipid that prevents aggregation of the particle (e.g., a PEG-lipid conjugate). LNPs are extremely useful for systemic applications, as they exhibit extended circulation lifetimes following intravenous (i.v.) injection and accumulate at distal sites (e.g., sites physically separated from the administration site). LNPs include "pSPLP," which include an encapsulated condensing agent-nucleic acid complex as set forth in PCT Publication No. WO 00/03683. The particles of the present invention typically have a mean diameter of 50 nm to 150 nm, more typically 60 nm to 130 nm, more typically 70 nm to 110 nm, most typically 70 nm to 90 nm, and are substantially nontoxic. In addition, the nucleic acids when present in the nucleic acid- lipid particles of the present invention are resistant in aqueous solution to degradation with a nuclease. Nucleic acid-lipid particles and their method of preparation are disclosed in, e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.5,976,567; 5,981,501; 6,534,484;
6,586,410; 6,815,432; 6,858,225; 8,158,601; and 8,058,069; U.S. Publication No.2010/0324120 and PCT Publication No. WO 96/40964.
In one embodiment, the lipid to drug ratio (mass/mass ratio) (e.g., lipid to antisense polynucleotide agent ratio) will be in the range of from 1:1 to 50:1, from 1:1 to 25:1, from 3:1 to 15:1, from 4:1 to 10:1, from 5:1 to 9:1, or 6:1 to 9:1. Ranges intermediate to the above recited ranges are also contemplated to be part of the invention.
The cationic lipid can be, for example, N,N-dioleyl-N,N-dimethylammonium chloride (DODAC), N,N-distearyl-N,N-dimethylammonium bromide (DDAB), N-(I -(2,3- dioleoyloxy)propyl)-N,N,N-trimethylammonium chloride (DOTAP), N-(I -(2,3- dioleyloxy)propyl)- N,N,N-trimethylammonium chloride (DOTMA), N,N-dimethyl-2,3- dioleyloxy)propylamine (DODMA), 1,2-DiLinoleyloxy-N,N-dimethylaminopropane (DLinDMA), l,2-Dilinolenyloxy-N,N- dimethylaminopropane (DLenDMA), 1,2-Dilinoleylcarbamoyloxy-3-dimethylaminopropane (DLin- C-DAP), 1,2-Dilinoleyoxy-3-(dimethylamino)acetoxypropane (DLin-DAC), 1,2-Dilinoleyoxy-3- morpholinopropane (DLin-MA), 1,2-Dilinoleoyl-3-dimethylaminopropane (DLinDAP), 1,2- Dilinoleylthio-3-dimethylaminopropane (DLin-S-DMA), 1-Linoleoyl-2-linoleyloxy-3- dimethylaminopropane (DLin-2-DMAP), 1,2-Dilinoleyloxy-3-trimethylaminopropane chloride salt (DLin-TMA.Cl), 1,2-Dilinoleoyl-3-trimethylaminopropane chloride salt (DLin-TAP.Cl), 1,2- Dilinoleyloxy-3-(N-methylpiperazino)propane (DLin-MPZ), or 3-(N,N-Dilinoleylamino)-1,2- propanediol (DLinAP), 3-(N,N-Dioleylamino)-1,2-propanedio (DOAP), 1,2-Dilinoleyloxo-3-(2-N,N- dimethylamino)ethoxypropane (DLin-EG-DMA), l,2-Dilinolenyloxy-N,N-dimethylaminopropane
(DLinDMA), 2,2-Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminomethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane (DLin-K-DMA) or analogs thereof, (3aR,5s,6aS)-N,N-dimethyl-2,2-di((9Z,12Z)-octadeca-9,12-dienyl)tetrahydro-3aH- cyclopenta[d][1,3]dioxol-5-amine (ALN100), (6Z,9Z,28Z,31Z)-heptatriaconta-6,9,28,31-tetraen-19-yl 4-(dimethylamino)butanoate (MC3), 1,1'-(2-(4-(2-((2-(bis(2-hydroxydodecyl)amino)ethyl)(2- hydroxydodecyl)amino)ethyl)piperazin-1-yl)ethylazanediyl)didodecan-2-ol (Tech G1), or a mixture thereof. The cationic lipid can comprise from 20 mol % to 50 mol % or 40 mol % of the total lipid present in the particle.
In another embodiment, the compound 2,2-Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane can be used to prepare lipid-santisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles. Synthesis of 2,2- Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane is described in United States provisional patent application number 61/107,998 filed on October 23, 2008, which is herein incorporated by reference.
In one embodiment, the lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent particle includes 40% 2, 2- Dilinoleyl-4-dimethylaminoethyl-[1,3]-dioxolane: 10% DSPC: 40% Cholesterol: 10% PEG-C-DOMG (mole percent) with a particle size of 63.0 ± 20 nm and a 0.027 antisense polynucleotide agent/Lipid Ratio.
The ionizable/non-cationic lipid can be an anionic lipid or a neutral lipid including, but not limited to, distearoylphosphatidylcholine (DSPC), dioleoylphosphatidylcholine (DOPC),
dipalmitoylphosphatidylcholine (DPPC), dioleoylphosphatidylglycerol (DOPG),
dipalmitoylphosphatidylglycerol (DPPG), dioleoyl-phosphatidylethanolamine (DOPE),
palmitoyloleoylphosphatidylcholine (POPC), palmitoyloleoylphosphatidylethanolamine (POPE), dioleoyl- phosphatidylethanolamine 4-(N-maleimidomethyl)-cyclohexane-l- carboxylate (DOPE- mal), dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (DPPE), dimyristoylphosphoethanolamine (DMPE), distearoyl-phosphatidyl-ethanolamine (DSPE), 16-O-monomethyl PE, 16-O-dimethyl PE, 18-1 -trans PE, 1 -stearoyl-2-oleoyl- phosphatidyethanolamine (SOPE), cholesterol, or a mixture thereof. The non-cationic lipid can be from 5 mol % to 90 mol %, 10 mol %, or 58 mol % if cholesterol is included, of the total lipid present in the particle.
The conjugated lipid that inhibits aggregation of particles can be, for example, a
polyethyleneglycol (PEG)-lipid including, without limitation, a PEG-diacylglycerol (DAG), a PEG- dialkyloxypropyl (DAA), a PEG-phospholipid, a PEG-ceramide (Cer), or a mixture thereof. The PEG-DAA conjugate can be, for example, a PEG-dilauryloxypropyl (Ci2), a PEG- dimyristyloxypropyl (Ci4), a PEG-dipalmityloxypropyl (Ci6), or a PEG- distearyloxypropyl (C]8). The conjugated lipid that prevents aggregation of particles can be from 0 mol % to 20 mol % or 2 mol % of the total lipid present in the particle.
In some embodiments, the nucleic acid-lipid particle further includes cholesterol at, e.g., 10 mol % to 60 mol % or 48 mol % of the total lipid present in the particle.
In one embodiment, the lipidoid ND98·4HCl (MW 1487) (see U.S. Patent Application No. 12/056,230, filed 3/26/2008, which is incorporated herein by reference), Cholesterol (Sigma-Aldrich), and PEG-Ceramide C16 (Avanti Polar Lipids) can be used to prepare lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles (i.e., LNP01 particles). Stock solutions of each in ethanol can be prepared as
follows: ND98, 133 mg/ml; Cholesterol, 25 mg/ml, PEG-Ceramide C16, 100 mg/ml. The ND98, Cholesterol, and PEG-Ceramide C16 stock solutions can then be combined in a, e.g., 42:48:10 molar ratio. The combined lipid solution can be mixed with aqueous antisense polynucleotide agent (e.g., in sodium acetate pH 5) such that the final ethanol concentration is 35-45% and the final sodium acetate concentration is 100-300 mM. Lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent nanoparticles typically form spontaneously upon mixing. Depending on the desired particle size distribution, the resultant nanoparticle mixture can be extruded through a polycarbonate membrane (e.g., 100 nm cut-off) using, for example, a thermobarrel extruder, such as Lipex Extruder (Northern Lipids, Inc). In some cases, the extrusion step can be omitted. Ethanol removal and simultaneous buffer exchange can be accomplished by, for example, dialysis or tangential flow filtration. Buffer can be exchanged with, for example, phosphate buffered saline (PBS) at pH 7, e.g., pH 6.9, pH 7.0, pH 7.1, pH 7.2, pH 7.3, or pH 7.4.
LNP01 formulations are described, e.g., in International Application Publication No. WO 2008/042973, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
Additional exemplary lipid-antisense polynucleotide agent formulations are described in Table 1.
DPPC: dipalmitoylphosphatidylcholine
PEG-DMG: PEG-didimyristoyl glycerol (C14-PEG, or PEG-C14) (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000)
PEG-DSG: PEG-distyryl glycerol (C18-PEG, or PEG-C18) (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000)
PEG-cDMA: PEG-carbamoyl-1,2-dimyristyloxypropylamine (PEG with avg mol wt of 2000) SNALP (l,2-Dilinolenyloxy-N,N-dimethylaminopropane (DLinDMA)) comprising formulations are described in International Publication No. WO2009/127060, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
XTC comprising formulations are described in WO2010008537, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
MC3 comprising formulations are described in U.S. Publication No.2010/0324120, filed June 10, 2010, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.
ALNY-100 comprising formulations are described inWO201054406, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
C12-200 comprising formulations are described in WO2010129709, which is hereby incorporated by reference.
Synthesis of ionizable/cationic lipids
Any of the compounds, e.g., cationic lipids and the like, used in the nucleic acid-lipid particles of the invention can be prepared by known organic synthesis techniques, including the methods described in more detail in the Examples. All substituents are as defined below unless indicated otherwise.
“Alkyl” means a straight chain or branched, noncyclic or cyclic, saturated aliphatic hydrocarbon containing from 1 to 24 carbon atoms. Representative saturated straight chain alkyls include methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, n-pentyl, n-hexyl, and the like; while saturated branched alkyls include isopropyl, sec-butyl, isobutyl, tert-butyl, isopentyl, and the like. Representative saturated cyclic alkyls include cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, and the like; while unsaturated cyclic alkyls include cyclopentenyl and cyclohexenyl, and the like.
“Alkenyl” means an alkyl, as defined above, containing at least one double bond between adjacent carbon atoms. Alkenyls include both cis and trans isomers. Representative straight chain and branched alkenyls include ethylenyl, propylenyl, 1-butenyl, 2-butenyl, isobutylenyl, 1-pentenyl, 2-pentenyl, 3-methyl-1-butenyl, 2-methyl-2-butenyl, 2,3-dimethyl-2-butenyl, and the like.
“Alkynyl” means any alkyl or alkenyl, as defined above, which additionally contains at least one triple bond between adjacent carbons. Representative straight chain and branched alkynyls include acetylenyl, propynyl, 1-butynyl, 2-butynyl, 1-pentynyl, 2-pentynyl, 3-methyl-1 butynyl, and the like.
“Acyl” means any alkyl, alkenyl, or alkynyl wherein the carbon at the point of attachment is substituted with an oxo group, as defined below. For example, -C(=O)alkyl, -C(=O)alkenyl, and - C(=O)alkynyl are acyl groups.
“Heterocycle” means a 5- to 7-membered monocyclic, or 7- to 10-membered bicyclic, heterocyclic ring which is either saturated, unsaturated, or aromatic, and which contains from 1 or 2 heteroatoms independently selected from nitrogen, oxygen and sulfur, and wherein the nitrogen and sulfur heteroatoms can be optionally oxidized, and the nitrogen heteroatom can be optionally quaternized, including bicyclic rings in which any of the above heterocycles are fused to a benzene
ring. The heterocycle can be attached via any heteroatom or carbon atom. Heterocycles include heteroaryls as defined below. Heterocycles include morpholinyl, pyrrolidinonyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, piperizynyl, hydantoinyl, valerolactamyl, oxiranyl, oxetanyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydropyridinyl, tetrahydroprimidinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl,
tetrahydrothiopyranyl, tetrahydropyrimidinyl, tetrahydrothiophenyl, tetrahydrothiopyranyl, and the like.
The terms“optionally substituted alkyl”,“optionally substituted alkenyl”,“optionally substituted alkynyl”,“optionally substituted acyl”, and“optionally substituted heterocycle” means that, when substituted, at least one hydrogen atom is replaced with a substituent. In the case of an oxo substituent (=O) two hydrogen atoms are replaced. In this regard, substituents include oxo, halogen, heterocycle, -CN, -ORx, -NRxRy, -NRxC(=O)Ry, -NRxSO2Ry, -C(=O)Rx, -C(=O)ORx,
-C(=O)NRxRy,–SOnRx and -SOnNRxRy, wherein n is 0, 1 or 2, Rx and Ry are the same or different and independently hydrogen, alkyl or heterocycle, and each of said alkyl and heterocycle substituents can be further substituted with one or more of oxo, halogen, -OH, -CN, alkyl, -ORx, heterocycle, -NRxRy, -NRxC(=O)Ry, -NRxSO2Ry, -C(=O)Rx, -C(=O)ORx, -C(=O)NRxRy, -SOnRx and -SOnNRxRy.
“Halogen” means fluoro, chloro, bromo and iodo.
In some embodiments, protecting groups can be used. Protecting group methodology is well known to those skilled in the art (see, for example, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, Green, T.W. et al., Wiley-Interscience, New York City, 1999). Briefly, protecting groups within the context of this invention are any group that reduces or eliminates unwanted reactivity of a functional group. A protecting group can be added to a functional group to mask its reactivity during certain reactions and then removed to reveal the original functional group. In some embodiments an“alcohol protecting group” is used. An“alcohol protecting group” is any group which decreases or eliminates unwanted reactivity of an alcohol functional group. Protecting groups can be added and removed using techniques well known in the art.
Formulations prepared by either the standard or extrusion-free method can be characterized in similar manners. For example, formulations are typically characterized by visual inspection. They should be whitish translucent solutions free from aggregates or sediment. Particle size and particle size distribution of lipid-nanoparticles can be measured by light scattering using, for example, a Malvern Zetasizer Nano ZS (Malvern, USA). Particles should be 20-300 nm, such as 40-100 nm in size. The particle size distribution should be unimodal. The total antisense polynucleotide agent concentration in the formulation, as well as the entrapped fraction, is estimated using a dye exclusion assay. A sample of the formulated antisense polynucleotide agent can be incubated with an RNA- binding dye, such as Ribogreen (Molecular Probes) in the presence or absence of a formulation disrupting surfactant, e.g., 0.5% Triton-X100. The total antisense polynucleotide agent in the formulation can be determined by the signal from the sample containing the surfactant, relative to a standard curve. The entrapped fraction is determined by subtracting the“free” antisense
polynucleotide agent content (as measured by the signal in the absence of surfactant) from the total
antisense polynucleotide agent content. Percent entrapped antisense polynucleotide agent is typically >85%. For SNALP formulation, the particle size is at least 30 nm, at least 40 nm, at least 50 nm, at least 60 nm, at least 70 nm, at least 80 nm, at least 90 nm, at least 100 nm, at least 110 nm, and at least 120 nm. The suitable range is typically at least 50 nm to at least 110 nm, at least 60 nm to at least 100 nm, or at least 80 nm to at least 90 nm.
Compositions and formulations for oral administration include powders or granules, microparticulates, nanoparticulates, suspensions or solutions in water or non-aqueous media, capsules, gel capsules, sachets, tablets or minitablets. Thickeners, flavoring agents, diluents, emulsifiers, dispersing aids or binders can be desirable. In some embodiments, oral formulations are those in which the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention are administered in conjunction with one or more penetration enhancer surfactants and chelators. Suitable surfactants include fatty acids or esters or salts thereof, bile acids or salts thereof. Suitable bile acids/salts include
chenodeoxycholic acid (CDCA) and ursodeoxychenodeoxycholic acid (UDCA), cholic acid, dehydrocholic acid, deoxycholic acid, glucholic acid, glycholic acid, glycodeoxycholic acid, taurocholic acid, taurodeoxycholic acid, sodium tauro-24,25-dihydro-fusidate and sodium
glycodihydrofusidate. Suitable fatty acids include arachidonic acid, undecanoic acid, oleic acid, lauric acid, caprylic acid, capric acid, myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein, dilaurin, glyceryl 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, an acylcarnitine, an acylcholine, or a monoglyceride, a diglyceride or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof (e.g., sodium). In some embodiments, combinations of penetration enhancers are used, for example, fatty acids/salts in combination with bile acids/salts. One exemplary combination is the sodium salt of lauric acid, capric acid and UDCA. Further penetration enhancers include
polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether, polyoxyethylene-20-cetyl ether. Antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be delivered orally, in granular form including sprayed dried particles, or complexed to form micro or nanoparticles. Antisense polynucleotide agent complexing agents include poly-amino acids; polyimines; polyacrylates; polyalkylacrylates, polyoxethanes,
polyalkylcyanoacrylates; cationized gelatins, albumins, starches, acrylates, polyethyleneglycols (PEG) and starches; polyalkylcyanoacrylates; DEAE-derivatized polyimines, pollulans, celluloses and starches. Suitable complexing agents include chitosan, N-trimethylchitosan, poly-L-lysine, polyhistidine, polyornithine, polyspermines, protamine, polyvinylpyridine,
polythiodiethylaminomethylethylene P(TDAE), polyaminostyrene (e.g., p-amino),
poly(methylcyanoacrylate), poly(ethylcyanoacrylate), poly(butylcyanoacrylate),
poly(isobutylcyanoacrylate), poly(isohexylcynaoacrylate), DEAE-methacrylate, DEAE-hexylacrylate, DEAE-acrylamide, DEAE-albumin and DEAE-dextran, polymethylacrylate, polyhexylacrylate, poly(D,L-lactic acid), poly(DL-lactic-co-glycolic acid (PLGA), alginate, and polyethyleneglycol (PEG). Oral formulations for antisense polynucleotide agents and their preparation are described in detail in U.S. Patent 6,887,906, US Publn. No.20030027780, and U.S. Patent No.6,747,014, each of which is incorporated herein by reference.
Compositions and formulations for parenteral, intraparenchymal (into the brain), intrathecal, intraventricular or intrahepatic administration can include sterile aqueous solutions which can also contain buffers, diluents and other suitable additives such as, but not limited to, penetration enhancers, carrier compounds and other pharmaceutically acceptable carriers or excipients.
Pharmaceutical compositions of the present invention include, but are not limited to, solutions, emulsions, and liposome-containing formulations. These compositions can be generated from a variety of components that include, but are not limited to, preformed liquids, self-emulsifying solids and self-emulsifying semisolids. Particularly preferred are formulations that target the liver, e.g., when treating hepatic disorders, e.g., hepatic carcinoma.
The pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention, which can conveniently be presented in unit dosage form, can be prepared according to conventional techniques well known in the pharmaceutical industry. Such techniques include the step of bringing into association the active ingredients with the pharmaceutical carrier(s) or excipient(s). In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredients with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product.
The compositions of the present invention can be formulated into any of many possible dosage forms such as, but not limited to, tablets, capsules, gel capsules, liquid syrups, soft gels, suppositories, and enemas. The compositions of the present invention can also be formulated as suspensions in aqueous, non-aqueous or mixed media. Aqueous suspensions can further contain substances which increase the viscosity of the suspension including, for example, sodium
carboxymethylcellulose, sorbitol or dextran. The suspension can also contain stabilizers.
C. Additional Formulations
i. Emulsions
The compositions of the present invention can be prepared and formulated as emulsions. Emulsions are typically heterogeneous systems of one liquid dispersed in another in the form of droplets usually exceeding 0.1µm in diameter (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199; Rosoff, in
Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., Volume 1, p.245; Block in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 2, p.335; Higuchi et al., in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mack Publishing Co., Easton, Pa., 1985, p.301). Emulsions are often biphasic systems comprising two immiscible liquid phases intimately mixed and dispersed with each other. In general, emulsions can be of either the water-in-oil (w/o) or the oil-in-water (o/w) variety. When an aqueous phase is finely divided into and dispersed as minute droplets into a bulk oily phase, the resulting composition is called a water-in-oil (w/o) emulsion. Alternatively, when an oily phase is finely divided into and dispersed as minute droplets into a bulk aqueous phase, the resulting composition is called an oil-in-water (o/w) emulsion. Emulsions can contain additional
components in addition to the dispersed phases, and the active drug which can be present as a solution in either the aqueous phase, oily phase or itself as a separate phase. Pharmaceutical excipients such as emulsifiers, stabilizers, dyes, and anti-oxidants can also be present in emulsions as needed.
Pharmaceutical emulsions can also be multiple emulsions that are comprised of more than two phases such as, for example, in the case of oil-in-water-in-oil (o/w/o) and water-in-oil-in-water (w/o/w) emulsions. Such complex formulations often provide certain advantages that simple binary emulsions do not. Multiple emulsions in which individual oil droplets of an o/w emulsion enclose small water droplets constitute a w/o/w emulsion. Likewise a system of oil droplets enclosed in globules of water stabilized in an oily continuous phase provides an o/w/o emulsion.
Emulsions are characterized by little or no thermodynamic stability. Often, the dispersed or discontinuous phase of the emulsion is well dispersed into the external or continuous phase and maintained in this form through the means of emulsifiers or the viscosity of the formulation. Either of the phases of the emulsion can be a semisolid or a solid, as is the case of emulsion-style ointment bases and creams. Other means of stabilizing emulsions entail the use of emulsifiers that can be incorporated into either phase of the emulsion. Emulsifiers can broadly be classified into four categories: synthetic surfactants, naturally occurring emulsifiers, absorption bases, and finely dispersed solids (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199).
Synthetic surfactants, also known as surface active agents, have found wide applicability in the formulation of emulsions and have been reviewed in the literature (see e.g., Ansel's
Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rieger, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.285; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., 1988, volume 1, p.199). Surfactants are typically amphiphilic and comprise a hydrophilic and a hydrophobic portion. The ratio of the hydrophilic to the hydrophobic nature of the surfactant has been termed the hydrophile/lipophile balance (HLB) and is a valuable tool in categorizing and selecting surfactants in the preparation of formulations. Surfactants can be classified into different classes based on the nature of the hydrophilic group: nonionic, anionic, cationic and amphoteric (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY Rieger, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.285).
Naturally occurring emulsifiers used in emulsion formulations include lanolin, beeswax, phosphatides, lecithin and acacia. Absorption bases possess hydrophilic properties such that they can soak up water to form w/o emulsions yet retain their semisolid consistencies, such as anhydrous lanolin and hydrophilic petrolatum. Finely divided solids have also been used as good emulsifiers
especially in combination with surfactants and in viscous preparations. These include polar inorganic solids, such as heavy metal hydroxides, nonswelling clays such as bentonite, attapulgite, hectorite, kaolin, montmorillonite, colloidal aluminum silicate and colloidal magnesium aluminum silicate, pigments and nonpolar solids such as carbon or glyceryl tristearate.
A large variety of non-emulsifying materials are also included in emulsion formulations and contribute to the properties of emulsions. These include fats, oils, waxes, fatty acids, fatty alcohols, fatty esters, humectants, hydrophilic colloids, preservatives and antioxidants (Block, in
Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.335; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199).
Hydrophilic colloids or hydrocolloids include naturally occurring gums and synthetic polymers such as polysaccharides (for example, acacia, agar, alginic acid, carrageenan, guar gum, karaya gum, and tragacanth), cellulose derivatives (for example, carboxymethylcellulose and carboxypropylcellulose), and synthetic polymers (for example, carbomers, cellulose ethers, and carboxyvinyl polymers). These disperse or swell in water to form colloidal solutions that stabilize emulsions by forming strong interfacial films around the dispersed-phase droplets and by increasing the viscosity of the external phase.
Since emulsions often contain a number of ingredients such as carbohydrates, proteins, sterols and phosphatides that can readily support the growth of microbes, these formulations often incorporate preservatives. Commonly used preservatives included in emulsion formulations include methyl paraben, propyl paraben, quaternary ammonium salts, benzalkonium chloride, esters of p- hydroxybenzoic acid, and boric acid. Antioxidants are also commonly added to emulsion formulations to prevent deterioration of the formulation. Antioxidants used can be free radical scavengers such as tocopherols, alkyl gallates, butylated hydroxyanisole, butylated hydroxytoluene, or reducing agents such as ascorbic acid and sodium metabisulfite, and antioxidant synergists such as citric acid, tartaric acid, and lecithin.
The application of emulsion formulations via dermatological, oral and parenteral routes and methods for their manufacture have been reviewed in the literature (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199). Emulsion formulations for oral delivery have been very widely used because of ease of formulation, as well as efficacy from an absorption and bioavailability standpoint (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rosoff, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.245; Idson, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.199). Mineral-oil base laxatives, oil-soluble vitamins and high fat
nutritive preparations are among the materials that have commonly been administered orally as o/w emulsions.
ii. Microemulsions
In one embodiment of the present invention, the compositions of antisense polynucleotide agents are formulated as microemulsions. A microemulsion can be defined as a system of water, oil and amphiphile which is a single optically isotropic and thermodynamically stable liquid solution (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rosoff, in
Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.245). Typically microemulsions are systems that are prepared by first dispersing an oil in an aqueous surfactant solution and then adding a sufficient amount of a fourth component, generally an intermediate chain-length alcohol to form a transparent system. Therefore, microemulsions have also been described as thermodynamically stable, isotropically clear dispersions of two immiscible liquids that are stabilized by interfacial films of surface-active molecules (Leung and Shah, in: Controlled Release of Drugs: Polymers and Aggregate Systems, Rosoff, M., Ed., 1989, VCH Publishers, New York, pages 185-215). Microemulsions commonly are prepared via a combination of three to five components that include oil, water, surfactant, cosurfactant and electrolyte. Whether the microemulsion is of the water-in-oil (w/o) or an oil-in-water (o/w) type is dependent on the properties of the oil and surfactant used and on the structure and geometric packing of the polar heads and hydrocarbon tails of the surfactant molecules (Schott, in Remington's
Pharmaceutical Sciences, Mack Publishing Co., Easton, Pa., 1985, p.271).
The phenomenological approach utilizing phase diagrams has been extensively studied and has yielded a comprehensive knowledge, to one skilled in the art, of how to formulate microemulsions (see e.g., Ansel's Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms and Drug Delivery Systems, Allen, LV., Popovich NG., and Ansel HC., 2004, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins (8th ed.), New York, NY; Rosoff, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.245; Block, in Pharmaceutical Dosage Forms, Lieberman, Rieger and Banker (Eds.), 1988, Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, N.Y., volume 1, p.335). Compared to conventional emulsions, microemulsions offer the advantage of solubilizing water-insoluble drugs in a formulation of thermodynamically stable droplets that are formed spontaneously.
Surfactants used in the preparation of microemulsions include, but are not limited to, ionic surfactants, non-ionic surfactants, Brij 96, polyoxyethylene oleyl ethers, polyglycerol fatty acid esters, tetraglycerol monolaurate (ML310), tetraglycerol monooleate (MO310), hexaglycerol monooleate (PO310), hexaglycerol pentaoleate (PO500), decaglycerol monocaprate (MCA750), decaglycerol monooleate (MO750), decaglycerol sequioleate (SO750), decaglycerol decaoleate (DAO750), alone or in combination with cosurfactants. The cosurfactant, usually a short-chain alcohol such as ethanol, 1-propanol, and 1-butanol, serves to increase the interfacial fluidity by penetrating into the surfactant film and consequently creating a disordered film because of the void space generated among surfactant molecules. Microemulsions can, however, be prepared without the use of cosurfactants and
alcohol-free self-emulsifying microemulsion systems are known in the art. The aqueous phase can typically be, but is not limited to, water, an aqueous solution of the drug, glycerol, PEG300, PEG400, polyglycerols, propylene glycols, and derivatives of ethylene glycol. The oil phase can include, but is not limited to, materials such as Captex 300, Captex 355, Capmul MCM, fatty acid esters, medium chain (C8-C12) mono, di, and tri-glycerides, polyoxyethylated glyceryl fatty acid esters, fatty alcohols, polyglycolized glycerides, saturated polyglycolized C8-C10 glycerides, vegetable oils and silicone oil.
Microemulsions are particularly of interest from the standpoint of drug solubilization and the enhanced absorption of drugs. Lipid based microemulsions (both o/w and w/o) have been proposed to enhance the oral bioavailability of drugs, including peptides (see e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.6,191,105; 7,063,860; 7,070,802; 7,157,099; Constantinides et al., Pharmaceutical Research, 1994, 11, 1385- 1390; Ritschel, Meth. Find. Exp. Clin. Pharmacol., 1993, 13, 205). Microemulsions afford advantages of improved drug solubilization, protection of drug from enzymatic hydrolysis, possible enhancement of drug absorption due to surfactant-induced alterations in membrane fluidity and permeability, ease of preparation, ease of oral administration over solid dosage forms, improved clinical potency, and decreased toxicity (see e.g., U.S. Patent Nos.6,191,105; 7,063,860; 7,070,802; 7,157,099;
Constantinides et al., Pharmaceutical Research, 1994, 11, 1385; Ho et al., J. Pharm. Sci., 1996, 85, 138-143). Often microemulsions can form spontaneously when their components are brought together at ambient temperature. This can be particularly advantageous when formulating thermolabile drugs, peptides or antisense polynucleotide agents. Microemulsions have also been effective in the transdermal delivery of active components in both cosmetic and pharmaceutical applications. It is expected that the microemulsion compositions and formulations of the present invention will facilitate the increased systemic absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents from the gastrointestinal tract, as well as improve the local cellular uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents and nucleic acids.
Microemulsions of the present invention can also contain additional components and additives such as sorbitan monostearate (Grill 3), Labrasol, and penetration enhancers to improve the properties of the formulation and to enhance the absorption of the antisense polynucleotide agents of the present invention. Penetration enhancers used in the microemulsions of the present invention can be classified as belonging to one of five broad categories--surfactants, fatty acids, bile salts, chelating agents, and non-chelating non-surfactants (Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92). Each of these classes has been discussed above.
iii. Microparticles
An antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be incorporated into a particle, e.g., a microparticle. Microparticles can be produced by spray-drying, but may also be produced by other methods including lyophilization, evaporation, fluid bed drying, vacuum drying, or a combination of these techniques.
iv. Penetration Enhancers
In one embodiment, the present invention employs various penetration enhancers to effect the efficient delivery of nucleic acids, particularly antisense polynucleotide agents, to the skin of animals.
Most drugs are present in solution in both ionized and nonionized forms. However, usually only lipid soluble or lipophilic drugs readily cross cell membranes. It has been discovered that even non- lipophilic drugs can cross cell membranes if the membrane to be crossed is treated with a penetration enhancer. In addition to aiding the diffusion of non-lipophilic drugs across cell membranes, penetration enhancers also enhance the permeability of lipophilic drugs.
Penetration enhancers can be classified as belonging to one of five broad categories, i.e., surfactants, fatty acids, bile salts, chelating agents, and non-chelating non-surfactants (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92). Each of the above mentioned classes of penetration enhancers are described below in greater detail.
Surfactants (or "surface-active agents") are chemical entities which, when dissolved in an aqueous solution, reduce the surface tension of the solution or the interfacial tension between the aqueous solution and another liquid, with the result that absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the mucosa is enhanced. In addition to bile salts and fatty acids, these penetration enhancers include, for example, sodium lauryl sulfate, polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether and polyoxyethylene-20- cetyl ether) (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92); and perfluorochemical emulsions, such as FC-43. Takahashi et al., J. Pharm. Pharmacol., 1988, 40, 252).
Various fatty acids and their derivatives which act as penetration enhancers include, for example, oleic acid, lauric acid, capric acid (n-decanoic acid), myristic acid, palmitic acid, stearic acid, linoleic acid, linolenic acid, dicaprate, tricaprate, monoolein (1-monooleoyl-rac-glycerol), dilaurin, caprylic acid, arachidonic acid, glycerol 1-monocaprate, 1-dodecylazacycloheptan-2-one, acylcarnitines, acylcholines, C1-20 alkyl esters thereof (e.g., methyl, isopropyl and t-butyl), and mono- and di-glycerides thereof (i.e., oleate, laurate, caprate, myristate, palmitate, stearate, linoleate, etc.) (see e.g., Touitou, E., et al. Enhancement in Drug Delivery, CRC Press, Danvers, MA, 2006; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, p.92; Muranishi, Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1990, 7, 1-33; El Hariri et al., J. Pharm. Pharmacol., 1992, 44, 651-654).
The physiological role of bile includes the facilitation of dispersion and absorption of lipids and fat-soluble vitamins (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Brunton, Chapter 38 in: Goodman & Gilman's The
Pharmacological Basis of Therapeutics, 9th Ed., Hardman et al. Eds., McGraw-Hill, New York, 1996, pp.934-935). Various natural bile salts, and their synthetic derivatives, act as penetration enhancers. Thus the term "bile salts" includes any of the naturally occurring components of bile as well as any of their synthetic derivatives. Suitable bile salts include, for example, cholic acid (or its pharmaceutically acceptable sodium salt, sodium cholate), dehydrocholic acid (sodium dehydrocholate), deoxycholic acid (sodium deoxycholate), glucholic acid (sodium glucholate), glycholic acid (sodium
glycocholate), glycodeoxycholic acid (sodium glycodeoxycholate), taurocholic acid (sodium
taurocholate), taurodeoxycholic acid (sodium taurodeoxycholate), chenodeoxycholic acid (sodium chenodeoxycholate), ursodeoxycholic acid (UDCA), sodium tauro-24,25-dihydro-fusidate (STDHF), sodium glycodihydrofusidate and polyoxyethylene-9-lauryl ether (POE) (see e.g., Malmsten, M. Surfactants and polymers in drug delivery, Informa Health Care, New York, NY, 2002; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, page 92; Swinyard, Chapter 39 In: Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences, 18th Ed., Gennaro, ed., Mack Publishing Co., Easton, Pa., 1990, pages 782-783; Muranishi, Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1990, 7, 1- 33; Yamamoto et al., J. Pharm. Exp. Ther., 1992, 263, 25; Yamashita et al., J. Pharm. Sci., 1990, 79, 579-583).
Chelating agents, as used in connection with the present invention, can be defined as compounds that remove metallic ions from solution by forming complexes therewith, with the result that absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the mucosa is enhanced. With regards to their use as penetration enhancers in the present invention, chelating agents have the added advantage of also serving as DNase inhibitors, as most characterized DNA nucleases require a divalent metal ion for catalysis and are thus inhibited by chelating agents (Jarrett, J. Chromatogr., 1993, 618, 315-339). Suitable chelating agents include but are not limited to disodium ethylenediaminetetraacetate (EDTA), citric acid, salicylates (e.g., sodium salicylate, 5-methoxysalicylate and homovanilate), N- acyl derivatives of collagen, laureth-9 and N-amino acyl derivatives of beta-diketones (enamines)(see e.g., Katdare, A. et al., Excipient development for pharmaceutical, biotechnology, and drug delivery, CRC Press, Danvers, MA, 2006; Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, page 92; Muranishi, Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1990, 7, 1-33; Buur et al., J. Control Rel., 1990, 14, 43-51).
As used herein, non-chelating non-surfactant penetration enhancing compounds can be defined as compounds that demonstrate insignificant activity as chelating agents or as surfactants but that nonetheless enhance absorption of antisense polynucleotide agents through the alimentary mucosa (see e.g., Muranishi, Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1990, 7, 1-33). This class of penetration enhancers includes, for example, unsaturated cyclic ureas, 1-alkyl- and 1- alkenylazacyclo-alkanone derivatives (Lee et al., Critical Reviews in Therapeutic Drug Carrier Systems, 1991, page 92); and non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agents such as diclofenac sodium, indomethacin and phenylbutazone (Yamashita et al., J. Pharm. Pharmacol., 1987, 39, 621-626).
Agents that enhance uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents at the cellular level can also be added to the pharmaceutical and other compositions of the present invention. For example, cationic lipids, such as lipofectin (Junichi et al, U.S. Pat. No.5,705,188), cationic glycerol derivatives, and polycationic molecules, such as polylysine (Lollo et al., PCT Application WO 97/30731), are also known to enhance the cellular uptake of antisense polynucleotide agents. Examples of commercially available transfection reagents include, for example Lipofectamine™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Lipofectamine 2000™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), 293fectin™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA),
Cellfectin™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), DMRIE-C™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), FreeStyle™ MAX (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Lipofectamine™ 2000 CD (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Lipofectamine™
(Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), RNAiMAX (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Oligofectamine™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), Optifect™ (Invitrogen; Carlsbad, CA), X-tremeGENE Q2 Transfection Reagent (Roche; Grenzacherstrasse, Switzerland), DOTAP Liposomal Transfection Reagent
(Grenzacherstrasse, Switzerland), DOSPER Liposomal Transfection Reagent (Grenzacherstrasse, Switzerland), or Fugene (Grenzacherstrasse, Switzerland), Transfectam® Reagent (Promega;
Madison, WI), TransFast™ Transfection Reagent (Promega; Madison, WI), Tfx™-20 Reagent (Promega; Madison, WI), Tfx™-50 Reagent (Promega; Madison, WI), DreamFect™ (OZ
Biosciences; Marseille, France), EcoTransfect (OZ Biosciences; Marseille, France), TransPassª D1 Transfection Reagent (New England Biolabs; Ipswich, MA, USA), LyoVec™/LipoGen™
(Invitrogen; San Diego, CA, USA), PerFectin Transfection Reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), NeuroPORTER Transfection Reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), GenePORTER Transfection reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), GenePORTER 2 Transfection reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), Cytofectin Transfection Reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), BaculoPORTER Transfection Reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA), TroganPORTER™ transfection Reagent (Genlantis; San Diego, CA, USA ), RiboFect (Bioline; Taunton, MA, USA), PlasFect (Bioline; Taunton, MA, USA), UniFECTOR (B-Bridge International; Mountain View, CA, USA), SureFECTOR (B-Bridge International; Mountain View, CA, USA), or HiFect™ (B-Bridge International, Mountain View, CA, USA), among others.
Other agents can be utilized to enhance the penetration of the administered nucleic acids, including glycols such as ethylene glycol and propylene glycol, pyrrols such as 2-pyrrol, azones, and terpenes such as limonene and menthone.
v. Carriers
Certain compositions of the present invention also incorporate carrier compounds in the formulation. As used herein,“carrier compound” or“carrier” can refer to a nucleic acid, or analog thereof, which is inert (i.e., does not possess biological activity per se) but is recognized as a nucleic acid by in vivo processes that reduce the bioavailability of a nucleic acid having biological activity by, for example, degrading the biologically active nucleic acid or promoting its removal from circulation. The coadministration of a nucleic acid and a carrier compound, typically with an excess of the latter substance, can result in a substantial reduction of the amount of nucleic acid recovered in the liver, kidney or other extracirculatory reservoirs, presumably due to competition between the carrier compound and the nucleic acid for a common receptor. For example, the recovery of a partially phosphorothioated antisense polynucleotide agent in hepatic tissue can be reduced when it is coadministered with polyinosinic acid, dextran sulfate, polycytidic acid or 4-acetamido- 4'isothiocyano-stilbene-2,2'-disulfonic acid (Miyao et al., Antisense polynucleotide agent Res. Dev., 1995, 5, 115-121; Takakura et al., Antisense polynucleotide agent & Nucl. Acid Drug Dev., 1996, 6, 177-183.
vi. Excipients
In contrast to a carrier compound, a“pharmaceutical carrier” or“excipient” is a
pharmaceutically acceptable solvent, suspending agent or any other pharmacologically inert vehicle
for delivering one or more nucleic acids to an animal. The excipient can be liquid or solid and is selected, with the planned manner of administration in mind, so as to provide for the desired bulk, consistency, etc., when combined with a nucleic acid and the other components of a given pharmaceutical composition. Typical pharmaceutical carriers include, but are not limited to, binding agents (e.g., pregelatinized maize starch, polyvinylpyrrolidone or hydroxypropyl methylcellulose, etc.); fillers (e.g., lactose and other sugars, microcrystalline cellulose, pectin, gelatin, calcium sulfate, ethyl cellulose, polyacrylates or calcium hydrogen phosphate, etc.); lubricants (e.g., magnesium stearate, talc, silica, colloidal silicon dioxide, stearic acid, metallic stearates, hydrogenated vegetable oils, corn starch, polyethylene glycols, sodium benzoate, sodium acetate, etc.); disintegrants (e.g., starch, sodium starch glycolate, etc.); and wetting agents (e.g., sodium lauryl sulphate, etc).
Pharmaceutically acceptable organic or inorganic excipients suitable for non-parenteral administration which do not deleteriously react with nucleic acids can also be used to formulate the compositions of the present invention. Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable carriers include, but are not limited to, water, salt solutions, alcohols, polyethylene glycols, gelatin, lactose, amylose, magnesium stearate, talc, silicic acid, viscous paraffin, hydroxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone and the like.
Formulations for topical administration of nucleic acids can include sterile and non-sterile aqueous solutions, non-aqueous solutions in common solvents such as alcohols, or solutions of the nucleic acids in liquid or solid oil bases. The solutions can also contain buffers, diluents and other suitable additives. Pharmaceutically acceptable organic or inorganic excipients suitable for non- parenteral administration which do not deleteriously react with nucleic acids can be used.
Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable excipients include, but are not limited to, water, salt solutions, alcohol, polyethylene glycols, gelatin, lactose, amylose, magnesium stearate, talc, silicic acid, viscous paraffin, hydroxymethylcellulose, polyvinylpyrrolidone and the like.
vii. Other Components
The compositions of the present invention can additionally contain other adjunct components conventionally found in pharmaceutical compositions, at their art-established usage levels. Thus, for example, the compositions can contain additional, compatible, pharmaceutically-active materials such as, for example, antipruritics, astringents, local anesthetics or anti-inflammatory agents, or can contain additional materials useful in physically formulating various dosage forms of the compositions of the present invention, such as dyes, flavoring agents, preservatives, antioxidants, opacifiers, thickening agents and stabilizers. However, such materials, when added, should not unduly interfere with the biological activities of the components of the compositions of the present invention. The formulations can be sterilized and, if desired, mixed with auxiliary agents, e.g., lubricants, preservatives, stabilizers, wetting agents, emulsifiers, salts for influencing osmotic pressure, buffers, colorings, flavorings or aromatic substances and the like which do not deleteriously interact with the nucleic acid(s) of the formulation.
Aqueous suspensions can contain substances which increase the viscosity of the suspension including, for example, sodium carboxymethylcellulose, sorbitol or dextran. The suspension can also contain stabilizers.
In some embodiments, pharmaceutical compositions featured in the invention include (a) one or more antisense polynucleotide agents and (b) one or more agents which function by a non-antisense inhibition mechanism and which are useful in treating a hemolytic disorder. Examples of such agents include, but are not lmited to an anti-inflammatory agent, anti-steatosis agent, anti-viral, or anti- fibrosis agent. In addition, other substances commonly used to protect the liver, such as silymarin, can also be used in conjunction with the antisense polynucleotide agents described herein. Other agents useful for treating liver diseases include telbivudine, entecavir, and protease inhibitors such as telaprevir and other disclosed, for example, in Tung et al., U.S. Application Publication Nos.
2005/0148548, 2004/0167116, and 2003/0144217; and in Hale et al., U.S. Application Publication No.2004/0127488.
Toxicity and therapeutic efficacy of such compounds can be determined by standard pharmaceutical procedures in cell cultures or experimental animals, e.g., for determining the LD50 (the dose lethal to 50% of the population) and the ED50 (the dose therapeutically effective in 50% of the population). The dose ratio between toxic and therapeutic effects is the therapeutic index and it can be expressed as the ratio LD50/ED50. Compounds that exhibit high therapeutic indices are preferred.
The data obtained from cell culture assays and animal studies can be used in formulating a range of dosage for use in humans. The dosage of compositions featured herein in the invention lies generally within a range of circulating concentrations that include the ED50 with little or no toxicity. The dosage can vary within this range depending upon the dosage form employed and the route of administration utilized. For any compound used in the methods featured in the invention, the therapeutically effective dose can be estimated initially from cell culture assays. A dose can be formulated in animal models to achieve a circulating plasma concentration range of the compound or, when appropriate, of the polypeptide product of a target sequence (e.g., achieving a decreased concentration of the polypeptide) that includes the IC50 (i.e., the concentration of the test compound which achieves a half-maximal inhibition of symptoms) as determined in cell culture. Such information can be used to more accurately determine useful doses in humans. Levels in plasma can be measured, for example, by high performance liquid chromatography.
In addition to their administration, as discussed above, the antisense polynucleotide agents featured in the invention can be administered in combination with other known agents effective in treatment of pathological processes mediated by IGFALS expression. In any event, the administering physician can adjust the amount and timing of antisense polynucleotide agent administration on the basis of results observed using standard measures of efficacy known in the art or described herein. VII. Methods For Inhibiting IGFALS Expression
The present invention provides methods of inhibiting expression of IGFALS in a cell. The methods include contacting a cell with a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense
polynucleotide agent, in an amount effective to inhibit expression of the IGFALS in the cell, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALS in the cell.
Contacting of a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent may be done in vitro or in vivo. Contacting a cell in vivo with the antisense polynucleotide agent includes contacting a cell or group of cells within a subject, e.g., a human subject, with the antisense polynucleotide agent. Combinations of in vitro and in vivo methods of contacting are also possible. Contacting may be direct or indirect, as discussed above. Furthermore, contacting a cell may be accomplished via a targeting ligand, including any ligand described herein or known in the art. In preferred embodiments, the targeting ligand is a carbohydrate moiety, e.g., a GalNAc3 ligand, or any other ligand that directs the antisense polynucleotide agent to a site of interest, e.g., the liver of a subject.
The term“inhibiting,” as used herein, is used interchangeably with“reducing,”“silencing,” “downregulating” and other similar terms, and includes any level of inhibition.
The phrase“inhibiting expression of an IGFALS gene” is intended to refer to inhibition of expression of any IGFALS gene (such as, e.g., a mouse IGFALS gene, a rat IGFALS gene, a monkey IGFALS gene, or a human IGFALS gene) as well as variants or mutants of an IGFALS gene. Thus, the IGFALS gene may be a wild-type IGFALS gene, a mutant IGFALS gene, or a transgenic IGFALS gene in the context of a genetically manipulated cell, group of cells, or organism.
“Inhibiting expression of an IGFALS gene” includes any level of inhibition of an IGFALS gene, e.g., at least partial suppression of the expression of an IGFALS gene. The expression of the IGFALS may be assessed based on the level, or the change in the level, of any variable associated with IGFALS gene expression, e.g., IGFALS mRNA level, IGFALS protein level, or for example, signaling through the IGF pathway may also be measured to assess IGFALS expression. This level may be assessed in an individual cell or in a group of cells, including, for example, a sample derived from a subject.
Inhibition may be assessed by a decrease in an absolute or relative level of one or more variables that are associated with IGFALS expression compared with a control level. The control level may be any type of control level that is utilized in the art, e.g., a pre-dose baseline level, or a level determined from a similar subject, cell, or sample that is untreated or treated with a control (such as, e.g., buffer only control or inactive agent control).
In some embodiments of the methods of the invention, expression of an IGFALS gene is inhibited by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, at least 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay method. In preferred embodiments, the level of expression is detected using the in vitro method provided in the Examples.
Inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS gene may be manifested by a reduction of the amount of mRNA expressed by a first cell or group of cells (such cells may be present, for example, in a sample derived from a subject) in which an IGFALS gene is transcribed and which has or have been treated (e.g., by contacting the cell or cells with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, or by administering an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention to a subject in which the cells are or were present) such that the expression of an IGFALS gene is inhibited, as compared to
a second cell or group of cells substantially identical to the first cell or group of cells but which has not or have not been so treated (control cell(s)). In preferred embodiments, the inhibition is assessed by expressing the level of mRNA in treated cells as a percentage of the level of mRNA in control cells, using the following formula:
(mRNA in control cells) - (mRNA in treated cells)
•100 %
(mRNAin control cells)
Alternatively, inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS gene may be assessed in terms of a reduction of a parameter that is functionally linked to IGFALS gene expression, e.g., IGFALS protein expression, signaling through the IGF pathway. IGFALS gene silencing may be determined in any cell expressing IGFALS, either constitutively or by genetic engineering, and by any assay known in the art. The liver is the predominant site of IGFALS expression.
Inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS protein may be manifested by a reduction in the level of the IGFALS protein that is expressed by a cell or group of cells (e.g., the level of protein expressed in a sample derived from a subject). As explained above for the assessment of mRNA suppression, the inhibiton of protein expression levels in a treated cell or group of cells may similarly be expressed as a percentage of the level of protein in a control cell or group of cells.
A control cell or group of cells that may be used to assess the inhibition of the expression of an IGFALS gene includes a cell or group of cells that has not yet been contacted with an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention. For example, the control cell or group of cells may be derived from an individual subject (e.g., a human or animal subject) prior to treatment of the subject with an antisense polynucleotide agent.
The level of IGFALS mRNA that is expressed by a cell or group of cells may be determined using any method known in the art for assessing mRNA expression. In one embodiment, the level of expression of IGFALS in a sample is determined by detecting a transcribed polynucleotide, or portion thereof, e.g., mRNA of the IGFALS gene. RNA may be extracted from cells using RNA extraction techniques including, for example, using acid phenol/guanidine isothiocyanate extraction (RNAzol B; Biogenesis), RNeasy RNA preparation kits (Qiagen) or PAXgene (PreAnalytix, Switzerland). Typical assay formats utilizing ribonucleic acid hybridization include nuclear run-on assays, RT-PCR, RNase protection assays (Melton et al., Nuc. Acids Res.12:7035), northern blotting, in situ hybridization, and microarray analysis.
In one embodiment, the level of expression of IGFALS is determined using a nucleic acid probe. The term "probe", as used herein, refers to any molecule that is capable of selectively binding to a specific IGFALS. Probes can be synthesized by one of skill in the art, or derived from appropriate biological preparations. Probes may be specifically designed to be labeled. Examples of molecules that can be utilized as probes include, but are not limited to, RNA, DNA, proteins, antibodies, and organic molecules.
Isolated mRNA can be used in hybridization or amplification assays that include, but are not limited to, Southern or northern analyses, polymerase chain reaction (PCR) analyses and probe arrays. One method for the determination of mRNA levels involves contacting the isolated mRNA with a
nucleic acid molecule (probe) that can hybridize to IGFALS mRNA. In one embodiment, the mRNA is immobilized on a solid surface and contacted with a probe, for example by running the isolated mRNA on an agarose gel and transferring the mRNA from the gel to a membrane, such as nitrocellulose. In an alternative embodiment, the probe(s) are immobilized on a solid surface and the mRNA is contacted with the probe(s), for example, in an Affymetrix® gene chip array. A skilled artisan can readily adapt known mRNA detection methods for use in determining the level of IGFALS mRNA.
An alternative method for determining the level of expression of IGFALS in a sample involves the process of nucleic acid amplification or reverse transcriptase (to prepare cDNA) of for example mRNA in the sample, e.g., by RT-PCR (the experimental embodiment set forth in Mullis, 1987, U.S. Pat. No.4,683,202), ligase chain reaction (Barany (1991) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 88:189-193), self sustained sequence replication (Guatelli et al. (1990) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 87:1874-1878), transcriptional amplification system (Kwoh et al. (1989) Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 86:1173-1177), Q-Beta Replicase (Lizardi et al. (1988) Bio/Technology 6:1197), rolling circle replication (Lizardi et al., U.S. Pat. No.5,854,033) or any other nucleic acid amplification method, followed by the detection of the amplified molecules using techniques well known to those of skill in the art. These detection schemes are especially useful for the detection of nucleic acid molecules if such molecules are present in very low numbers. In particular aspects of the invention, the level of expression of IGFALS is determined by quantitative fluorogenic RT-PCR (i.e., the TaqManTM System).
The expression levels of IGFALS mRNA may be monitored using a membrane blot (such as used in hybridization analysis such as northern, Southern, dot, and the like), or microwells, sample tubes, gels, beads or fibers (or any solid support comprising bound nucleic acids). See U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,770,722, 5,874,219, 5,744,305, 5,677,195 and 5,445,934, which are incorporated herein by reference. The determination of IGFALS expression level may also comprise using nucleic acid probes in solution.
In preferred embodiments, the level of mRNA expression is assessed using branched DNA (bDNA) assays or real time PCR (qPCR). The use of a qPCR methods is described and exemplified in the Examples presented herein.
The level of IGFALS protein expression may be determined using any method known in the art for the measurement of protein levels. Such methods include, for example, electrophoresis, capillary electrophoresis, high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), thin layer
chromatography (TLC), hyperdiffusion chromatography, fluid or gel precipitin reactions, absorption spectroscopy, a colorimetric assays, spectrophotometric assays, flow cytometry, immunodiffusion (single or double), immunoelectrophoresis, western blotting, radioimmunoassay (RIA), enzyme- linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), immunofluorescent assays, electrochemiluminescence assays, and the like.
The term“sample” as used herein refers to a collection of similar fluids, cells, or tissues isolated from a subject, as well as fluids, cells, or tissues present within a subject. Examples of
biological fluids include blood, serum and serosal fluids, plasma, lymph, urine, cerebrospinal fluid, saliva, ocular fluids, and the like. Tissue samples may include samples from tissues, organs or localized regions. For example, samples may be derived from particular organs, parts of organs, or fluids or cells within those organs. In certain embodiments, samples may be derived from the liver (e.g., whole liver or certain segments of liver or certain types of cells in the liver, such as, e.g., hepatocytes). In preferred embodiments, a“sample derived from a subject” refers to blood or plasma drawn from the subject. In further embodiments, a“sample derived from a subject” refers to liver tissue derived from the subject.
In some embodiments of the methods of the invention, the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered to a subject such that the antisense polynucleotide agent is delivered to a specific site within the subject. The inhibition of expression of IGFALS may be assessed using measurements of the level or change in the level of IGFALS mRNA or IGFALS protein in a sample derived from fluid or tissue from the specific site within the subject. In preferred embodiments, the site is the liver. The site may also be a subsection or subgroup of cells from any one of the aforementioned sites. The site may also include cells that express a particular type of receptor.
The phrase“contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent,” as used herein, includes contacting a cell by any possible means. Contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent includes contacting a cell in vitro with the antisense polynucleotide agent or contacting a cell in vivo with the antisense polynucleotide agent. The contacting may be done directly or indirectly. Thus, for example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be put into physical contact with the cell by the individual performing the method, or alternatively, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be put into a situation that will permit or cause it to subsequently come into contact with the cell.
Contacting a cell in vitro may be done, for example, by incubating the cell with the antisense polynucleotide agent. Contacting a cell in vivo may be done, for example, by injecting the antisense polynucleotide agent into or near the tissue where the cell is located, or by injecting the antisense polynucleotide agent into another area, e.g., the bloodstream or the subcutaneous space, such that the agent will subsequently reach the tissue where the cell to be contacted is located. For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may contain or be coupled to a ligand, e.g., GalNAc3, that directs the antisense polynucleotide agent to a site of interest, e.g., the liver. Combinations of in vitro and in vivo methods of contacting are also possible. For example, a cell may also be contacted in vitro with an antisense polynucleotide agent and subsequently transplanted into a subject.
In one embodiment, contacting a cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent includes “introducing” or“delivering the antisense polynucleotide agent into the cell” by facilitating or effecting uptake or absorption into the cell. Absorption or uptake of an antisense polynucleotide agent can occur through unaided diffusive or active cellular processes, or by auxiliary agents or devices. Introducing an antisense polynucleotide agent into a cell may be in vitro or in vivo. For example, for in vivo introduction, antisense polynucleotide agent can be injected into a tissue site or administered systemically. In vivo delivery can also be done by a beta-glucan delivery system, such as those described in U.S. Patent Nos.5,032,401 and 5,607,677, and U.S. Publication No.
2005/0281781, the entire contents of which are hereby incorporated herein by reference. In vitro introduction into a cell includes methods known in the art such as electroporation and lipofection. Further approaches are described herein below or are known in the art. VIII. Methods for Treating or Preventing an IGFALS-Associated Disorder
The present invention also provides therapeutic and prophylactic methods which include administering to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer, a polynucleotide agent, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent, or pharmaceutical compositions comprising a polynucleotide agent of the invention, e.g., antisense polynucleotide agent.
In one aspect, the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer. The treatment methods (and uses) of the invention include administering to the subject, e.g., a human, a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, thereby treating the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
In another aspect, the present invention provides methods of treating a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer, which include administering to the subject, e.g., a human, a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, and an additional therapeutic agent for the treatment of cancer, acromegaly, gigantism, or other interventions such as radiation or surgery, thereby treating the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression.
In one aspect, the invention provides methods of preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS- associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer. The methods include administering to the subject a prophylactically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene, thereby preventing at least one symptom in the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression. For example, the invention provides methods for preventing acromegaly or cancer in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
"Therapeutically effective amount," as used herein, is intended to include the amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent, that, when administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, is sufficient to effect treatment of the disease (e.g., by diminishing, ameliorating or maintaining the existing disease or one or more symptoms of disease). The "therapeutically effective amount" may vary depending on the antisense polynucleotide agent, how the agent is administered,
the disease and its severity and the history, age, weight, family history, genetic makeup, the types of preceding or concomitant treatments, if any, and other individual characteristics of the subject to be treated.
“Prophylactically effective amount,” as used herein, is intended to include the amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent that, when administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associate disease but not yet (or currently) experiencing or displaying symptoms of the disease, or a subject at risk of developing or suffering a recurrence of an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly or cancer, is sufficient to prevent or ameliorate the disease or one or more symptoms of the disease. Ameliorating the disease includes slowing the course of the disease or reducing the severity of later- developing disease. The "prophylactically effective amount" may vary depending on the antisense polynucleotide agent is administered, the degree of risk of disease, and the history, age, weight, family history, genetic makeup, the types of preceding or concomitant treatments, if any, and other individual characteristics of the patient to be treated.
A "therapeutically effective amount" or“prophylactically effective amount” also includes an amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent that produces some desired local or systemic effect at a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to any treatment. Antisense polynucleotide agents employed in the methods of the present invention may be administered in a sufficient amount to produce a reasonable benefit/risk ratio applicable to such treatment.
In another aspect, the present invention provides uses of a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression.
In another aspect, the present invention provides uses of a therapeutically effective amount of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention and an additional therapeutic agent or intervention, e.g., radiation or surgery, for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression.
In yet another aspect, the present invention provides use of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene in the manufacture of a medicament for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as a subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
In another aspect, the present invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention targeting an IGFALS gene or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting an IGFALS gene in the manufacture of a medicament for use in combination with an additional therapeutic agent, for treating a subject, e.g., a subject that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, e.g., an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
In another aspect, the invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would
benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
In yet another aspect, the invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention, and an additional therapeutic agent, for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
In a further aspect, the present invention provides uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention in the manufacture of a medicament for preventing at least one symptom in a subject suffering from a disorder that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, such as a an IGFALS-associated disease, e.g., acromegaly, gigantism, or cancer.
In one embodiment, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS is administered to a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease such that IGFALS levels, e.g., in a cell, most commonly a liver cell, of the subject are reduced as compared to an appropriate control by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to a level below the level of detection of the assay method as compared to an appropriate control.
Additional therapeutic agents and interventions include the standard of care as well as other therapies that provide a benefit to the subject. Treatments for acromegaly and cancer are discussed below.
The methods of the invention comprising administration of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention and treatments including the standard of care, e.g., surgery or radiation, as well as other therapies which provide a benefit to the subject.
The additional therapeutic agents may be administered to the subject at the same time as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or at a different time.
Moreover, the additional therapeutic agent may be administered to the subject in the same formulation as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or in a different formulation as the antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS.
The methods and uses of the invention include administering a composition described herein such that expression of the target IGFALS gene is decreased, such as for at least about 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 12, 16, 18, 24, 28, 32, 36, 40, 44, 48, 52, 56, 60, 64, 68, 72, 76, or 80 hours. In one embodiment, expression of the target IGFALS gene is decreased for an extended duration, e.g., at least two, three, four, five, six, seven days or more, e.g., one week, two weeks, three weeks, or four weeks, or longer.
Administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent according to the methods and uses of the invention may result in a reduction of the severity, signs, symptoms, or markers of such diseases or disorders in a patient with an IGFALS-associated disease. By“reduction” in this context is meant a statistically significant decrease in such level as compared to an appropriate control. The reduction can be, for example, at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay used for detection. In certain embodiments, the reduction is the normalization of the level of a sign or symptom of a disease, a reduction in the difference between the subject level of a sign of the disease and the normal level of
the sign for the disease (e.g., upper level of normal, lower level of normal, average of upper and lower level of normal). For example, reduction can be understood as normalization of blood pressure, decreasing an elevated blood pressure or increasing a low blood pressure to reduce the difference from a normal reading.
Efficacy of treatment or prevention of disease can be assessed, for example by measuring disease progression, disease remission, symptom severity, reduction in pain, dose of a medication required to sustain a treatment effect, level of a disease marker or any other measurable parameter appropriate for a given disease being treated or targeted for prevention. It is well within the ability of one skilled in the art to monitor efficacy of treatment or prevention by measuring any one of such parameters, or any combination of parameters. For example, efficacy of treatment of acromegaly and cancer are discussed below. Comparisons of the later readings with the initial readings provide a physician an indication of whether the treatment is effective. It is well within the ability of one skilled in the art to monitor efficacy of treatment or prevention by measuring any one of such parameters, or any combination of parameters. In connection with the administration of an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS or pharmaceutical composition thereof, "effective against" an IGFALS- associated disease indicates that administration in a clinically appropriate manner results in a beneficial effect for at least a statistically significant fraction of patients, such as improvement of symptoms, a cure, a reduction in disease, extension of life, or other effect generally recognized as positive by medical doctors familiar with treating a IGFALS -associated disease and the related causes.
A treatment or preventive effect is evident when there is a statistically significant improvement in one or more parameters of disease status, or by a failure to worsen or to develop symptoms where they would otherwise be anticipated. As an example, a favorable change of at least 10% in a measurable parameter of disease, and preferably at least 20%, 30%, 40%, 50% or more can be indicative of effective treatment. Efficacy for a given antisense polynucleotide agent drug or formulation of that drug can also be judged using an experimental animal model for the given disease as known in the art. When using an experimental animal model, efficacy of treatment is evidenced when a statistically significant reduction in a marker or symptom is observed.
Alternatively, the efficacy can be measured by a reduction in the severity of disease as determined by one skilled in the art of diagnosis based on a clinically accepted criteria as discussed below. Any positive change resulting in e.g., lessening of severity of disease measured using the appropriate scale, represents adequate treatment using an antisense polynucleotide agent or antisense polynucleotide agent formulation as described herein.
Subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.01 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg, 0.1 mg/kg, 0.15 mg/kg, 0.2 mg/kg, 0.25 mg/kg, 0.3 mg/kg, 0.35 mg/kg, 0.4 mg/kg, 0.45 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg, 0.55 mg/kg, 0.6 mg/kg, 0.65 mg/kg, 0.7 mg/kg, 0.75 mg/kg, 0.8 mg/kg, 0.85 mg/kg, 0.9 mg/kg, 0.95 mg/kg, 1.0 mg/kg, 1.1 mg/kg, 1.2 mg/kg, 1.3 mg/kg, 1.4mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg, 1.6 mg/kg, 1.7 mg/kg, 1.8 mg/kg, 1.9 mg/kg, 2.0 mg/kg, 2.1mg/kg, 2.2mg/kg, 2.3 mg/kg, 2.4 mg/kg, 2.5 mg/kg, 2.6 mg/kg, 2.7 mg/kg, 2.8 mg/kg, 2.9 mg/kg, 3.0 mg/kg, 3.1 mg/kg,
3.2 mg/kg, 3.3 mg/kg, 3.4 mg/kg, 3.5 mg/kg, 3.6 mg/kg, 3.7 mg/kg, 3.8 mg/kg, 3.9 mg/kg, 4.0 mg/kg, 4.1 mg/kg, 4.2 mg/kg, 4.3 mg/kg, 4.4 mg/kg, 4.5 mg/kg, 4.6 mg/kg, 4.7 mg/kg, 4.8 mg/kg, 4.9 mg/kg, 5.0 mg/kg, 5.1 mg/kg, 5.2 mg/kg, 5.3 mg/kg, 5.4 mg/kg, 5.5 mg/kg, 5.6 mg/kg, 5.7 mg/kg, 5.8 mg/kg, 5.9 mg/kg, 6.0 mg/kg, 6.1 mg/kg, 6.2 mg/kg, 6.3 mg/kg, 6.4 mg/kg, 6.5 mg/kg, 6.6 mg/kg, 6.7 mg/kg, 6.8 mg/kg, 6.9 mg/kg, 7.0 mg/kg, 7.1 mg/kg, 7.2 mg/kg, 7.3 mg/kg, 7.4 mg/kg, 7.5 mg/kg, 7.6 mg/kg, 7.7 mg/kg, 7.8 mg/kg, 7.9 mg/kg, 8.0 mg/kg, 8.1 mg/kg, 8.2 mg/kg, 8.3 mg/kg, 8.4 mg/kg, 8.5 mg/kg, 8.6 mg/kg, 8.7 mg/kg, 8.8 mg/kg, 8.9 mg/kg, 9.0 mg/kg, 9.1 mg/kg, 9.2 mg/kg, 9.3 mg/kg, 9.4 mg/kg, 9.5 mg/kg, 9.6 mg/kg, 9.7 mg/kg, 9.8 mg/kg, 9.9 mg/kg, 9.0 mg/kg, 10 mg/kg, 15 mg/kg, 20 mg/kg, 25 mg/kg, 30 mg/kg, 35 mg/kg, 40 mg/kg, 45 mg/kg, or 50 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
In certain embodiments, for example, when a composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and a lipid, subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.01 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg,
0.01 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.05 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.1 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.1 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.2 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.2 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.3 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.3 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.4 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.4 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 0.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 1 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 1 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 1.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 2 mg/kg to 2.5 mg/kg, 2 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 3 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 3 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 3.5 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 4 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 4.5 mg/kg to 5 mg/kg, 4 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 4.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 5.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 6 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 6.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 7 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 7.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 8 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 8.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, 9 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg, or 9.5 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
For example, the antisense polynucleotide agent may be administered at a dose of about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, or about 10 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
In other embodiments, for example, when a composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and an N-acetylgalactosamine, subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as a dose of about 0.1 to 50 mg/kg, 0.25 to 50 mg/kg, 0.5 to 50 mg/kg, 0.75 to 50 mg/kg, 1 to 50 mg/mg, 1.5 to 50 mg/kb, 2 to 50 mg/kg, 2.5 to 50 mg/kg, 3 to 50 mg/kg, 3.5 to 50 mg/kg, 4 to 50 mg/kg, 4.5 to 50 mg/kg, 5 to 50 mg/kg, 7.5 to 50 mg/kg, 10 to 50 mg/kg, 15 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 20 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 25 to 50 mg/kg, 30 to 50 mg/kg, 35 to 50 mg/kg, 40 to 50 mg/kg, 45 to 50 mg/kg, 0.1 to 45 mg/kg, 0.25 to 45 mg/kg, 0.5 to 45 mg/kg, 0.75 to 45 mg/kg, 1 to 45 mg/mg, 1.5 to 45 mg/kb, 2 to 45 mg/kg, 2.5 to 45 mg/kg, 3 to 45 mg/kg, 3.5 to 45 mg/kg, 4 to 45 mg/kg, 4.5 to 45 mg/kg, 5 to 45
mg/kg, 7.5 to 45 mg/kg, 10 to 45 mg/kg, 15 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 20 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 25 to 45 mg/kg, 30 to 45 mg/kg, 35 to 45 mg/kg, 40 to 45 mg/kg, 0.1 to 40 mg/kg, 0.25 to 40 mg/kg, 0.5 to 40 mg/kg, 0.75 to 40 mg/kg, 1 to 40 mg/mg, 1.5 to 40 mg/kb, 2 to 40 mg/kg, 2.5 to 40 mg/kg, 3 to 40 mg/kg, 3.5 to 40 mg/kg, 4 to 40 mg/kg, 4.5 to 40 mg/kg, 5 to 40 mg/kg, 7.5 to 40 mg/kg, 10 to 40 mg/kg, 15 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 20 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 25 to 40 mg/kg, 30 to 40 mg/kg, 35 to 40 mg/kg, 0.1 to 30 mg/kg, 0.25 to 30 mg/kg, 0.5 to 30 mg/kg, 0.75 to 30 mg/kg, 1 to 30 mg/mg, 1.5 to 30 mg/kb, 2 to 30 mg/kg, 2.5 to 30 mg/kg, 3 to 30 mg/kg, 3.5 to 30 mg/kg, 4 to 30 mg/kg, 4.5 to 30 mg/kg, 5 to 30 mg/kg, 7.5 to 30 mg/kg, 10 to 30 mg/kg, 15 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 20 to 30 mg/kg, 25 to 30 mg/kg, 0.1 to 20 mg/kg, 0.25 to 20 mg/kg, 0.5 to 20 mg/kg, 0.75 to 20 mg/kg, 1 to 20 mg/mg, 1.5 to 20 mg/kb, 2 to 20 mg/kg, 2.5 to 20 mg/kg, 3 to 20 mg/kg, 3.5 to 20 mg/kg, 4 to 20 mg/kg, 4.5 to 20 mg/kg, 5 to 20 mg/kg, 7.5 to 20 mg/kg, 10 to 20 mg/kg, or 15 to 20 mg/kg. In one embodiment, when a composition of the invention comprises a antisense polynucleotide agent as described herein and an N-acetylgalactosamine, subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of 10 to 30 mg/kg of antisense polynucleotide agent. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
For example, subjects can be administered a therapeutic amount of antisense polynucleotide agent, such as about 0.1, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, 0.5, 0.6, 0.7, 0.8, 0.9, 1, 1.1, 1.2, 1.3, 1.4, 1.5, 1.6, 1.7, 1.8, 1.9, 2, 2.1, 2.2, 2.3, 2.4, 2.5, 2.6, 2.7, 2.8, 2.9, 3, 3.1, 3.2, 3.3, 3.4, 3.5, 3.6, 3.7, 3.8, 3.9, 4, 4.1, 4.2, 4.3, 4.4, 4.5, 4.6, 4.7, 4.8, 4.9, 5, 5.1, 5.2, 5.3, 5.4, 5.5, 5.6, 5.7, 5.8, 5.9, 6, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7, 7.1, 7.2, 7.3, 7.4, 7.5, 7.6, 7.7, 7.8, 7.9, 8, 8.1, 8.2, 8.3, 8.4, 8.5, 8.6, 8.7, 8.8, 8.9, 9, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4, 9.5, 9.6, 9.7, 9.8, 9.9, 10, 10.5, 11, 11.5, 12, 12.5, 13, 13.5, 14, 14.5, 15, 15.5, 16, 16.5, 17, 17.5, 18, 18.5, 19, 19.5, 20, 20.5, 21, 21.5, 22, 22.5, 23, 23.5, 24, 24.5, 25, 25.5, 26, 26.5, 27, 27.5, 28, 28.5, 29, 29.5, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49, or 50 mg/kg. Values and ranges intermediate to the recited values are also intended to be part of this invention.
The antisense polynucleotide agent can be administered by intravenous infusion over a period of time, such as over a 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, or a 25 minute period. The administration may be repeated, for example, on a regular basis, such as weekly, biweekly (i.e., every two weeks) for one month, two months, three months, four months or longer. After an initial treatment regimen, the treatments can be administered on a less frequent basis. For example, after administration weekly or biweekly for three months, administration can be repeated once per month, for six months or a year or longer.
Administration of the antisense polynucleotide agent can reduce IGFALS levels, e.g., in a cell, tissue, blood, urine or other compartment of the patient by at least 20%, 25%, 30%, 35%, 40%, 45%, 50%, 55%, 60%, 65%, 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, or to below the level of detection of the assay method used.
Before administration of a full dose of the antisense polynucleotide agent, patients can be administered a smaller dose, such as a 5% infusion, and monitored for adverse effects, such as an
allergic reaction. In another example, the patient can be monitored for unwanted immunostimulatory effects, such as increased cytokine (e.g., TNF-alpha or INF-alpha) levels.
Owing to the inhibitory effects on IGFALS expression, a composition according to the invention or a pharmaceutical composition prepared therefrom can enhance the quality of life.
An antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be administered in“naked” form, or as a“free antisense polynucleotide agent.” A naked antisense polynucleotide agent is administered in the absence of a pharmaceutical composition. The naked antisense polynucleotide agent may be in a suitable buffer solution. The buffer solution may comprise acetate, citrate, prolamine, carbonate, or phosphate, or any combination thereof. In one embodiment, the buffer solution is phosphate buffered saline (PBS). The pH and osmolarity of the buffer solution containing the antisense polynucleotide agent can be adjusted such that it is suitable for administering to a subject.
Alternatively, an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention may be administered as a pharmaceutical composition, such as an antisense polynucleotide agent liposomal formulation.
Subjects that would benefit from a reduction or inhibition of IGFALS gene expression are those having an IGFALS-associated disease or disorder as described herein. In one embodiment, a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has acromegaly. In another embodiment, a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has giantism. In another embodiment, a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease has cancer. In yet another embodiment, a subject having an IGFALS- associated disease has metastatic cancer.
The invention further provides methods and uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent or a pharmaceutical composition thereof (including methods and uses of an antisense polynucleotide agent or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent and compositions and methods known in the art for treating a subject that would benefit from reduction or inhibition of IGFALS expression, e.g., a subject having an IGFALS-associated disease, in combination with other pharmaceuticals or other therapeutic methods, e.g., with known pharmaceuticals or known therapeutic methods, such as, for example, those which are currently employed for treating these disorders. For example, in certain embodiments, an antisense polynucleotide agent targeting IGFALS is
administered in combination with, e.g., an agent useful in treating an IGFALS-associated disease as described elsewhere herein.
The antisense polynucleotide agent and an additional therapeutic agent or treatment may be administered at the same time or in the same combination, e.g., parenterally, or the additional therapeutic agent can be administered as part of a separate composition or at separate times or by another method known in the art or described herein.
The present invention also provides methods of using an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition containing an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention to reduce or inhibit IGFALS expression in a cell. In other aspects, the present invention provides an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition comprising an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention for use in reducing or inhibiting IGFALS expression in a cell. In yet other aspects, use of an antisense polynucleotide agent of the invention or a composition comprising an antisense
polynucleotide agent of the invention for the manufactuire of a medicament for reducing or inhibiting IGFALS expression in a cell are provided.
The methods and uses include contacting the cell with an antisense polynucleotide agent, e.g., a antisense polynucleotide agent, of the invention and maintaining the cell for a time sufficient to obtain antisense inhibition of an IGFALS gene, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALS gene in the cell.
Reduction in gene expression can be assessed by any methods known in the art and as provided herein. IX. Diagnostic Criteria and Treatment for Acromegaly
Diagnostic criteria for acromegaly are set forth in the American Association of Clinical Endocrinologists Medical Guidelines for Clinical Practice for the Diagnosis and Treatment of Acromegaly– 2011 Update (Katznelson et al., Endocr. Pract.17(Suppl. 4), incorporated herein by reference. Further details and citations can be found therein.
Acromegaly is a clinical syndrome that, depending on its stage of progression, may not manifest with clear diagnostic features. Diagnosis should be considered in patients with 2 or more of the following comorbidities: new-onset diabetes, diffuse arthralgias, new-onset or difficult-to-control hypertension, cardiac disease including biventricular hypertrophy and dia- stolic or systolic dysfunction, fatigue, headaches, carpal tunnel syndrome, sleep apnea syndrome, diaphoresis, loss of vision, colon polyps, and progressive jaw malocclusion. A serum IGF-I level, if accompanied by a large number of results from age- and sex-matched normal subjects, is a good tool to assess integrated GH secretion and is excellent for diagnosis, monitoring, and especially screening. A random IGF-I value (a marker of integrated GH secretion) should be measured for diagnosis and for monitoring after a therapeutic intervention. Serum GH assays are not standardized and should not be used nterchangeably. The nadir GH suppression after administration of glucose has been considered the“gold standard” test for acromegaly, however, a conflict exists regarding the threshold for diagnosis. The panel recommends that GH measurements be performed at baseline, then every 30 minutes for a total of 120 minutes after administration of glucose. The inability to suppress serum GH to less than 1 ng/mL after glucose administration is typically considered the diagnostic criterion for acromegaly, however, in a consensus guideline in 2000, the diagnosis of acromegaly was excluded if the patient had a random GH measurement less than 0.4 ng/mL and a normal IGF-1 value. Although a nadir GH concentration of less than 1 ng/mL after administration of glucose is the standard
recommendation for a normal response, the 2011 panel suggests consideration of a lower nadir GH cut point at 0.4 ng/mL after glucose administration because of the enhanced assay sensitivity and more frequent finding of modest GH hypersecretion. A diagnosis of acromegaly will be made by one of skill in the art considering the totality of the evidence for the patient under consideration.
Once a biochemical diagnosis of acromegaly has been made, a magnetic resonance imaging (MRI) scan of the pituitary gland should be performed because a pituitary GH- secreting adenoma is the most common cause of acromegaly. Visual field testing should be performed if there is optic chiasmal compression noted on the MRI or if the patient has complaints of reduced peripheral vision. Further biochemical testing should include a serum prolactin level (to evaluate for hyperprolactinemia) and assessment of anterior and posterior pituitary function (for potential hypopituitarism).
The goals of therapy for acromegaly are to (1) control biochemical indices of activity, (2) control tumor size and prevent local mass effects, (3) reduce signs and symptoms of disease, (4) prevent or improve medical comorbidities, and (5) prevent early mortality. The primary mode of therapy is surgery, which is recommended for all patients with
microadenomas and for all patients who have macroadenomas with associated mass effects. In patients with macroadenomas without mass effects, and with low likelihood of surgical cure, a role for surgical de-bulking of macroadenomas to improve the response to subsequent medical therapy has been advocated, as well as primary medical therapy alone. Medical therapy is generally used in the adjuvant setting. Irradiation, either conventional fractionated RT or stereotactic radiosurgery, is largely relegated to an adjuvant role. Availability of specific therapeutic options and cost of these interventions are taken into account with decisions regarding therapy.
The goal of surgical interventions is to decrease tumor volume, thereby decreasing production of excess growth hormone and decompress the mass effect of macroadenomas on any normal remaining pituitary gland tissues, optic nerve, or surrounding critical structures. Surgical interventions can be curative for many subjects. Surgically resected tissue should be analyzed to understand the tumor biology to potentially provide guidance for treatment. Biochemical analyses are also performed post-operatively to assess the surgical outcome.
Medical therapy is used in conjunction with surgery. Studies have provided conflicting results regarding the benefits of treatment with medical interventions prior to surgery to change the nature of the tumor. The iRNAs provided herein can be used at any time in conjunction with surgical intervention (i.e., before or after surgery).
Adjunctive medical therapy is used in patients who cannot achieve a complete cure by surgical intervention. Medical therapies fall into three catagories: dopamine agonists, somatostatin analogs (SSAs), and a GH receptor antagonist. Each of the medical
interventions presents different risks and benefits, including substantial costs of some of the therapies.
Dopamine agonists include cabergoline and bromocriptine. The agents are a good first line therapy, especially in patients with mild biochemical activity, as they are realtively inexpensive and orally administered. However, side effects include gastrointestinal upset, orthostatic hypotension, headache, and nasal congestion.
Somatostatin analogs (SSAs) include octreotide (Sandostatin®) LAR (long-acting release, administered as an intramuscular injection) and lanreotide (Somatuline®) Autogel (administered as a deep subcutaneous depot injection). SSAs are less convenient for use than dopamine agonists as they must be administered by injection (50 mcg three times daily Sandostatin® Injection subcutaneously for 2 weeks followed by Sandostatin® LAR 20 mg intragluteally every 4 weeks for 3 months; or 60, 90, or 120mg of Somatuline® every 28 days by deep subcutaneous injection). SSAs are effective in normalizing IGF-I and GH levels in approximately 55% of patients. The clinical and biochemical responses to SSAs are inversely related to tumor size and degree of GH hypersecretion. Octreotide LAR and lanreotide Autogel have similar efficacy profiles. In patients with an inadequate response to SSAs, the addition of cabergoline or pegvisomant may be effective for further lowering one or both of GH and IGF-1 levels. Potential side effects of SSAs, include gastrointestinal upset, malabsorption, constipation, gallbladder disease, hair loss, and bradycardia.
Pegvisomant, a GH receptor antagonist, is administered by daily subcutaneous injection. Side effects of pegvisomant, include flulike illness, allergic reactions, and increase in liver enzymes. Patients treated with pegvisomant must undergo routine liver enzyme tests. Because endogenous GH levels increase with pegvisomant administration and pegvisomant may be cross-measured in GH assays, serum GH levels are not specific and should not be monitored in patients receiving pegvisomant. Instead, serum IGF-1 levels are monitored.
Combinations of various medical therapies may be useful in the treatment of some acromegaly patients.
Radiation therapy is used as an adjunctive treatment is patients who do not respond sufficiently to surgical or medical interventions.
Similar treatment strategies are used in children with giantism, a type of acromegaly, which refers to excess GH secretion that occurs during childhood when the growth plates are open, leading to accelerated vertical growth.
Some of the comorbidities of acromegaly resolve upon decreasing the level of GH or decreasing the responsiveness of the subject to GH. However, others are not. Unlike soft tissue changes, bone enlargement is not reversible. Surgical interventions (e.g., carpal tunnel release, joint replacement surgery), physical therapy, and analgesic medications can be used to treat conditions associated with bone or soft tissue overgrowth. Respiratory disorders including sleep apnea and higher susceptibility to respiratory infections can be treated with standard interventions and preventive strategies (e.g., influenza and pneumococcal vaccinations). Cardiovascular disease, hypertension, and stroke can be managed using standard monitoring (e.g., blood pressure, cholesterol, and lipid level monitoring) and medical treatment. Subjects should be monitored for the development of type 2 diabetes and neoplasia, particularly colon polyps and neoplasia. Subjects should also be monitored for psychological complications related to the physical changes and deformities that can occur with the disease. As used herein, treatment can include, but does not require, resolution of
the co-morbidities of acromegaly. Treatment can include, but does not require, prevention or reduction of the development of one or more of the comorbidities associated with
acromegaly. As used herein, treatment for acromegaly can further include, but does not require, treatment of one or more of the comorbidities associated with acromegaly. X. Response Evaluation Criteria and Treatment of Cancer
Methods for detection of tumors and assessment of tumor burden are well known in the art. For example, the Response Evaluation Criteria in Solid Tumors (RECIST) guidelines were revised in 2008 and are fully set forth in Eisenhauer et al., 2009, New response evaluation criteria in solid tumours: Revised RECIST guideline (version 1.1). Eur. J. Cancer. 45:228-247. These guidelines can be used to determine if a subject has tumor regression or no tumor progression as demonstrated by a complete response (CR) or partial response (PR), or stable disease (SD), respectively, as provided therein for at least a sufficient time that the CR, PR, or SD is detected meets the threshold of treatment or effective treatment as provided herein. A subject with only progressive disease (PD) after
administration of an iRNA provided herein is not considered to have a favorable response to or be effectively treated by the iRNA. The development of PD after a period of CR, PR, or PD is understood as having been effectively treated by the iRNA provided herein.
It is understood that the iRNA agents provided herein can be used in conjunction with other interventions for the treatment of cancer, e.g., surgery, chemotherapy, or radiation. Unless otherwise defined, all technical and scientific terms used herein have the same meaning as commonly understood by one of ordinary skill in the art to which this invention belongs. Although methods and materials similar or equivalent to those described herein can be used in the practice or testing of the antisense polynucleotide agents and methods featured in the invention, suitable methods and materials are described below. All publications, patent applications, patents, and other references mentioned herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety. In case of conflict, the present specification, including definitions, will control. In addition, the materials, methods, and examples are illustrative only and not intended to be limiting. EXAMPLES
Example 1. Antisense Synthesis
The antisense polynucleotides targeting IGFALS were synthesized using standard synthesis methods well known in the art.
A detailed list of antisense molecules targeting IGFALS is shown in Table 3 and Table 5.
Example 2. In vitro screening
Bioinformatics
A set of antisense polynucleotide agents targeting the human IGFALS (insulin like growth factor binding protein acid labile subunit) (human NCBI refseqID: NM_004970; NCBI GeneID: 3483, SEQ ID NO: 1) were designed using custom R and Python scripts. The rationale and method for the set of designs is as follows: the predicted efficacy for every potential 19mer from position 1 through the end of the mRNA was determined with a linear model derived the direct measure of mRNA knockdown from more than 20,000 distinct antisense polynucleotide agent designs targeting a large number of vertebrate genes. Starting from position 1 a set of oligos was created by
systematically picking a design whose 5’ base began every 11 bases along the entire length of the mRNA. Predicted efficacy was used to allow for the substitution of a neighboring, predicted-to-be- more-potent design where the neighboring was 1 base either toward the 5’ or 3’ end of the mRNA. Low complexity designs were removed by filtering with a Shannon entropy index greater than 1.35. In vitro screening
Mouse Hepa1-6 cells (ATCC order# CRL-1830) were seeded at a density of 20000 cells/well in regular, white-walled 96-well tissue culture plates. Plasmid (IGFALS-Luc reporter from Alnylam, SEQ ID NO: 6) transfection was carried out at a concentration of 50ng/well with 0.5µl/well
Lipofectamine2000 (Invitrogen GmbH, Karlsruhe, Germany, cat.# 11668-019) as described by the manufacturer. IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agents and controls (Aha-1 siRNA XD-00033, inactive F-Luc siRNA XD-00194 and R-Luc siRNA XD-00379) were added simultaneously at a concentration of 10nM. Cells were incubated for 24 hours in a humidified incubator at 37°C/5% CO2. Twenty-four hours post-transfection, cells were lysed using luciferase reagents as described by the manufacturer (Promega, Dual-Glo Luciferase Assay System, cat.# E2980). Renilla luciferase protein levels were normalized to firefly luciferase levels. For each IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agent and control, four individual data points were collected. For comparison of silencing activity under full-match conditions (and to monitor transfection efficiency), an active R-Luc siRNA XD-00379 with full match to the renilla open reading frame was synthesized and tested in parallel to the IGFALS antisense polynucleotide agents. Transfections of Aha-1 and F-Luc siRNAs as well as mock treatment were used for normalization since target sites of these molecules were unrelated to IGFALS target sites on the reporter plasmid. Table 2: Abbreviations of nucleotide monomers used in nucleic acid sequence representation. It will be understood that these monomers, when present in an oligonucleotide, are mutually linked by 5'-3'- h h i r n
Claims
We claim: 1. An antisense polynucleotide agent for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises 4 to 50 contiguous nucleotides, wherein at least one of the contiguous nucleotides is a modified nucleotide, and wherein the nucleotide sequence of the agent is 80% complementary over its entire length to the equivalent region of the nucleotide sequence of any one of SEQ ID NOs:1-5. 2. The agent of claim 1, wherein the equivalent region is any one of the target regions of SEQ ID NO:1 provided in Table 3. 3. The agent of claim 1, wherein the equivalent region is a target region of SEQ ID NO:1 at least 14 contiguous nucleotides selected from the group consisting of residues 23-42, 87-106, 121-207, 121-229, 210-229, 287-328, 352-382, 396-415, 417-470, 396-472, 549-568, 615-658, 672- 700, 848-867, 880-899, 923-942, 1035-1054, 1099-1118, 1132-1163,1220-1239, 1354-1382, or 1737- 1756 of SEQ ID NO:1. 4. An antisense polynucleotide agent for inhibiting expression of insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS), wherein the agent comprises at least 8 contiguous nucleotides differing by no more than 3 nucleotides from any one of the nucleotide sequences listed in Table 3. 5. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, wherein substantially all of the nucleotides of the antisense polynucleotide agent are modified nucleotides. 6. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, wherein all of the nucleotides of the antisense polynucleotide agent are modified nucleotides. 7. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 10 to 40 nucleotides in length. 8. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 10 to 30 nucleotides in length. 9. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 18 to 30 nucleotides in length. 10. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 10 to 24 nucleotides in length. 11. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 18 to 24 nucleotides in length. 12. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 14 to 20 nucleotides in length.
13. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 14 nucleotides in length. 14. The agent of any one of claims 1-4, which is 20 nucleotides in length. 15. The agent of any one of claims 1-14, wherein the modified nucleotide comprises a modified sugar moiety selected from the group consisting of: a 2′-O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′-O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety. 16. The agent of claim 15, wherein the bicyclic sugar moiety has a (—CH2—)n group forming a bridge between the 2′ oxygen and the 4′ carbon atoms of the sugar ring, wherein n is 1 or 2 and wherein R is H, CH3 or CH3OCH3. 17. The agent of any one of claims 1-14, wherein the modified nucleotide is a 5- methylcytosine. 18. The agent of any one of claims 1-14, wherein the modified nucleotide comprises a modified internucleoside linkage. 19. The agent of claim 18, wherein the modified internucleoside linkage is a
phosphorothioate internucleoside linkage. 20. The agent of any one of claims 1-14, comprising a plurality of 2′-deoxynucleotides flanked on each side by at least one nucleotide having a modified sugar moiety. 21. The agent of claim 20, wherein the agent is a gapmer comprising a gap segment comprised of linked 2′-deoxynucleotides positioned between a 5′ and a 3′ wing segment. 22. The agent of claim 20, wherein the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′-O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′- O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety. 23. The agent of claim 1-21, wherein the 5’-wing segment is 1 to 6 nucleotides in length. 24. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 3’-wing segment is 1 to 6 nucleotides in length. 25. The agent of claim 21, wherein the gap segment is 5 to 14 nucleotides in length.
26. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 5’-wing segment is 2 nucleotides in length. 27. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 3’-wing segment is 2 nucleotides in length. 28. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 5’-wing segment is 3 nucleotides in length. 29. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 3’-wing segment is 3 nucleotides in length. 30. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 5’-wing segment is 4 nucleotides in length. 31. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 3’-wing segment is 4 nucleotides in length. 32. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 5’-wing segment is 5 nucleotides in length. 33. The agent of claim 21, wherein the 3’-wing segment is 5 nucleotides in length. 34. The agent of claim 21, wherein gap segment is 10 nucleotides in length. 35. An antisense polynucleotide agent for inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression, comprising
a gap segment consisting of linked deoxynucleotides;
a 5’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides;
a 3’-wing segment consisting of linked nucleotides;
wherein the gap segment is positioned between the 5’-wing segment and the 3’-wing segment and wherein each nucleotide of each wing segment comprises a modified sugar. 36. The agent of claim 35, wherein the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is five nucleotides in length. 37. Theagent of claim 35, wherein the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is four nucleotides in length. 38. The agent of claim 35, wherein the gap segment is ten 2′-deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is three nucleotides in length. 39. The antisense compound of claim 35, wherein the gap segment is ten 2′- deoxynucleotides in length and each of the wing segments is two nucleotides in length.
40. The agent of claim 35, wherein the modified sugar moiety is selected from the group consisting of a 2′-O-methoxyethyl modified sugar moiety, a 2′-methoxy modified sugar moiety, a 2′- O-alkyl modified sugar moiety, and a bicyclic sugar moiety. 41. The agent of any one of claims 1-4 or 35, wherein the agent further comprises a ligand. 42. The agent of claim 41, wherein the antisense polynucleotide agent is conjugated to the ligand at the 3’-terminus. 43. The agent of claim 41, wherein the ligand is an N-acetylgalactosamine (GalNAc) derivative.
45. A pharmaceutical composition for inhibiting expression of an insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS)gene comprising the agent of any one of claims 1 to 44. 46. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 45, wherein agent is present in an unbuffered solution. 47. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 46, wherein the unbuffered solution is saline or water. 48. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 46, wherein the agent is present in a buffer solution. 49. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 48, wherein the buffer solution comprises acetate, citrate, prolamine, carbonate, or phosphate or any combination thereof.
50. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 48, wherein the buffer solution is phosphate buffered saline (PBS). 51. A pharmaceutical composition comprising the agent of any one of claims 1 to 50, and a lipid formulation. 52. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 51, wherein the lipid formulation comprises a LNP. 53. The pharmaceutical composition of claim 51, wherein the lipid formulation comprises a MC3. 54. A method of inhibiting insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
(IGFALS)expression in a cell, the method comprising:
(a) contacting the cell with the agent of any one of claims 1-44 or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of claims 45 to 53; and
(b) maintaining the cell produced in step (a) for a time sufficient to obtain antisense inhibition of an insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) gene, thereby inhibiting expression of the IGFALS gene in the cell. 55. The method of claim 54, wherein the cell is within a subject. 56. The method of claim 55, wherein the subject is a human. 57. The method of claim 54, wherein the insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression is inhibited by at least 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 95%, 98% or to below the level of detection. 58. A method of treating a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) expression, the method comprising administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of the agent of any one of claims 1-44 or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of claims 45-53, thereby treating the subject. 59. A method of preventing at least one symptom in a subject having a disease or disorder that would benefit from reduction in insulin like growth factor, acid labile subunit
(IGFALS)expression, the method comprising administering to the subject a prophylactically effective amount of the agent of any one of claims 1-44 or a pharmaceutical composition of any one of claims
45-53, thereby preventing at least one symptom in the subject having a disorder that would benefit from reduction in IGFALS expression. 60. The method of claim 58 or 59, wherein the administration of the agent or pharmaceutical composition to the subject causes a decrease in one or more signs or symptoms of acromegaly, giantism, or cancer; or a decrease in IGFALS protein levels. 61. The method of claim 58 or 59, wherein the disorder is an IGFALS-associated disease. 62. The method of claim 61, wherein the IGFALS-associated disease is selected from acromegaly, gigantism, and cancer. 63. The method of claim 62, wherein the IGFALS-associated disease is acromegaly. 64. The method of claim 62, wherein the IGFALS-associated disease is gigantism. 65. The method of claim 62, wherein the IGFALS-associated disease is cancer. 66. The method of claim 65, wherein the cancer is metastatic cancer. 67. The method of claim 58 or 59, wherein the subject is human. 68. The method of any one of claims 58-67, further comprising administering an additional therapeutic agent, to the subject. 69. The method of any one of claims 58-68, wherein the agent is administered at a dose of 0.01 mg/kg to 10 mg/kg or 0.5 mg/kg to 50 mg/kg. 70. The method of claim 69, wherein the agent is administered at a dose of 10 mg/kg to 30 mg/kg. 71. The method of claim 69, wherein the agent is administered to the subject once a week. 72. The method of claim 69, wherein the agent is administered to the subject twice a week.
73. The method of claim 69, wherein the agent is administered to the subject twice a month. 74. The method of any one of claims 58-73, wherein the agent is administered to the subject subcutaneously.
Applications Claiming Priority (2)
| Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
|---|---|---|---|
| US201662315255P | 2016-03-30 | 2016-03-30 | |
| US62/315,255 | 2016-03-30 |
Publications (1)
| Publication Number | Publication Date |
|---|---|
| WO2017172356A1 true WO2017172356A1 (en) | 2017-10-05 |
Family
ID=59966354
Family Applications (1)
| Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
|---|---|---|---|
| PCT/US2017/022390 Ceased WO2017172356A1 (en) | 2016-03-30 | 2017-03-15 | Polynucleotide agents targeting insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (igfals) and methods of use thereof |
Country Status (1)
| Country | Link |
|---|---|
| WO (1) | WO2017172356A1 (en) |
Cited By (1)
| Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
|---|---|---|---|---|
| US11066670B2 (en) | 2015-07-10 | 2021-07-20 | Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) and insulin-like growth factor 1 (IGF-1) iRNA compositions and methods of use thereof |
Citations (1)
| Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
|---|---|---|---|---|
| WO2014197938A1 (en) * | 2013-06-13 | 2014-12-18 | Antisense Therapeutics Ltd | Combination therapy |
-
2017
- 2017-03-15 WO PCT/US2017/022390 patent/WO2017172356A1/en not_active Ceased
Patent Citations (1)
| Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
|---|---|---|---|---|
| WO2014197938A1 (en) * | 2013-06-13 | 2014-12-18 | Antisense Therapeutics Ltd | Combination therapy |
Non-Patent Citations (2)
| Title |
|---|
| LOMBARDI, G. ET AL.: "Efficacy of the new long-acting formulation of lanreotide (lanreotide Autogel) in somatostatin analogue-naive patients with acromegaly", JOURNAL OF ENDOCRINOLOGICAL INVESTIGATION, vol. 32, no. 3, 17 June 2009 (2009-06-17), XP055426713, Retrieved from the Internet <URL:https://www.researchgate.net/profile/Annamaria_Colao/publication/26307457_Efficacy_of_thenewlong-acting_formulation_of_lanreotide_Lanreotide_Autogel_in_somatostatin_analogue-naive_patients_with_acromegaly/links/00b7d52clal0394fb0000000/Efficacy-of-the-new-long-acting-formulation-of-lanreo> [retrieved on 20170620] * |
| SIEBEL, SARA ET AL.: "Humanization and Characterization of a Human Growth Hormone Receptor (GHR) Antagonist Antibody RN172.", GH AND IGF ACTION, 22 June 2014 (2014-06-22), Retrieved from the Internet <URL:http://press.endocrine.orgldoi/abs/10.1210/endo-meetings.2014.NP.8.SUN-0629> [retrieved on 20170620] * |
Cited By (1)
| Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
|---|---|---|---|---|
| US11066670B2 (en) | 2015-07-10 | 2021-07-20 | Alnylam Pharmaceuticals, Inc. | Insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) and insulin-like growth factor 1 (IGF-1) iRNA compositions and methods of use thereof |
Similar Documents
| Publication | Publication Date | Title |
|---|---|---|
| US20240102020A1 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting programmed cell death 1 ligand 1 (pd-l1) and methods of use thereof | |
| US10597661B2 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting patatin-like phospholipase domain containing 3 (PNPLA3) and methods of use thereof | |
| US10883107B2 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting factor XII (hageman factor) (F12) and methods of use thereof | |
| US11066670B2 (en) | Insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (IGFALS) and insulin-like growth factor 1 (IGF-1) iRNA compositions and methods of use thereof | |
| US10946107B2 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting hydroxyacid oxidase (glycolate oxidase, HAO1) and methods of use thereof | |
| US20200384011A1 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting angiotensinogen (agt) and methods of use thereof | |
| US20220372487A1 (en) | Compositions and methods for inhibiting expression of the lect2 gene | |
| US20220002734A1 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting aminolevulinic acid synthase-1 (alas1) and uses thereof | |
| US10344278B2 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting Serpinc1 (AT3) and methods of use thereof | |
| WO2017172356A1 (en) | Polynucleotide agents targeting insulin-like growth factor binding protein, acid labile subunit (igfals) and methods of use thereof |
Legal Events
| Date | Code | Title | Description |
|---|---|---|---|
| NENP | Non-entry into the national phase |
Ref country code: DE |
|
| 121 | Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application |
Ref document number: 17776289 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |
|
| 122 | Ep: pct application non-entry in european phase |
Ref document number: 17776289 Country of ref document: EP Kind code of ref document: A1 |